KAYE GROUP INC
10-K, 1999-03-30
FIRE, MARINE & CASUALTY INSURANCE
Previous: COMPUTER MOTION INC, DEF 14A, 1999-03-30
Next: MB FINANCIAL INC, 8-K/A, 1999-03-30





                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                              WASHINGTON, DC 20549

                                    FORM 10-K

              ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(D) OF THE
                         SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT - 1934


For the Fiscal Year Ended December 31, 1998
Commission File Number 0-21988


                                 Kaye Group Inc.
             (exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)


            Delaware                                       13-3719772
(State or Other Jurisdiction of                (IRS Employer Identification No.)
Incorporation or Organization)

                    122 East 42nd Street, New York, NY 10168
              (Address and Zip Code of Principal Executive Offices)

                  Registrant's Telephone Number: (212) 338-2100

Securities Registered Under Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act:

    Title of Each Class                                       Name of Exchange
Common Stock $.01 par value                               NASDAQ National Market

Securities Registered Under Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act:

                                      None

     Check  whether  the issuer (1) filed all  reports  required  to be filed by
Section 13 or 15(d) of the  Exchange  Act during the past 12 months (or for such
shorter period that the  registrant was required to file such reports),  and (2)
has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes _X_ No___

     Check  if  disclosure  of  delinquent  filers  in  response  to Item 405 of
Regulation  S-K is not  contained  in  this  form,  and no  disclosure  will  be
contained,  to the  best  of  registrant's  knowledge  in  definitive  proxy  or
information  statements  incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K
or any amendment to this Form 10-K. ___


<PAGE>


     The  aggregate  market  value  of the  registrant's  common  stock  held by
non-affiliates  of  the  registrant  as of  March  12,  1999  was  approximately
$39,140,000.

     Number of shares of the registrant's  common stock  outstanding as of March
12, 1999: 8,452,435.


                       DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

     The registrant's  definitive proxy statement,  which will be filed with the
Securities  and  Exchange  Commission  within 120 days after  December  31, 1998
(incorporated by reference under Part III).

     Total number of pages filed including cover and under pages 89.

     Index to Exhibits is on page 42.



                                       2
<PAGE>


                                 KAYE GROUP INC.

                                TABLE OF CONTENTS

Part I

Item 1.     Business                                                           4

Item 2.     Properties                                                        21

Item 3.     Legal Proceedings                                                 21

Item 4.     Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders               21


Part II

Item 5.     Market for Common Equity and Related
            Stockholder Matters                                               22

Item 6.     Selected Financial Data                                           23

Item 7.     Management's Discussion and Analysis
            of Financial Condition and Results of Operations                  25

Item 8.     Financial Statements and Supplementary Data                       40

Item 9.     Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants
            on Accounting and Financial Disclosure                            40


Part III

Item 10.    Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant                40

Item 11.    Executive Compensation                                            40

Item 12.    Security Ownership of Certain
            Beneficial Owners and Management                                  40

Item 13.    Certain Relationships and Related Transactions                    41



Part IV

Item 14.    Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules
            and  Reports on Form 8-K                                          41

Financial Statements                                                         F-1


                                       3
<PAGE>


Item 1.  Business

Business  Segments

     Kaye Group Inc. (the "Company"), a Delaware corporation,  formerly Old Lyme
Holding  Corporation  ("Holding"),  is a  holding  company  which,  through  its
subsidiaries,  is engaged in a broad range of insurance brokerage,  underwriting
and related activities.  The Company operates in two insurance business segments
- -  the  Insurance  Brokerage  Companies  Operations  ("Brokerage   Operations"),
comprised of the Retail Brokerage  Business and the Program Brokerage  Business,
and the Property and Casualty Companies Operations.

     In addition,  Corporate  Operations  includes those activities that benefit
the Company in its entirety and cannot be specifically  identified to either the
Brokerage  Operations or the Property and Casualty  Companies  Operations.  Such
activities  include  debt  servicing  and  public  company  expenses,  including
investor relations costs.

     The Company's  activities are conducted in New York, New York, and in other
offices  located in  Pasadena,  California,  Westport,  Connecticut,  Hollywood,
Florida, Floral Park, New York, Woodbury, New York and Warwick, Rhode Island.

Insurance Brokerage Companies Operations

     The Retail  Brokerage  Business  operates  insurance  brokerage  businesses
through four subsidiaries of the Company, the "Retail Brokerage  Companies".  It
offers commercial clients a full range of insurance brokerage services including
procurement of property/casualty insurance, risk management consulting, bonding,
loss prevention engineering,  and group employee benefit consulting services. In
addition,  personal lines and life and health  insurance  coverage are placed on
behalf of individual clients.

     The Retail Brokerage Business' primary strategy is to service middle market
companies  and  organizations  just below the  Fortune 500 level for which other
national  brokers  intensely  compete.  Within  this middle  market,  the Retail
Brokerage Business has developed particular expertise and knowledge of the risks
facing a number of industry sectors including health care, real estate,  retail,
manufacturing, churches, law firms, homes for the aged and fine arts.

     During 1998, the Retail Brokerage  Business serviced  approximately  15,000
insureds.  The  Retail  Brokerage  Business  is  compensated  for  its  services
primarily in the form of commissions paid by insurance companies. The commission
is usually a percentage  of the premium paid by the  insured.  Commission  rates
depend upon the type of insurance,  the particular  insurance  company,  and the
role in which the Retail Brokerage  Business acts. In some cases a commission is
shared  with other  agents or brokers  who have  acted  jointly  with the Retail
Brokerage  Business in connection  with the  transaction.  The Retail  Brokerage
Business may also receive from an insurance company a contingent



                                       4
<PAGE>


commission that is generally based on the  profitability  and volume of business
placed with it by the Retail Brokerage Business over a given period of time. The
Retail Brokerage Business may also receive fees from insureds in connection with
consulting services relating to the marketing of insurance.

     Program Brokerage  Corporation or "PBC" (the "Program Brokerage  Business")
is a  subsidiary  of the Company and  operates a wholesale  insurance  brokerage
business which offers retail insurance agents and brokers  innovative  solutions
to the twin  insurance  problems  of price  and  availability  of  coverage.  It
accomplishes  this by organizing pools of similar risks into specially  designed
Alternative Risk Transfer  ("A.R.T.") programs through which it places insurance
for affinity groups (the "Programs").

     The Program Brokerage  Business is one of the leaders in the application of
purchasing groups in the commercial insurance market. Approximately 65% of PBC's
premium volume was generated by  approximately  450 unrelated  retail  insurance
agents and  brokers  serving  approximately  5,800  insureds  during  1998.  The
remaining  35% was derived  from the Retail  Brokerage  Business.  Approximately
one-half  of PBC's  premium  volume is directly  or  indirectly  placed with two
affiliates,  Old Lyme Insurance  Company of Rhode Island,  Inc. ("OLRI") and Old
Lyme Insurance Company, Ltd. (Bermuda) ("OLB").

Property and Casualty Companies Operations

     The Company  conducts  its  property  and  casualty  underwriting  business
through two insurance company subsidiaries (the "Insurance Companies"), OLRI and
OLB. OLRI is a property and casualty  insurance company licensed in Rhode Island
and  eligible as a surplus  lines  insurer in New York and New Jersey.  OLB is a
property and casualty insurance company organized and licensed under the laws of
Bermuda.  In states where the Insurance  Companies are not admitted  insurers or
surplus lines insurers, the Insurance Companies underwrite risks through various
reinsurance agreements.

     The Insurance Companies  underwrite property risks (loss or physical damage
to property) and OLRI  underwrites  casualty risks (legal liability for personal
injury or  damaged  property  of others)  for  insureds  in the  United  States.
Insurance is sold principally  through the Programs marketed by PBC which insure
various   types  of   businesses   and   properties   that  have   similar  risk
characteristics,  such as apartments, condominiums,  cooperatives,  restaurants,
building  maintenance  companies,  automobile  service stations,  retail stores,
funeral homes and pharmacies, among others.



                                       5
<PAGE>


     The Insurance  Companies'  strategy is to underwrite only the first "layer"
of the property and casualty insurance provided under the Programs.  Exposure to
individual insureds on individual losses is thereby generally limited to between
$10,000 and $25,000 per claim (inclusive of allocated loss expenses),  depending
on the Program.  Under the Programs,  the Insurance Companies' policies are sold
in  conjunction  with  policies  issued by  unaffiliated  Program  insurers that
provide  coverage for losses above the first layer of risk  underwritten  by the
Insurance Companies.  In addition,  OLRI has issued policies on a selected basis
with  limits up to  $1,000,000,  retaining  the first  $50,000 of  exposure  and
reinsuring the remaining limits with an unaffiliated reinsurer, PXRE Reinsurance
Company (rated Ag by A.M. Best Company ("A.M.  Best"), a major rating agency for
insurers).

     The  Property   and   Casualty   Companies   Operations   includes   Claims
Administration  Corporation  ("CAC"),  a  subsidiary  of the  Company  which  is
responsible for the  administration  of a large majority of the claims submitted
to the Insurance Companies. The administration of claims includes investigation,
engagement of legal counsel,  approval of settlements and the making of payments
to, or on behalf of insureds. CAC also provides claims administration service to
the unaffiliated Program insurers for a fee.


History of the Company

1952 to 1993

     Prior to the initial public offering  ("IPO") of Holding's  common stock in
August  1993,  the  operations  of the  Retail  Brokerage  Companies,  PBC,  the
Insurance  Companies  and CAC  were  part of a  single  combined  insurance  and
brokerage  business  owned  by Kaye  International  L.P.  ("KILP")  and  certain
individuals.  KILP, via several stock and asset acquisitions and mergers, traces
its origins back to 1952.  Prior to the IPO,  KILP  developed the concept of the
"deductible"   primary  "layer"  of  insurance  coverage   administered  through
Programs.  This business was placed through the Insurance  Companies.  In August
1993, after years of successful  growth,  the Insurance  Companies,  PBC and CAC
were organized under Holding, of which approximately 33% was sold to the public.

     At the time of the IPO,  management of Holding believed that its historical
marketing  efforts and ability to expand its business were hampered by its small
capital  base and its lack of a letter  rating  from  A.M.  Best.  Approximately
$13,000,000 of the proceeds of the IPO were  contributed to OLRI to increase its
capital and surplus to permit it to (i) increase its underwriting  capabilities,
(ii)  obtain a letter  rating  from A.M.  Best,  and (iii)  enable  OLRI to meet
certain regulatory capital and surplus requirements. As a result of the proceeds
being contributed,  OLRI significantly increased its underwriting capacity. This
enabled it to ultimately obtain an A.M. Best rating of A- (Excellent)  (which it
currently maintains) and meet all regulatory capital and surplus requirements.



                                       6
<PAGE>


     The business growth of OLRI however depends on the creation of new Programs
and the  addition  of insureds  into  existing  Programs.  OLRI relies on PBC to
develop  new  Programs.  PBC is  also  OLRI's  most  important  and  significant
producing  broker,  historically  producing all of the Insurance  Companies' net
premiums earned.

1994

     In 1994, the Retail  Brokerage  Business  completed the  integration of its
1992  acquisition  of  Amalgamated  Programs  Corporation  and related  entities
("Amalgamated")  and  continued to downsize to adjust for the  continuing  "soft
market" in property and casualty premium rates. At the time, the officers of the
general  partners  of  KILP  (which  included  members  of  Holding's  Board  of
Directors)  concluded that the  combination of Holding and the Retail  Brokerage
Business would be advantageous for both OLRI and KILP. This conclusion was based
on three factors:  (a) improved  operating  results derived from the Amalgamated
integration  and "soft  market"  downsizing,  (b) the  improved  outlook for the
Retail Brokerage  Business and (c) the fact that the Retail  Brokerage  Business
accounted for approximately one-half of PBC's premium volume.

     In evaluating the combination, Holding's Board of Directors also considered
the fact that the  market  for  Holding's  common  stock  following  the IPO was
relatively  illiquid.  The Board  believed  that the  combination  of the Retail
Brokerage  Business with Holding would  increase the size of Holding,  make it a
more financially  diverse company and potentially  attract a broader spectrum of
investors.

1995

     The  combination  ("Transaction")  was  effective  October  2, 1995 and was
accounted for as a transfer and exchange between companies under common control.
Accordingly,  the assets and liabilities of the Retail  Brokerage  Business were
combined with those of Holding at their historical cost in a manner similar to a
"pooling of interests" (see Note 2 to the consolidated  financial  statements of
the Company). The combination was accomplished as follows:

          1. Holding  transferred  to then  recently  formed Kaye Holding  Corp.
     ("KHC") all of the outstanding stock of the Insurance Companies and its two
     other  subsidiaries,  PBC and CAC, and its other assets in exchange for (i)
     82,400  shares  of KHC  common  stock,  representing  82.4%  of  the  total
     outstanding KHC common stock,  and (ii) the assumption by KHC of certain of
     Holding's liabilities.

          2. KILP  transferred  all of its interest in the limited  partnerships
     conducting the Retail Brokerage  Business (the "Retail  Partnerships")  and
     certain  related  assets to KHC in  exchange  for (i) 17,200  shares of KHC
     common stock, representing 17.2% of the total outstanding KHC common stock,
     and (ii) the assumption by KHC of certain KILP liabilities.



                                       7
<PAGE>


          3. Certain  individuals  transferred to KHC all of their  interests in
     the  corporate  general  partners of the Retail  Partnerships  (the "Retail
     Brokerage  Companies")  in  exchange  for 400 shares of KHC  common  stock,
     representing 0.4% of the total outstanding KHC common stock.

          4. KHC  contributed  its interests in the Retail  Partnerships  to the
     Retail  Brokerage  Companies  thereby causing the dissolution of the Retail
     Partnerships.  As a result, the Retail Brokerage Companies, as a group, own
     all of the assets and are subject to all of the liabilities,  of the Retail
     Brokerage Business.

1997

     On December 30, 1997  stockholders of the Company  approved a restructuring
that merged KHC into the Company.  This eliminated the minority  interest in KHC
held by KILP  and  simplified  the  corporate  structure  and  reporting  of the
Company.

1998

     On May 12, 1998 KILP was dissolved and  approximately  6,100,000  shares of
the  Company  were  distributed  by KILP  to its  partners,  consisting  of Kaye
Investments L.P., ZS Kaye, L.P., other entities and individuals.

The chart below reflects the current structure of the Company:


                       ==================================
                                KAYE GROUP INC.
                             (Corporate Operations)
                       ==================================

             100%                                           100%
=================================         ======================================
Insurance Brokerage Companies:            Property and Casualty Companies:
  Kaye Insurance Associates, Inc.           Old Lyme Insurance Company of Rhode
  Kaye Corporation of Connecticut              Island, Inc.
  Kaye-Western Insurance & Risk             Old Lyme Insurance Company, Ltd. and
    Services, Inc.                          Park Brokerage, Ltd.
  Kaye Services Corp.                       Claims Administration Corporation
  Program Brokerage Corporation
=================================         ======================================


                                       8
<PAGE>



Affinity Group Marketing

     Affinity group marketing (including A.R.T. programs) contributes 68% of the
Company's 1998 consolidated revenues, excluding investment income.

Retail Brokerage Operations

     The Retail  Brokerage  Business  generally  services middle market entities
just  below  the  Fortune  500  level.  Within  this  market,  it has  developed
particular  expertise  and  knowledge  of the risks  facing a number of industry
sectors.  Based on this expertise and knowledge,  the Retail Brokerage  Business
has  established  programs for hospitals and  physicians,  churches,  law firms,
mental health practitioners, homes for the aged and fine arts, among others.

     Approximately 37% of the Retail Brokerage Business' 1998 revenues relate to
such affinity groups. Of this 37%, approximately 73% of the related revenues are
derived from unrelated insurance markets. The remaining 27% is derived from PBC.
(The premium volume associated with this 27% represents  approximately one-third
of PBC's premium  volume.) No premiums are placed with the  Insurance  Companies
directly by the Retail Brokerage Business.

PBC and Insurance Companies Operations

     PBC designs A.R.T.  programs for affinity  groups and markets via a network
of retail insurance  brokers,  including the Retail Brokerage  Companies.  PBC's
distribution  network  includes  approximately  450 unrelated  retail agents and
brokers.  These  unrelated  agents and brokers  account for  two-thirds of PBC's
premium volume. The Insurance Companies underwrite a portion of the Programs and
only underwrite programs designed by PBC.

     During  the past six years the  original  1:2 ratio of  insurance  premiums
produced by  unrelated  retail  brokers to  insurance  premiums  produced by the
Retail Brokerage Companies (the "Production Ratio"), respectively, has reversed.
But production from both sources has grown.  PBC's total premium volume for 1998
of $55,000,000 increased 10% over 1997. It is expected that the Production Ratio
will  approach 3:1 during 1999,  consistent  with PBC's  strategy of growing the
unrelated retail agents and broker distribution network.

     Once PBC establishes an A.R.T.  program, it acts as the placing broker with
respect  to  insurance  under the  Programs.  In such a role,  PBC is a party to
agreements  with  various  unaffiliated   insurers  as  well  as  the  Insurance
Companies.


                                       9
<PAGE>


     PBC receives  commissions from OLRI and the unaffiliated  Program insurers.
Pursuant to  sub-brokerage  agreements,  PBC pays  commissions to retail brokers
based upon all business produced by such agents and brokers (including  business
placed by PBC with the unaffiliated Program insurers).

     The Insurance  Companies'  strategy in most cases is to underwrite only the
first "layer" per claim (the deductible range) (primarily inclusive of allocated
loss  expenses)  of the  property  and  casualty  insurance  provided  under the
Programs developed by PBC. This limits their exposure to individual  insureds on
individual  losses to the deductible  range depending on the Program.  Under the
Programs,  the  Insurance  Companies'  policies  are  sold in  conjunction  with
policies issued by unaffiliated  insurers that provide coverage for losses above
the first "layer" of risk underwritten by the Insurance Companies. The Insurance
Companies  believe that their rates for the first "layer" of risk, when combined
with the rates of such other  unrelated  insurers  for the  coverage  above such
layer, are generally  competitive with the rates that other insurance  companies
would charge to provide comparable insurance coverage.

     The Insurance Companies currently  participate in 24 A.R.T.  programs.  The
major program groupings are as follows:

          1. The  Residential  Real Estate  Program,  started in 1990,  provides
     property and  casualty  insurance  for  residential  real estate  including
     rental  apartments,  cooperatives,  and condominiums.  Policies protect the
     owner from property losses and casualty claims, such as claims brought by a
     tenant or member of the public  injured on the  premises.  This  program is
     offered  principally in the New York City area and has approximately  1,300
     insureds.

          2.  The  Restaurant  Program,  started  in 1985,  insures  restaurants
     against  casualty claims (most typically  brought by an injured  restaurant
     patron) and property  losses.  Many of the restaurants  that participate in
     this Program are "white tablecloth" restaurants. The Restaurant Program has
     approximately 900 insureds.

          3. The Real Estate Umbrella Program insures residential and commercial
     real estate owners against certain types of casualty  losses.  Insureds are
     provided with an extra level of protection in  conjunction  with a standard
     umbrella  policy.  Coverage is provided for losses that are included within
     the broad terms of the policy,  but are excluded under the general casualty
     policy.  This Program also offers high umbrella  casualty limits  primarily
     provided by unrelated Program insurance companies to individual real estate
     owners.  OLRI has a maximum  exposure of $10,000 per claim. The Real Estate
     Umbrella Program has approximately 500 insureds.


                                       10
<PAGE>


          4. The remaining 21 programs  represent 17% of the net premiums earned
     by the Insurance  Companies in 1998. They have approximately 3,100 insureds
     and include among others the following affinity groups:  catalog showrooms,
     homeowners,  retail  stores,  drug  stores,  funeral  directors,  bars  and
     taverns,   waste  haulers,   laundromats  and  dry  cleaners,  New  England
     restaurants,  Asian  American  restaurants,  automobile  service  stations,
     houses of worship, and main street small businesses.

     The  Restaurant  Program,  Residential  Real Estate Program and Real Estate
Umbrella  Program  accounted for 83% of the net premiums earned by the Insurance
Companies in 1998. The following table sets forth the percentage of net premiums
earned  attributable  to the  programs and all other  business  during the years
ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996.

                                                        Net Premiums Earned
                                                      Years Ended December 31,
                                                    1998        1997        1996
                                                    ----        ----        ----
Residential Real Estate ....................         42%         46%         49%
Restaurant Program .........................         23%         25%         24%
Real Estate Umbrella Program ...............         18%         16%         14%
Other ......................................         17%         13%         13%
                                                    ---         ---         ---
                                                    100%        100%        100%
                                                    ===         ===         ===

Acquisitions

     During  1997,  the  Brokerage   Operations   acquired  certain  assets  and
liabilities of Western Insurance Associates,  Inc. ("WIA"). This acquisition was
accounted  for as a  purchase  and  achieved  critical  mass  for the  brokerage
operations located in Pasadena,  California.  In addition,  this acquisition was
synergistic as WIA's competitive advantage is in the production of business from
affinity groups, including churches and homes for the aged.

     During  1998,  the  Brokerage   Operations   acquired  certain  assets  and
liabilities  of Florida  Insurance  Associates,  Inc.  ("FIA"),  Daniel V. Keane
Agency, Inc. ("DVK") and Laub Group of Florida, Inc. ("LGF"). These acquisitions
were accounted for as purchases and are expected to add 7% revenue growth to the
Retail Brokerage Business. FIA, located in Hollywood,  Florida,  represented the
Company's  entrance into the Florida  marketplace.  DVK,  located in Bridgeport,
Connecticut,  was relocated to the Company's  Westport,  Connecticut  office and
added  to  that  office's  personal  lines  and  main  street  (small  business)
operations. LGF, located in Hollywood,  Florida, added alternative risk transfer
capabilities to the FIA operations.


                                       11
<PAGE>


     During the first quarter of 1999, the Brokerage Operations acquired certain
assets and liabilities of Seaman, Ross, & Weiner, Inc. ("SRW"). This acquisition
will be accounted for as a purchase.  SRW,  located in Woodbury,  New York, will
enhance the general  commercial,  group  benefits and life  insurance  Brokerage
Operations in the New York City metropolitan area.

     The  Company  believes  that  the  effect  of  past,   present  and  future
acquisitions  will be to expand  its  insurance  program  services  to  affinity
groups, thus providing earnings to all operations.

     The  Company  is  considering  and  intends to  consider  from time to time
additional  acquisitions  and divestitures on terms it deems consistent with its
strategies.  The Company at this time is engaged in preliminary discussions with
a number of  candidates  for  possible  future  acquisitions  but has not signed
contracts  or  agreements  in  principle  to make  additional  acquisitions.  No
assurances can be given that any additional acquisitions or divestitures will be
completed, or if completed, that they will be advantageous to the Company.

Seasonality

     The  Brokerage  Operations'  revenues  vary  significantly  from quarter to
quarter as a result of the timing of policy renewals and their related billings.
This is due to the revenue  recognition  method for brokerage  commissions which
requires  that a full year's  commissions  be  recognized  immediately  upon the
billing  date  of the  business.  However,  premium  revenues  of the  Insurance
Companies are  recognized  ratably over the term of the related  policies.  As a
result,  there is little  variation  from quarter to quarter in the Property and
Casualty Companies Operations' revenues.

     Consolidated  revenues  by quarter  for 1998,  1997 and 1996 were earned as
follows.  Amounts  shown  represent  a  percentage  of  the  related  full  year
consolidated revenues.

                                              1998        1997        1996
                                              ----        ----        ----
         First Quarter                         23%         22%         22%
         Second Quarter                        24%         23%         22%
         Third Quarter                         26%         28%         28%
         Fourth Quarter                        27%         27%         28%



                                       12
<PAGE>


Competition, and Industry and Market Risk

     The  Company is the 28th  largest  insurance  broker in the  United  States
according to "Business Insurance", a leading insurance industry publication.  It
operates in a highly  competitive  industry and faces  competition from regional
brokers, regional offices of worldwide brokers and insurers.

     The  insurance  brokerage  business  is  highly  competitive.  The  Company
believes that it is well  positioned  to compete  within its  designated  market
because of the  expertise  and  knowledge it has  developed in servicing  middle
market companies,  the Programs it has developed and the proprietary database of
affinity group underwriting and claims information it has developed. In general,
premium pricing and commission  rate  reductions  continue to impact the Company
and the  insurance  industry  as a whole.  The Company  has been  successful  in
replacing  business lost from such premium and  commission  rate  reductions and
attrition  through new business  developed  from new accounts and programs,  and
extension of service to existing accounts.

     Many  insurance  companies  which compete with OLRI have a higher A.M. Best
- -rating  (OLRI  is  rated  A-(Excellent)),  and  are  larger  and  have  greater
financial, marketing and management resources than OLRI. Competition is based on
many factors,  including  perceived overall  financial  strength of the insurer,
premiums charged, policy terms and conditions,  services offered, reputation and
experience. Due to its size, management and operational flexibility, the Company
can  respond  quickly  to,  and  take  advantage  of,   changing   circumstances
encountered in the marketplace.

     In the event that admitted  insurers  (including the  unaffiliated  Program
insurers)  begin to offer the coverage in New York which the Company offers as a
surplus  lines  insurer,  it is  possible  that OLRI may be  unable  to  receive
placements on a surplus  lines basis,  because  brokers are  generally  required
first to obtain three  "declinations"  from  admitted  carriers  before they can
offer  the  business  to a  surplus  lines  underwriter.  In  addition,  in soft
insurance  markets,  other insurance  companies may be more willing to offer low
deductibles  which cover the first layer of risk at prices  competitive  with or
lower than those under the Programs.

     As part of its ongoing  business,  the Company is exposed to certain market
risks of potential  losses from adverse changes in market rates and prices.  The
Company's  primary market risk exposure is interest rate risk in regard to fixed
rate  domestic  instruments  and  outstanding  debt.  The  Company  has  minimal
investments in equity securities which have no material market risk exposure. It
has no derivative  instruments.  The Company's financial  instruments consist of
the investment  portfolio of OLRI. These  instruments are comprised of Corporate
and  Municipal  Bonds  and  U.S.  Treasury  securities  that are  classified  as
available  for sale.  The  Company  generally  selects  investment  assets  with
characteristics such as duration,  yield,  currency, and liquidity to match cash
flows of related  insurance and  reinsurance  contracts.  It selects medium term
fixed  rate  investments  to  support  general   liability  claims  and  shorter
investments to support property claims. The



                                       13
<PAGE>


fair value of and weighted average interest rate on the investment  portfolio as
of December 31, 1998 was $43,597,000 and 5.6%, respectively.

     The Company has various debt instruments  outstanding at December 31, 1998.
These debt  instruments,  which are due through 2002,  match the Company's  cash
inflow from operations.

Year 2000 Compliance

     Many computers,  software programs and microprocessors  embedded in certain
equipment (collectively,  "systems") were designed to accommodate only two-digit
date fields to  represent  a given year  (e.g.,  "98"  represents  1998).  It is
possible  that  such  systems  will  not be  able  to  accurately  process  data
containing  information relating to dates before, during or after the year 2000.
It is possible that such systems could fail entirely, although in many instances
the  consequences  of a system not being "year 2000  complaint" are unknown.  In
response to this issue, the Company has evaluated its applications and operating
software and is in the process of evaluating its hardware and software products,
end  user  computing   activities,   third-party  data  exchanges  and  business
relationships,  and has  established a project team  responsible  for overseeing
progress on the  Company's  compliance  program and  periodically  reporting  to
management.

     As of December 31, 1998 the Company has completed  approximately 75% of its
efforts to bring its own applications software and hardware in compliance,  with
the objective of having all critical  production  systems year 2000 compliant by
the  middle of 1999.  Testing of  critical  applications  is being  accomplished
through the use of a special system testing  environment  that simulates  system
operations  in the year 2000.  The Company also  purchased and  implemented  new
operational  and  accounting  software  in 1998.  In addition to being year 2000
compliant,  these new systems are intended to add increased functionality to the
Company.  The Company has  completed  its  assessment  of its servers and client
server operating software. The results of this assessment were identification of
hardware and software issues requiring  remediation in order to assure year 2000
compliance.

     The  total  cost  (both  current  and  future)  to  modify  these  existing
production  systems,   which  includes  both  internal  and  external  costs  of
programming,  coding  and  testing  is  estimated  to be  $135,000  and has been
reflected in the financial statements.

     In addition to addressing hardware/software  information technology ("IT"),
the Company  has also been  assessing  year 2000  issues with  respect to non-IT
systems  such as  telephones  and various  building  services  which may rely on
embedded  microprocessors.  Although failure of non-IT systems such as telephone
service could disrupt the Company's business, the Company's  communications with
the relevant vendors have not identified any significant year 2000 problems.



                                       14
<PAGE>


     The  Company   believes  that  if  systems  were  not  complaint  for  year
2000-related  problems there could be a material adverse impact on the Company's
financial  statements.  The  Company  believes  that it is taking the  necessary
measures to address issues that may arise relating to year 2000-related problems
and that its systems should be compliant.  The Company realizes,  however,  that
non-compliance  by these parties could impact its business.  The Company's  plan
addresses  potential year 2000 issues related to the processing of  transactions
with third parties.  The possibility  exists that some of the Company's external
business  contacts  may not be  compliant.  The  Company  began  contacting  its
external  business  contacts and continues to do so to determine their status of
compliance and to assess the impact of noncompliance to the Company. The Company
is working  closely with all  critical  business  relationships  to minimize its
exposure to year 2000-related  problems. It should be noted, however, that there
can be no  assurance  that the  systems  of other  companies  will be year  2000
compliant, or that their conversion will be comparable with information included
in the  Company's  systems  without  having a  material  adverse  effect  on the
Company.

     Although  it has  considered  various  scenarios  concerning  the  possible
effects of the year 2000  issue,  the Company  does not have formal  contingency
plans  relating to either its internal  processing  environment  or its external
business  contacts.  As it completes the upgrading and testing of  non-compliant
systems and continues to monitor the status of its important  external  contacts
into mid 1999, the Company will develop  contingency  plans if deemed  necessary
for critical systems and relationships.

     A  comprehensive  review was  performed  by the  Company  of the  insurance
policies written by its Insurance Companies and their underwriting guidelines to
determine Year 2000 exposure.  The Insurance  Companies primarily issue policies
covering  all or  part  of an  insured's  self-insured  retention,  with  limits
generally  up to $25,000,  that follow the form of the  policies for coverage in
excess of the Insurance  Companies'  policies.  The Insurance Companies have not
issued exclusions on these policies.  The Insurance Companies have also issued a
number of policies  with greater  limits of coverage,  and have  included a year
2000 exclusion on such policies. The Company is aware that year 2000 liabilities
may be deemed not to be fortuitous in nature and,  therefore,  not covered under
the policies underwritten by the Insurance Companies.  Moreover,  based upon the
classes of insurance  primarily  underwritten  by the Insurance  Companies,  the
Company  believes  that its coverage  exposure  with respect to year 2000 losses
will not be material.  However, changes in social and legal trends may establish
coverage  unintended  for  year  2000  exposures  by  re-interpreting  insurance
contracts and exclusions.


                                       15
<PAGE>


Ceded Reinsurance

     OLRI has  from  time to time  obtained  reinsurance  for  portions  of,  or
specific  risks  under,  the first  layer of risks  underwritten  by OLRI.  Such
reinsurance  is not and has not  been  material  to OLRI.  Reinsurance  has been
placed with PXRE  Reinsurance  Company and  Transatlantic  Reinsurance  Company,
which are rated A or better by A.M. Best.  However, if reinsurance should become
more widely  available  at  economical  prices,  OLRI may increase the amount of
reinsurance it purchases (see Note 13 to the consolidated  financial  statements
of the Company).

Losses and Loss Expenses

     The  Insurance  Companies  are directly  liable for losses and loss expense
payments  under the terms of insurance  policies that they write,  and under the
reinsurance agreements to which they are party. In many cases, several years may
elapse  between the  occurrence of an insured loss, the reporting of the loss to
the Insurance  Companies and the Insurance  Companies  payment of that loss. The
Insurance  Companies  reflect their  liability  for the ultimate  payment of all
incurred  losses  and loss  expenses  by  establishing  loss  and  loss  expense
reserves,  which are balance sheet liabilities  representing estimates of future
amounts needed to pay claims and related expenses with respect to insured events
that have occurred.

     When a claim involving a probable loss is reported, the Insurance Companies
establish a loss reserve for the estimated  amount of the  Insurance  Companies'
ultimate  loss and loss  expense  payments.  The  estimate  reflects an informed
judgment  based  on  established  reserving  practices  and the  experience  and
knowledge of CAC's claims examiners regarding the nature and value of the claim,
as well as the  estimated  expense of settling  the claim,  including  legal and
other fees, and general expenses of administering the claims adjustment process.
The Insurance Companies also establish reserves on an aggregate basis to provide
for  losses  incurred  but not  reported  ("IBNR  reserves"),  as well as future
developments  on losses  reported to the Insurance  Companies.  The amount of an
insurer's  incurred  losses in a given period is determined by adding losses and
loss expenses paid during the period to case loss and loss expense  reserves and
IBNR reserves  (collectively "loss reserves") at the end of the period, and then
subtracting loss reserves existing at the beginning of the period.

     As  part  of  the  reserving  process,  historical  data  is  reviewed  and
consideration is given to the anticipated  effect of various factors,  including
anticipated  legal  developments,  changes in social  attitudes,  inflation  and
economic  conditions.  Reserve  amounts are  necessarily  based on  Management's
estimates,  and as other data becomes available and is reviewed, these estimates
are revised, resulting in increases or decreases to existing reserves.



                                       16
<PAGE>


     OLRI  receives  claims  related to lead paint  exposures  it insures  under
various Residential Real Estate Programs.  There are uncertainties in estimating
the  amount  of  reserves  due to  factors  including:  difficulty  in  properly
allocating responsibility and/or liability for the lead paint exposure;  changes
in the  underlying  laws and the  judicial  interpretation  of those  laws;  and
questions   regarding  the  interpretation  and  application  of  insurance  and
reinsurance  coverage.  OLRI has reserves established for these claims on a case
basis  and an  incurred  but not  reported  basis.  The  reserves  provided  are
established based on Management's estimate of ultimate liabilities. However, due
to the nature of the exposures, such reserves cannot be, and are not established
using standard actuarial techniques.

     To further  review the adequacy of the reserves,  the  Insurance  Companies
engage  independent  actuarial  consultants  to perform annual case and ultimate
loss reserve analysis.

     The  following  table  sets  forth a  reconciliation  of the  change in the
reserves for  outstanding  losses and loss  expenses,  including paid losses and
loss expenses, for each year in the three year period ended December 31, 1998.


                                                    Years Ended December 31,
                                                --------------------------------
                                                  1998        1997        1996
                                                --------    --------    --------
                                                          (in thousands)

Balance at January 1,                           $ 19,126    $ 15,227    $ 12,671
         Less reinsurance recoverables            (2,811)       (882)
                                                --------    --------    --------
         Net balance                              16,315      14,345      12,671
                                                --------    --------    --------

Incurred related to:
         Current year                              8,461       8,824       6,621
         Prior years                                  35        (108)        415
                                                --------    --------    --------
         Total incurred                            8,496       8,716       7,036
                                                --------    --------    --------

Paid related to:
         Current year                              1,877       1,802       1,832
         Prior years                               4,587       4,944       3,530
                                                --------    --------    --------
         Total paid                                6,464       6,746       5,362
                                                --------    --------    --------

Net balance at December 31,                       18,347      16,315      14,345
         Plus reinsurance recoverables             3,220       2,811         882
                                                --------    --------    --------

         Balance                                $ 21,567    $ 19,126    $ 15,227
                                                ========    ========    ========


                                       17
<PAGE>


     The  following  table  presents the  development  of unpaid losses and loss
expense reserves for the past ten years for the Insurance Companies.  During the
ten year period covered by this table,  OLB changed its fiscal  year-end  during
1989  from  July 31 to  April  30 and then to  December  31 for the  year  ended
December 31, 1990. In addition,  Bermuda domiciled insurance  companies,  unlike
U.S. domiciled insurers, are not required to file calendar year loss development
information  with  regulatory  authorities.  Accordingly,  the loss  development
information  included in the following  table with respect to OLB prior to 1992,
reflects  development  data converted from the policy year loss development data
maintained by OLB through the use of  mathematical  models.  The top line of the
table shows the  estimated  reserve for unpaid  losses and loss  expenses at the
balance sheet date for each of the indicated years.  These figures represent the
estimated  amount of unpaid losses and loss  expenses for claims  arising in the
current  and all  prior  years  that  were  unpaid at the  balance  sheet  date,
including  losses that had been  incurred but not yet  reported.  The table also
shows  the  re-estimated  amount of the  previously  recorded  reserve  based on
experience as of the end of each succeeding  year. The estimate  changes as more
information  becomes  available,  principally  about the frequency of claims for
individual  years. The table is presented net of reinsurance which is immaterial
for all years presented except for 1998 and 1997. The reinsurance recoverable on
unpaid  losses at December  31, 1998 and 1997 were  $3,220,000  and  $2,811,000,
respectively.



                                       18
<PAGE>


KAYE GROUP INC.
LOSS DEVELOPMENT SCHEDULE
(In thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
          Year Ended            1988     1989      1990       1991     1992     1993      1994     1995     1996      1997    1998
          ----------            ----     ----      ----       ----     ----     ----      ----     ----     ----      ----    ----
<S>                             <C>      <C>      <C>       <C>       <C>      <C>       <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>
Reserves for outstanding
  losses and loss expenses
  on December 31,               $6,866   $8,418   $12,555   $16,244   $18,444  $17,929   $14,118  $12,672  $15,227  $19,126  $21,567


Cumulative amount paid as of:

     One year later             $2,018   $2,505    $4,374    $5,569    $6,379   $6,965    $4,161   $3,697   $4,943   $4,587
     Two years later             3,513    5,266     7,545     9,258    11,704   10,002     6,802    6,882    7,780
     Three years later           5,208    7,041     9,245    12,695    13,833   12,278     9,455    8,691
     Four years later            6,113    7,600    11,378    13,813    14,973   14,120    10,917
     Five years later            6,269    8,539    11,705    14,146    15,784   15,281
     Six years later             6,881    8,660    11,768    14,385    16,374
     Seven years later           6,892    8,681    11,877    14,562
     Eight years later           6,895    8,701    11,917
     Nine years later            6,903    8,720
     Ten years later             6,909


Re-estimated liability as of:

     One year later             $6,891   $9,127   $13,665   $16,117   $18,140  $17,856   $14,254  $12,257  $15,494  $18,534
     Two years later             6,692    9,767    13,003    15,182    18,511   18,184    13,487   12,454   15,352
     Three years later           7,343    9,288    11,850    15,609    18,636   16,552    13,990   12,448
     Four years later            7,228    9,002    12,410    15,462    18,177   18,157    13,985
     Five years later            7,120    9,060    12,468    15,312    18,252   17,993
     Six years later             7,140    8,973    12,224    14,982    17,999
     Seven years later           7,063    8,893    12,121    14,872
     Eight years later           6,964    8,847    11,996
     Nine years later            7,012    8,733
     Ten years later             6,909


Cumulative
Redundancy (Deficiency):          ($43)   ($315)     $559    $1,373      $445     ($64)     $133     $225    ($125)    $593
</TABLE>


                                       19
<PAGE>


Regulation

     The  Company is  subject  to a  substantial  degree of  regulation  that is
designed to protect the interests of insurance policyholders.  As a Rhode Island
property  and  casualty  insurance  company,  OLRI is  primarily  subject to the
regulatory  oversight  of the Rhode  Island  Department  of Business  Regulation
through its Insurance Division.

     As a Bermuda  property and casualty  insurance  company,  OLB is subject to
regulation of the regulatory body of Bermuda.  Such regulation relates to, among
other things, authorized lines of business, capital and surplus requirements and
general standards of solvency,  the filing of annual and other financial reports
prepared on the basis of statutory accounting practices,  the filing and form of
actuarial  reports,  the  establishment and maintenance of reserves for unearned
premiums,  losses  and  loss  expenses,  underwriting  limitations,   investment
parameters,  transactions  with  affiliates,  dividend  limitations,  changes in
control and a variety of other financial and non-financial matters.

     The  National   Association  of  Insurance   Commissioners   has  developed
risk-based capital formulas to be applied to all domestic  insurance  companies.
These formulas  calculate a minimum required  statutory net worth,  based on the
underwriting,  investment  and other  business  risks  inherent in an  insurance
company's  operations.  Any  insurance  company  that  does not  meet  threshold
risk-based  capital levels ultimately will be subject to statutory  receivership
proceedings. The statutory net worth of OLRI is adequate in light of its current
and  anticipated  future  business and OLRI has met its  risk-based  capital and
surplus  requirements  at  December  31,  1998.  The  authorized  control  level
risk-based  capital for OLRI,  as of December 31, 1998 was  $4,403,083  and OLRI
exceeded that threshold by $23,463,514.

Employees

     As of December 31, 1998, the Company had 368 employees.  The Company is not
unionized and believes that its employee relationships are satisfactory.


                                       20
<PAGE>


Item 2.  Properties

     The  Company  owns  approximately  7,500  square feet of space in an office
condominium building in Warwick,  Rhode Island which is utilized by employees of
PBC and OLRI.  The Company  also  leases  space  located in New York,  New York,
Pasadena,  California,  Westport,  Connecticut,  Woodbury,  New York, Hollywood,
Florida,  and Floral Park, New York.  The Company's  total leased space at these
locations is  approximately  114,000 square feet and is suitable for its current
needs.

Item 3.  Legal Proceedings

     The  Company  is a party  to  lawsuits  arising  in the  normal  course  of
business.  Virtually all pending lawsuits in which the Insurance Companies are a
party,  involve  claims  under  policies   underwritten  or  reinsured  by  such
Companies.  Management believes these lawsuits have been adequately provided for
in its  established  loss and loss expense  reserves and that the  resolution of
these  lawsuits  will  not  have a  material  adverse  effect  on the  Company's
financial condition or results of operations.

     The  Insurance  Brokerage  Companies  are  subject  to  various  claims and
lawsuits from both private and  governmental  parties,  which include claims and
lawsuits in the ordinary  course of business.  The majority of pending  lawsuits
involve insurance claims,  errors and omissions,  employment claims and breaches
of contract. The Company believes that the resolution of these lawsuits will not
have a material adverse effect on the Company's  financial  condition or results
of operations.

     As licensed brokers,  the Insurance  Brokerage  Companies are or may become
party to  administrative  inquiries and at times to  administrative  proceedings
commenced  by state  insurance  regulatory  bodies.  Certain  subsidiaries  were
involved in an  administrative  investigation  commenced in 1992 by the New York
Insurance Department  ("Department") relating to how property insurance policies
were issued for the Residential Real Estate Program.  As a result, the manner in
which policies are  structured for certain  clients in this Program was altered,
which has not had a material  adverse effect on this Program.  While the Company
had discussions with the Department  regarding settlement of such investigation,
this matter has not been pursued for several years.  If the matter is not closed
or settled,  the  Department  could  institute  formal  proceedings  against the
subsidiaries  seeking fines or license  revocation.  Management does not believe
the resolution of this issue will have a material adverse effect on the Company.

Item 4.  Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders

     No matters  were  submitted  to a vote of  security  holders of the Company
during the fourth quarter of the fiscal year ended December 31, 1998.




                                       21
<PAGE>


                                     PART II

Item 5. Market for Common Equity and Related Stockholder Matters

     In  August  1993,  in  connection  with the  consummation  of the IPO,  the
Company's Common Stock was listed on the NASDAQ National Market System under the
symbol  "OLHC".  On October 2, 1995, in connection  with the  combination of the
Retail Brokerage Business of Kaye with Holding, Holding changed its name to Kaye
Group Inc. and is now listed under its new symbol  "KAYE".  The following  table
sets forth the closing  high and low prices for the Common  Stock as reported on
NASDAQ for the indicated  periods and the  dividends  paid per share during such
periods.

                                              Price Range             Dividends
                                        ----------------------           Paid
                                          High           Low          Per Share
                                          ----           ---          ---------

    1998:
First Quarter                           $7 13/16        $6 1/4       $ .025 cash
Second Quarter                             7 1/2         6 3/8       $ .025 cash
Third Quarter                              7 1/4         6 1/4       $ .025 cash
Fourth Quarter                             7 5/8         5 1/8       $ .025 cash

    1997:
First Quarter                             $5 3/8        $4 1/2       $ .025 cash
Second Quarter                             5 1/8         4 3/8       $ .025 cash
Third Quarter                              9             5 1/8       $ .025 cash
Fourth Quarter                             9             6 3/8       $ .025 cash


     The approximate  number of holders of record of the Company's  Common Stock
as of March 12, 1999 was 103.

     See Item 7 - "Management's  Discussion and Analysis of Financial  Condition
and Results of Operations - Dividends" for a discussion of dividends paid by the
Company.


                                       22
<PAGE>


Item 6.  Selected Financial Data

The following  table should be read in conjunction  with, and is supplemented in
its entirety by, the  consolidated  financial  statements and the notes thereto.
Financial data has been restated to take into effect the Transactions  effective
October 2, 1995.  The  financial  data for the years 1994  through 1998 has been
derived from the audited consolidated financial statements of the Company.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                               Years ended December 31,
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                           1998           1997           1996           1995              1994
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                        (in thousands, except per share data)
<S>                                                      <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>               <C>
Revenues:
Operating revenues (6)                                   $ 60,191       $ 55,309       $ 51,339       $ 51,582          $ 52,906
Net investment income                                       4,735          4,312          3,576          3,912             3,455
Net realized gains (losses) on investments                     85             21             72            (47)              (50)
                                                         --------       --------       --------       --------          --------

Total revenues                                           $ 65,011       $ 59,642       $ 54,987       $ 55,447          $ 56,311
                                                         --------       --------       --------       --------          --------


Net income                                               $  7,282       $  4,357       $  3,071       $  5,181          $  4,347
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Earnings per share:
  Basic                                                  $   0.86       $   0.62       $   0.44       $   0.74          $   0.62
  Diluted                                                $   0.85       $   0.62       $   0.44       $   0.74          $   0.62
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

PRO FORMA NET INCOME
  Income before minority interest,
  income taxes and cumulative effect
  of change in accounting principles                     $ 10,554       $  7,555       $  5,211       $  6,309          $  6,516

  Provision for income taxes                                3,272          2,267          1,484          1,995(1)          1,861(1)
                                                         --------       --------       --------       --------          --------

  Income before minority interest and
  cumulative effect of change in
  accounting principles                                     7,282          5,288          3,727          4,314             4,655

  Minority interest                                                         (931)          (656)          (759)           (1,011)

  Cumulative effect of change in
  accounting principles, net of charge
  in lieu of income taxes (2)                                                                                              1,090
                                                         --------       --------       --------       --------          --------

  Pro forma net income                                   $  7,282       $  4,357       $  3,071       $  3,555          $  4,734
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

PRO FORMA EARNINGS PER SHARE - BASIC
  Income before cumulative effect
  of change in accounting principles                     $   0.86       $   0.62       $   0.44       $   0.51          $   0.52

  Cumulative effect of change in
  accounting principles, net of charge
  in lieu of income taxes                                                                                                   0.15
                                                         --------       --------       --------       --------          --------

  Pro forma earnings per share - basic                   $   0.86       $   0.62       $   0.44       $   0.51          $   0.67
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Weighted average of shares
outstanding - basic                                         8,474          7,024          7,020          7,020             7,020
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Weighted average of shares and
share equivalents outstanding - diluted                     8,593          7,083          7,021          7,023             7,035
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>


                                       23
<PAGE>



Item 6.  Selected Financial Data (Continued)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            Years ended December 31,
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                   1998               1997             1996             1995               1994
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                  (in thousands, except per share data and ratios)
<S>                                             <C>               <C>               <C>               <C>               <C>
Balance Sheet data:
Total assets                                    $   167,066       $   141,025       $   156,102       $   174,000       $   185,976
Long-term debt (3)                                    4,672             5,810            12,787            13,679            11,618
Stockholders' equity                                 41,769            35,168            24,984            22,882            16,676
Net book value  per share (4)                          4.93              4.15              3.56              3.26              2.38
Cash dividend per share                                0.10              0.10              0.10              0.10              0.10

GAAP operating data:
Loss ratio                                             34.4%             38.2%             36.4%             28.8%             31.8%
Expense ratio                                          39.3%             41.0%             42.5%             41.1%             32.9%
Combined ratio                                         73.7%             79.2%             78.9%             69.9%             64.7%

Statutory operating data (5):
Net underwriting gain                           $     6,925       $     5,890       $     4,455       $     7,104       $     7,105
Policyholders' surplus                               29,286            25,566            25,485            26,231            22,274

Loss ratio                                             33.1%             36.6%             34.1%             24.4%             30.2%
Expense ratio                                          39.1%             38.6%             40.0%             37.1%             35.5%
Combined ratio                                         72.2%             75.2%             74.1%             61.5%             65.7%
</TABLE>

(1)  Prior  to  the  Transaction   certain  entities  were   partnerships  or  S
     Corporations  under the Internal  Revenue Code and therefore not liable for
     Federal  income taxes.  A charge in lieu of income taxes is presented as if
     the income of these  entities were taxed to those  entities  rather than to
     partners  or   stockholders   not  otherwise   included  in  the  Company's
     consolidated group.

(2)  Commission  income,  together  with the related  accounts  receivable  from
     clients and premiums payable to insurance carriers, is recorded principally
     as of the billing date.  Beginning in 1994,  commission  income  related to
     installment  billing  arrangements  is recorded in total at the date of the
     initial billing. This change was made because in the opinion of management,
     it results in a better  matching of revenues with the related costs.  Prior
     to this change,  commissions  were recorded as each installment was billed.
     As a result of this  change,  additional  commissions  of  $1,471,000  were
     recorded  in 1994 that  would  have been  recorded  under the old policy in
     1995.  The  Company was unable to  determine  the effects of this change in
     years prior to 1994 and, therefore,  pro forma disclosure of this change in
     prior  years  cannot be made.  Accordingly,  the  effect  of the  change in
     accounting on prior years of $ 1,652,000 was treated as a cumulative effect
     adjustment on the 1994 consolidated statement of income.

(3)  Excludes that portion of long-term debt maturing in less than one year.

(4)  Based upon 8,474,435  shares  outstanding at December 31, 1998 and 1997 and
     7,020,000 outstanding at December 31, 1996, 1995 and 1994.

(5)  Based upon  statutory  accounting  practices and derived from the statutory
     financial statements of the Insurance Companies, which excludes the effects
     of CAC.

(6)  Subsequent to 1995, commission expense paid to internal producers have been
     reclassified  to salary  expense to more  accurately  reflect  salaries and
     benefits. Previously this expense was netted against operating revenues and
     accordingly operating revenues for 1995 and 1994 are not comparable.

(7)  Certain prior year  information  has been  reclassified to conform with the
     1998 presentation.


                                       24
<PAGE>


Item 7. Management's  Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results
        of Operations

General

     Kaye Group Inc.  (the  "Company"),  a  Delaware  corporation,  is a holding
company  which,  through  its  subsidiaries,  is  engaged  in a broad  range  of
insurance brokerage,  underwriting and related activities.  The Company operates
in two insurance business segments the Insurance Brokerage Companies  Operations
comprised of the Retail Brokerage  Business and the Program Brokerage  Business,
and the Property  and  Casualty  Companies  Operations  ("Property  and Casualty
Companies"  or  "Insurance"),  comprised of the  Insurance  Companies and Claims
Administration  (see  Note 1 to the  consolidated  financial  statements  of the
Company).

Overview

     The Insurance  Brokerage  Companies  derive their revenue  principally from
commissions  associated  with the placement of insurance  coverage for corporate
clients.  These commissions are paid by the insurance carriers and are usually a
fixed  percentage  of the  total  premiums.  Certain  of these  commissions  are
contingent upon the level of volume and profitability of the related coverage to
the insurance  companies.  There is normally a lag between receipt of funds from
the insured and payment to the insurance company. Investment of these funds over
this period generates additional revenue in the form of interest income.

     The Insurance business underwrites property and casualty risks for insureds
in the United States, principally through specially designed Programs,  covering
various   types  of   businesses   and   properties   which  have  similar  risk
characteristics. The Insurance business generally underwrites the first layer of
insurance under the Programs and unaffiliated  Program insurers provide coverage
for losses  above the first layer of risk.  Substantially  all of the  Insurance
business  revenues  are  derived  from  premiums  on  this  business,  plus  the
investment  income  generated  by the  investment  portfolio  of  the  Insurance
business.

     Corporate  Operations  include those activities that benefit the Company in
its  entirety  and cannot be  specifically  identified  to either the  Insurance
Brokerage  Companies or the Property and  Casualty  Companies.  Such  activities
include debt servicing and public company expenses, including investor relations
costs.

     The Company has foreign  operations in Bermuda.  For further discussion see
Note 23 to the consolidated financial statements of the Company.


                                       25
<PAGE>


Results of Operations

Year ended December 31, 1998 compared with year ended December 31, 1997

Net Income

     Net income for the year ended  December 31, 1998 increased by $2,925,000 to
$7,282,000 or basic  earnings per share of $0.86 compared to $4,357,000 or $0.62
for the same period last year as explained  below.  $931,000 of the increase was
due to the  elimination  of minority  interest  (see Note 2 to the  consolidated
financial statements of the Company).

Insurance Brokerage Companies

     Income before income taxes increased by $938,000 to $1,705,000 in 1998 from
$767,000 in 1997.  The  improved  operating  result was mainly due to  increased
revenues offset by the increase in salaries and benefits, as discussed below.

     Total revenues in 1998 were $37,202,000  compared with $33,782,000 in 1997,
an increase of $3,420,000  (10%).  Gross  commission and fees grew by $4,222,000
(11%) mainly as a result of new business  exceeding lost business,  acquisitions
and an increase in contingency  commissions due to volume and  profitability  of
1997 premiums placed with certain  insurance  carriers.  The commission  expense
rate  incurred to produce new and renewal  business  increased  from 17% to 18%.
Investment  income  increased  in  1998  by  $281,000  (18%)  primarily  due  to
collection  efficiencies  resulting  in a longer  holding  period for  fiduciary
investments.

     Salaries and benefits  increased by $2,418,000 (13%) to $21,323,000 in 1998
compared to $18,905,000 in 1997. This increase was due to  acquisitions,  salary
increments, increased commission expense to employees and annual incentive based
compensation.

     Amortization  of  intangibles  increased by $172,000 (34%) to $679,000 from
$507,000 in 1997 as a result of increased  amortization  of acquisition  related
intangibles due to 1997 and 1998 acquisitions.

     Other operating  expenses increased by $243,000 (2%) to $13,446,000 in 1998
compared  with  $13,203,000  in 1997.  This  increase was mainly the result of a
reserve for E & O deductibles partially offset by reduced rent costs.

     Interest expense  decreased by $351,000  primarily as a result of the early
payment of the $6,000,000 note payable to KILP in August, 1997.



                                       26
<PAGE>


Property & Casualty Companies

     Income before income taxes  increased by $1,918,000  (25%) to $9,637,000 in
1998 from  $7,719,000  in 1997.  The  increase  in  operating  result was due to
increased net premiums earned, investment income and a decreased combined ratio.

     Net premiums  earned for 1998  increased by $1,842,000  (8%) to $24,689,000
from $22,847,000 in 1997. The Property & Casualty Companies'  efforts,  combined
with the efforts of the Brokerage  segment's Program Brokerage  Corporation,  to
develop new  Alternative  Risk  Transfer  programs and broaden the  distribution
network of the existing  programs and coverage  types,  has  contributed  to the
growth of premium volume.

     Net  investment  income  increased  by  $228,000  (8%) to  $2,920,000  from
$2,692,000  in  1997.  This  increase  was  due to an  increase  in  investments
generated by cash flow from operations.

     Net realized gain on investment  transactions for 1998 increased by $64,000
to $85,000  compared to $21,000 in 1997. The realization of investment gains and
losses is determined by market  conditions and management's  decision  regarding
the holding period of the portfolio.

     Other  income for 1998  decreased by $99,000 to $146,000  from  $245,000 in
1997. This decrease is mainly due to discontinued warranty contracts in 1998.

     Loss and loss  expenses  decreased in 1998 by $220,000  (3%) to  $8,496,000
from $8,716,000 in 1997. The loss ratio (loss incurred expressed as a percentage
of  premiums  earned)  for 1998 and  1997  was 34% and 38%,  respectively.  This
decrease was due to low general  liability losses and an improvement in loss and
loss expense under the property programs resulting from mild weather.

     Acquisition costs and general and administrative expenses increased in 1998
by $337,000  (4%) to  $9,707,000  from  $9,370,000  in 1997.  The expense  ratio
(acquisition  costs and general and  administrative  expenses) for 1998 and 1997
was 39% and 41%,  respectively.  Exclusive of a bad debt recovered,  the expense
ratio would have been 40% and 41%, respectively.  This decrease was due to lower
general and administrative expenses in 1998.

Corporate

     Net expenses  before  income taxes  decreased in 1998 by $143,000  (15%) to
$788,000 from $931,000 in 1997.  This decrease was the result of lower  interest
expense and  insurance  costs  partially  offset by a provision  for  investment
decline and costs related to the  restructuring  of debt.



                                       27
<PAGE>


Year ended December 31, 1997 compared with year ended December 31, 1996

Net Income

     Net income for the year ended  December 31, 1997 increased by $1,286,000 to
$4,357,000 or basic  earnings per share of $0.62 compared to $3,071,000 or $0.44
for the same period last year as explained below.

Insurance Brokerage Companies

     Income before income taxes increased by $1,962,000 to $767,000 in 1997 from
a loss of $1,195,000 in 1996. The improved operating result was due to increased
revenues,  a significant decrease in other operating expenses and lower interest
expense  partially  offset by a modest  increase in salaries  and  benefits,  as
discussed below.

     Total revenues in 1997 were $33,782,000  compared with $32,593,000 in 1996,
an increase of $1,189,000  (4%).  Gross  commission  and fews grew by $1,453,000
(4%) mainly as a result of new business exceeding lost business and acquisitions
partially  offset  by a  decrease  in  wholesale  contingency  commissions.  The
Commission  expense rate incurred to produce new and renewal business  increased
form 15% to 17%. Investment income increased in 1997 by $539,000 (53%) primarily
due  to  collection  efficiencies  resulting  in a  longer  holding  period  for
fiduciary investments.

     Salaries and benefits  increased by $142,000  (1%) to  $18,905,000  in 1997
compared to $18,763,000 in 1996. This increase was the result of the acquisition
of Western  Insurance  Associates,  Inc.  ("WIA")  partially  offset by a modest
reduction in work force due to continued operating efficiencies, lower executive
compensation  and reduced  costs for prior years'  acquisitions.  The  Company's
board  of  directors'  compensation  committee  and  executive  management  have
reviewed and adjusted executive and management  compensation,  respectively,  to
reflect a continued movement toward performance based pay.

     Amortization  of  intangibles  increased by $68,000  (15%) to $507,000 from
$439,000  as  a  result  of  increased   amortization  of  acquisition   related
intangibles due to the acquisition of WIA.

     Other operating  expenses decreased by $783,000 (6%) to $13,203,000 in 1997
compared  with  $13,986,000  in 1996.  This  decrease  was mainly due to reduced
account servicing  expenses,  expiration of certain management service contracts
and reduced insurance costs.



                                       28
<PAGE>


     Interest expense  decreased by $200,000 as a result of the early payment of
the $6,000,000 note payable to KILP in August, 1997.

Property and Casualty Companies

     Income before income taxes increased in 1997 by $668,000 (9%) to $7,719,000
from  $7,051,000 in 1996. The increase in operating  result was due to increased
net premiums earned (net of related  expenses) and investment  income  partially
offset by a decrease in other income, as discussed below.

     Net premiums  earned for 1997 increased by $3,520,000  (18%) to $22,847,000
from  $19,327,000  in 1996.  The Company's  efforts to broaden the  distribution
network of the  Programs  and coverage  types has  contributed  to growth in the
Residential Real Estate and Restaurant Programs and the formation of several new
programs.

     Net investment income in 1997 increased by $231,000 (9%) to $2,692,000 from
$2,461,000 in 1996 as a result of an increase in investments generated from cash
flow from operations.

     Net realized gain on investment  transactions for 1997 decreased by $51,000
to $21,000  compared to $72,000 in 1996. The realization of investment gains and
losses is determined by market  conditions and management's  decision  regarding
the holding period of the portfolio.

     Other income for 1997  decreased by $200,000 to $245,000  from  $445,000 in
1996.  This  decrease  is  mainly  due to the  run-off  of  certain  reinsurance
contracts during the first half of 1996.

     Losses  and  loss  expenses  increased  in  1997  by  $1,680,000  (24%)  to
$8,716,000 from $7,036,000 in 1996. The loss ratio (loss incurred expressed as a
percentage of premiums earned) for 1997 and 1996 was 38% and 36%,  respectively.
This increase was the result of growth in general liability coverage and reserve
strengthening.  The  increase in absolute  dollars was  generally  the result of
increased net premiums earned.

     Acquisition costs and general and administrative expenses increased in 1997
by $1,152,000  (14%) to $9,370,000  from  $8,218,000 in 1996.  The expense ratio
(acquisition  costs and general and  administrative  expenses as a percentage of
premiums earned) for 1997 and 1996 was 41% and 43%, respectively.  This decrease
was due to a modest decrease in general and administrative expenses in 1997. The
increase in  absolute  dollars was due mainly to  additional  acquisition  costs
related to increased net premiums  earned and the write-off of certain  deferred
acquisition  costs  resulting  from the  termination  of a  deposit  reinsurance
contract.  General and administrative expenses had a modest decrease as a result
of lower professional fees.



                                       29
<PAGE>


Corporate

     Net expenses  before  income taxes  increased in 1997 by $286,000  (44%) to
$931,000 from $645,000 in 1996.  This increase was the result of costs  incurred
for acquisition activities and investor relations.

Effective Tax Rate (See Note 8)

     The  effective  tax rate for 1998,  1997,  and 1996 was 31%,  30%, and 28%,
respectively.  The  difference  between the statutory tax rate and the effective
tax rate in 1998,  1997, and 1996 was primarily  related to tax exempt interest.
The rate increase for 1998 and 1997 was  primarily  due to additional  state and
local taxes.

Financial Condition and Liquidity

     Management  believes that the Company's operating cash flow, along with the
cash equivalents and short term investments will provide  sufficient  sources of
liquidity  and capital to meet the Company's  anticipated  needs during the next
twelve months and the foreseeable future. The Company has no capital commitments
that are material individually or in the aggregate.

     Total assets increased by $26,041,000 (18%) to $167,066,000 at December 31,
1998 from  $141,025,000  at December 31, 1997 due primarily to general  business
growth resulting in fiduciary cash and cash equivalents and premiums  receivable
from clients and other insurance agents and brokers. Total liabilities increased
by $19,440,000  (18%) to $125,297,000 at December 31, 1998 from  $105,857,000 at
December  31,  1997  primarily  due to  general  business  growth  resulting  in
increased premiums payable to insurance markets.

     Stockholders'  equity  increased  by  $6,601,000  (19%) to  $41,769,000  at
December 31, 1998, from $35,168,000 at December 31, 1997. The increase in equity
resulted  from net  income  of  $7,282,000  and an  increase  in net  unrealized
appreciation of investments of $168,000,  partially  offset by dividends paid of
$849,000.

     On  December  30,  1997  the   stockholders  of  the  Company   approved  a
restructuring  that merged Kaye Holding  Corp.  ("KHC")  into the Company.  This
eliminated KILP's minority interest in KHC of $6,191,000 as of December 31, 1997
and increased  stockholders'  equity of the Company by the same amount. Prior to
its dissolution in May 1998,  KILP was the Company's  largest  shareholder.  The
merger was  accounted  for as a transfer and  exchange  between  entities  under
common control. Accordingly,  common stock of Kaye Group Inc. issued in exchange
for the KHC shares was accounted for by using the closing NASDAQ market price on
October 24, 1997 ($7.00) (the effective date of the merger).  This increased the
number of shares of common stock by 1,454,435 at the par value $.01 per share or
$14,544. Paid-in capital was increased by $10,166,000 which



                                       30
<PAGE>


was the  difference  between the market  value price per share and the par value
per share.  Minority  interest in KHC was  eliminated as a result of the merger,
and  retained  earnings  of Kaye Group  Inc.  was  reduced  to  account  for the
difference  between the market value of the shares  issued and the book value of
the minority interest in KHC.

     The Company's cash and cash  equivalents  increased by $14,136,000  for the
year ended December 31, 1998.  Operating activities provided cash of $23,188,000
primarily  as a  result  of  premiums  received  from  assureds  not yet paid to
insurance markets.  Investing  activities used cash of $4,443,000  primarily for
fixed asset purchases (primarily software) and acquisition  payments.  Financing
activities   used  cash  of  $4,609,000  for  payments  of  dividends  and  loan
restructuring,  including a reduction of  approximately  $1,100,000 of corporate
debt.

     The Company paid off its  revolving  credit line of $6,094,000  early,  and
replaced it with a term loan of  $5,000,000,  at an interest  rate  reduction of
approximately   50  basis  points,   thereby   reducing  debt  by  approximately
$1,100,000. As of December 31, 1998, $4,456,000 is outstanding on the term loan.
In addition,  the Company has  available a $4,500,000  revolving  line of credit
with a bank.  Both lines are  collateralized  by the stock of the  Property  and
Casualty  Companies.  The proceeds are available for general operating needs and
acquisitions. As of December 31, 1998, no amount is outstanding on the revolving
line of credit.

     The Company has  calculated  risk-based  capital and the result is that the
statutory net worth of OLRI is adequate in light of the current requirements.

     The  Company is subject to a  substantial  degree of  regulation,  which is
designed to protect the interests of insurance policyholders.  As a Rhode Island
property  and  casualty  insurance  company,  OLRI is  primarily  subject to the
regulatory  oversight  of the Rhode  Island  Department  of Business  Regulation
through its Insurance Division.

     The Company's  primary source of cash is derived from  insurance  premiums,
insurance brokerage commissions and fees, proceeds from the sale of investments,
and  investment  income.  The Company's  principal  uses of cash are payments of
insurance premiums,  commissions to brokers who produce the business, losses and
loss expenses and operating expenses, and purchases of investments, acquisitions
and fixed assets.

     The Company has minimized its investment  risk by investing in high quality
tax exempt municipal bonds, U.S. Government and government agency securities and
corporate  bonds  rated  A or  better  by an  accredited  rating  agency  and by
maintaining an average duration of approximately four years, taking into account
the effects of certain early call  features.  The Company  currently  intends to
continue these investment strategies.


                                       31
<PAGE>


     The table below sets forth the  composition  of the Company's  portfolio of
fixed maturity investments by rating as of December 31, 1998 (in thousands):


                                            Market Value as       Percentage of
                        Amortized            Reflected on        Total at Market
Rating (a)                 Cost             Balance Sheet            Value
- ----------              ---------           ---------------      ---------------

AAA(b)                   $22,213               $22,574                51.8%
  AA+                      1,116                 1,124                 2.6%
  AA                      13,177                13,393                30.7%
  AA-                      3,860                 3,883                 8.9%
   A+                        351                   352                  .8%
   A                       2,263                 2,271                 5.2%
                         -------               -------               -----
                         $42,980               $43,597               100.0%
                         =======               =======               =====

(a)  Ratings are  assigned  primarily by Standard & Poors  Corporation  with the
     remaining  ratings  assigned  by  Moody's  Investors  Services,   Inc.  and
     converted to the  equivalent  Standard & Poors  ratings.

(b)  Includes U.S. Government Obligations.

     The  amortized  cost and  estimated  market  value of fixed  maturities  at
December 31, 1998, by  contractual  maturity  date,  are listed below.  Expected
maturities may differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the
right to call or prepay obligations with or without penalties.

                                                   Investments Available
                                                          for Sale
                                            -----------------------------------
                                                                 Aggregate Fair
                                            Amortized Cost            Value
                                            --------------       --------------

Due in one year or less                        $ 3,769               $ 3,774
Due after one year through five years           21,193                21,624
Due after five years through ten years          13,474                13,599
Due after ten years                              4,544                 4,600
                                               -------               -------

Total                                          $42,980               $43,597
                                               =======               =======

     The Company  maintains a  substantial  level of cash and liquid  short term
investments which are used to meet anticipated payment obligations.  At December
31,  1998 and  1997,  the  Company  had  cash  and  short  term  investments  of
$48,393,000 and $34,737,000,  respectively, of which $33,218,000 and $22,322,000
represents  premiums  collected  and  held in a  fiduciary  capacity  which  are
generally not available  for  operating  needs of the Company.  Of the Company's
total invested assets, certain amounts are pledged or deposited into trust funds
to collateralize the Company's obligations under reinsurance agreements.



                                       32
<PAGE>


     Investment results of the Company for each of the three years in the period
ended December 31, 1998 are shown in the following table (in thousands):

                                                          At or for the
                                                    years ended December 31,
                                              ----------------------------------
                                               1998         1997         1996
                                               ----         ----         ----

Average cash and cash equivalents
   and invested assets (1)                    $85,191      $76,534      $68,692

Investment income                              $4,735       $4,312       $3,576

Average yield on total investments                5.6%         5.6%         5.2%

Net realized investment gains                     $85          $21          $72

(1)  Based upon the  average of the  beginning  and end of the period  amortized
     cost for fixed maturities and cost for equity securities.

     The Company's  insurance  subsidiaries  require  capital to support premium
writing.  The  guidelines  set forth by the NAIC  suggest  that a  property  and
casualty   insurer's  ratio  of  annual   statutory  net  premiums   written  to
policyholders'  surplus  should not exceed 3 to 1. At  December  31,  1998,  the
Insurance  Companies,  with a combined  statutory surplus of $29,286,000,  had a
ratio of  combined  annual  statutory  net  premiums  written to their  combined
statutory surplus of approximately .84 to 1.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

     As part of its ongoing  business,  the Company is exposed to certain market
risks of potential  losses from adverse changes in market rates and prices.  The
Company's  primary market risk exposure is interest rate risk in regard to fixed
rate  domestic  instruments  and  outstanding  debt.  The  Company  has  minimal
investments in equity  securities  which have no material  market risk exposure.
The Company has no derivative  instruments.  The Company's financial instruments
consist of the investment  portfolio of OLRI. These instruments are comprised of
Corporate and Municipal Bonds and U.S.  Treasury  Securities that are classified
as available for sale.

     The Company generally selects investment assets with  characteristics  such
as  duration,   yield,   currency,  and  liquidity  to  reflect  the  underlying
characteristics  of related  insurance and  reinsurance  contracts.  The Company
selects medium term fixed rate  investments to support general  liability claims
and shorter investments to support property claims.




                                       33
<PAGE>


     The Company has various debt instruments  outstanding at December 31, 1998.
These debt  instruments,  which are due through 2002,  match the Company's  cash
inflow from operations.

     The following table summarizes  information  about the Company's  financial
instruments  that are  sensitive to changes in interest  rate as of December 31,
1998. The table presents  principal and interest cash flow and related  weighted
average  interest rates by expected  maturity dates for assets and  liabilities.
The Company has presumed the call date as the expected  maturity  date for those
asset  instruments  with call  features.  Weighted  average rates are calculated
using the sum of expected  investment  income or interest expense divided by the
sum of the amortized  cost of assets or the sum of the average debt  outstanding
at each respective period.  For variable rate debt,  expected interest cash flow
is calculated using the December 31, 1998 weighted average interest rate without
any adjustments for projected fluctuations in prime rate.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  EXPECTED CASH FLOW
                                                                                    (in thousands)
                                                       ----------------------------------------------------------------------------

Assets                                   Fair Value    Total Value    1999       2000       2001      2002      2003     Thereafter
- ------                                   ----------    -----------    ----       ----       ----      ----      ----     ----------
<S>                                        <C>           <C>           <C>       <C>        <C>        <C>      <C>      <C>
U.S. Treasury Notes
Interest rates ranging from 5.75% to
6.75%                                      $2,162        $2,424        $580      $862       $299       $39      $644

Weighted average interest rate                             5.6%        6.2%      5.3%       5.5%      6.5%      3.2%

Municipal Bonds with call features
Interest rates ranging from 5% to
12.6%                                      12,268        15,016       2,033     1,328      1,169     2,721     4,228       3,537

Weighted average interest rate                             6.7%        7.1%        7%       6.9%      6.8%      5.2%        6.4%

Municipal Bonds without call features
Interest rates ranging from 3.8% to
10.9%                                      24,444        32,521       2,913     2,265      2,221     4,663     3,737      16,722

Weighted average interest rate                             6.1%        6.1%      6.2%       6.2%      6.1%      6.1%        6.2%

Corporate Bonds
Interest rates ranging from 5.6% to
7.5%                                        4,723         5,287         921     2,350      1,350       428       238

Weighted average interest rate                             6.4%        6.4%      5.0%       5.7%      4.3%      5.9%

Total Fixed Rate Instrument               $43,597       $55,248      $6,447   $ 6,805     $5,039    $7,851    $8,847     $20,259

Weighted average interest rate                             6.2%        6.4%      6.2%       6.3%      6.3%      5.8%        6.2%
</TABLE>


                                       34
<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  EXPECTED CASH FLOW
                                                                                    (in thousands)
                                                       ----------------------------------------------------------------------------

Liabilities                              Fair Value    Total Value    1999       2000       2001      2002      2003     Thereafter
- -----------                              ----------    -----------    ----       ----       ----      ----      ----     ----------
<S>                                        <C>           <C>           <C>       <C>        <C>        <C>      <C>        <C>
Debt - Fixed Rate
Interest rates ranging from 7.4%
to 7.8%                                    $5,052        $5,811      $1,777    $1,623     $1,623      $788

Weighted average interest rate                             8.3%        8.1%      8.2%       8.7%      9.8%


Debt - Variable Rate
Interest rates ranging from
prime to prime +1/2%                        1,492         1,715         546       462        415       292

Weighted average interest rate                             8.2%        8.1%      8.1%       8.5%      7.7%


Total Debt                                 $6,544        $7,526      $2,323    $2,085     $2,038    $1,080

Weighted average interest rate                             8.3%        8.0%      8.2%       8.7%      9.2%
</TABLE>

Dividends

     On December 21, 1998 the Board of Directors  declared a quarterly  dividend
of $.025 per  share,  payable  January  20,  1999 to  stockholders  of record on
December 31, 1998.  The Company is largely  dependent  upon  dividends  from its
insurance  subsidiaries  to pay  dividends to the  stockholders.  The  Company's
insurance subsidiaries are subject to regulations that restrict their ability to
pay dividends.

     Under Rhode Island  Insurance  law, OLRI may pay cash  dividends  only from
earned surplus  determined on a statutory  basis,  subject to the maintenance of
minimum capital and surplus of $3,000,000.  Further,  OLRI is restricted (on the
basis  of the  lesser  of 10% of  OLRI's  statutory  surplus  at the  end of the
preceding  twelve-month period or 100% of OLRI's net income,  excluding realized
capital  gains,  for the  preceding  twelve-month  period)  as to the  amount of
dividends  it  may  declare  or pay in any  twelve-month  period  without  prior
approval of the  Department  of Business  Regulation  of Rhode  Island.  Without
special  permission,   at  December  31,  1998,  $2,786,000  was  available  for
distribution.

     OLB is required to maintain a minimum  statutory  capital and surplus based
upon the higher of $1,000,000  or an amount  derived by applying a variable rate
to its current  premium  volume or  outstanding  losses at December 31, 1998. At
December 31, 1998,  $419,000 was  available  for  distribution  from OLB and its
subsidiary, Park Brokerage Ltd.


                                       35
<PAGE>


     The  continued  payment  and the amount of any cash  dividends  will depend
upon, among other factors,  the Company's  operating results,  overall financial
condition, capital requirements and general business conditions.

Newly Adopted Accounting Standards

     In February 1997, the  Securities  and Exchange  Commission  ("SEC") issued
Financial  Reporting  Release No. 48,  Disclosure  of  Accounting  Policies  for
Derivative  Financial  Instruments  and  Derivative  Commodity  Instruments  and
Disclosure  of  Quantitative  and  Qualitative  Information  about  Market  Risk
Inherent in Derivative Financial Instruments,  Other Financial Instruments,  and
Derivative  Commodity  Instruments  ("FRR No. 48").  FRR No. 48 amends rules and
forms for  registrants  and  requires  clarification  and  expansion of existing
disclosures for derivative financial  instruments,  other financial  instruments
and derivative commodity instruments, as defined therein. The amendments require
enhanced disclosure with respect to these derivative instruments. As of December
31, 1998, the Company has no derivative financial instruments. Additionally, the
amendments expand existing disclosure  requirements to include  quantitative and
qualitative  discussions  with  respect to market  risk  inherent in market risk
sensitive  instruments such as equity and fixed maturity securities,  as well as
derivative instruments which investors can use to better understand and evaluate
market risk exposures of registrants.  These  disclosures were effective in 1998
for the Company and are appropriately disclosed.

     In June 1997, the FASB issued SFAS No. 130, Reporting Comprehensive Income.
This  statement   establishes   standards  for  the  reporting  and  display  of
comprehensive   income  and  its  components  in  the   consolidated   financial
statements.  The  purpose  of  reporting  comprehensive  income is to report the
change in equity of a business  enterprise for the period from  transactions and
other events and circumstances from non-owner  sources.  It includes all changes
in equity during a period except those resulting from  investments by owners and
distributions to owners.  These items include currency  translation  adjustments
and unrealized  appreciation  of  investments,  which are currently  reported as
separate  components  of equity in the balance  sheet.  In  accordance  with the
statement,  the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income are presented as
a separate statement at December 31, 1998, 1997, and 1996.

     Also in June 1997, the FASB issues SFAS No. 131,  Disclosure about Segments
of an Enterprise and Related Information. This statement requires that companies
report  certain  information  about their  operating  segments in the  financial
statements  including  information  about the products  and services  from which
revenues are derived, the geographic areas of operations,  and information about
major customers. Operating segments are determined by the way management decides
how  to  allocate  resources  and  how  it  assesses  performance.   Descriptive
information about the method used to identify the reportable  operating segments
must  also be  disclosed.  The  statement  also  requires  a  reconciliation  of
revenues, net income, and assets and other amounts disclosed for the segments to
the  corresponding  amounts  in  the  consolidated  financial  statements.   The



                                       36
<PAGE>


statement  is  effective  for year end 1998 and has not  changed  the  Company's
current  segmentation  of its  business.  The  financial  position and operating
results of the Company were not affected by this  statement  (see Note 23 to the
consolidated financial statements).

Accounting Standards Not Yet Adopted

     In June 1998, the Financial  Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of
Financial  Accounting  Standards  ("SFAS") No. 133,  Accounting  for  Derivative
Instruments and Hedging  Activities.  This statement requires all derivatives to
be  recognized  as either  assets or  liabilities  in the statement of financial
position and to be measured at fair value.  This  statement is effective for all
fiscal  quarters and fiscal  years  beginning  after June 15,  1999.  Management
believes  that the  statement  will not have a material  impact on the financial
position of the Company.

     In March 1998,  the  American  Institute of  Certified  Public  Accountants
("AICPA") issued Statement of Position ("SOP") 98-1, Accounting for the Costs of
Computer  Software  Developed  or Obtained  for  Internal  Use,  which  requires
capitalization  of external  and certain  internal  costs  incurred to obtain or
develop internal-use computer software during the application development stage.
SOP 98-1 is effective for fiscal years  beginning  after December 15, 1998. This
statement  is not  expected  to  materially  impact the  Company's  consolidated
financial statements.

     In late 1998, the AICPA issued SOP 98-7, Deposit Accounting: Accounting for
Insurance and  Reinsurance  Contracts that Do Not Transfer  Insurance Risk. This
SOP effective for fiscal years beginning after June 15, 1999,  provides guidance
to both the insured and insurer on how to apply the deposit method of accounting
when it is required for insurance and reinsurance contracts that do not transfer
insurance  risk.  This SOP is not expected to  materially  impact the  Company's
consolidated financial statements.

     In December  1997,  the AICPA issued SOP 97-3,  Accounting by Insurance and
Other Enterprises for Insurance-Related  Assessments. SOP 97-3 provides guidance
for assessments related to insurance  activities and requirements for disclosure
of certain  information.  SOP 97-3 is effective for financial  statements issued
for periods beginning after December 31, 1998.  Restatement of previously issued
financial  statements  is not  required.  SOP  97-3  is not  expected  to have a
material impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements.



                                       37
<PAGE>


Year 2000 Compliance

     Many computers,  software programs and microprocessors  embedded in certain
equipment (collectively,  "systems") were designed to accommodate only two-digit
date fields to  represent  a given year  (e.g.,  "98"  represents  1998).  It is
possible  that  such  systems  will  not be  able  to  accurately  process  data
containing  information relating to dates before, during or after the year 2000.
It is possible that such systems could fail entirely, although in many instances
the  consequences  of a system not being "year 2000  complaint" are unknown.  In
response to this issue, the Company has evaluated its applications and operating
software and is in the process of evaluating its hardware and software products,
end  user  computing   activities,   third-party  data  exchanges  and  business
relationships,  and has  established a project team  responsible  for overseeing
progress on the  Company's  compliance  program and  periodically  reporting  to
management.

     As of December 31, 1998 the Company has completed  approximately 75% of its
efforts to bring its own applications software and hardware in compliance,  with
the objective of having all critical  production  systems year 2000 compliant by
the  middle of 1999.  Testing of  critical  applications  is being  accomplished
through the use of a special system testing  environment  that simulates  system
operations  in the year 2000.  The Company also  purchased and  implemented  new
operational  and  accounting  software  in 1998.  In addition to being year 2000
compliant,  these new systems are intended to add increased functionality to the
Company.  The Company has  completed  its  assessment  of its servers and client
server operating software. The results of this assessment were identification of
hardware and software issues requiring  remediation in order to assure year 2000
compliance.

     The  total  cost  (both  current  and  future)  to  modify  these  existing
production  systems,   which  includes  both  internal  and  external  costs  of
programming,  coding  and  testing  is  estimated  to be  $135,000  and has been
reflected in the financial statements.

     In addition to addressing hardware/software  information technology ("IT"),
the Company  has also been  assessing  year 2000  issues with  respect to non-IT
systems  such as  telephones  and various  building  services  which may rely on
embedded  microprocessors.  Although failure of non-IT systems such as telephone
service could disrupt the Company's business, the Company's  communications with
the relevant vendors have not identified any significant year 2000 problems.

     The  Company   believes  that  if  systems  were  not  complaint  for  year
2000-related  problems there could be a material adverse impact on the Company's
financial  statements.  The  Company  believes  that it is taking the  necessary
measures to address issues that may arise relating to year 2000-related problems
and that its systems should be compliant.  The Company realizes,  however,  that
non-compliance  by these parties could impact its business.  The Company's  plan
addresses  potential year 2000 issues related to the processing of  transactions
with third parties.  The possibility  exists that some of the Company's external
business contacts may not be compliant. The Company began



                                       38
<PAGE>


contacting  its external  business  contacts and continues to do so to determine
their  status of  compliance  and to assess the impact of  noncompliance  to the
Company. The Company is working closely with all critical business relationships
to minimize  its  exposure to year  2000-related  problems.  It should be noted,
however, that there can be no assurance that the systems of other companies will
be year  2000  compliant,  or that  their  conversion  will be  comparable  with
information  included in the Company's systems without having a material adverse
effect on the Company.

     Although  it has  considered  various  scenarios  concerning  the  possible
effects of the year 2000  issue,  the Company  does not have formal  contingency
plans  relating to either its internal  processing  environment  or its external
business  contacts.  As it completes the upgrading and testing of  non-compliant
systems and continues to monitor the status of its important  external  contacts
into mid 1999, the Company will develop  contingency  plans if deemed  necessary
for critical systems and relationships.

     A  comprehensive  review was  performed  by the  Company  of the  insurance
policies written by its Insurance Companies and their underwriting guidelines to
determine year 2000 exposure.  The Insurance  Companies primarily issue policies
covering  all or  part  of an  insured's  self-insured  retention,  with  limits
generally  up to $25,000,  that follow the form of the  policies for coverage in
excess of the Insurance  Companies'  policies.  The Insurance Companies have not
issued exclusions on these policies.  The Insurance Companies have also issued a
number of policies  with greater  limits of coverage,  and have  included a year
2000 exclusion on such policies. The Company is aware that year 2000 liabilities
may be deemed not to be fortuitous in nature and,  therefore,  not covered under
the policies underwritten by the Insurance Companies.  Moreover,  based upon the
classes of insurance  primarily  underwritten  by the Insurance  Companies,  the
Company  believes  that its coverage  exposure  with respect to year 2000 losses
will not be material.  However, changes in social and legal trends may establish
coverage  unintended  for  Year  2000  exposures  by  re-interpreting  insurance
contracts and exclusions.

Safe Harbor Disclosure

     The  Private  Securities  Litigation  Reform  Act of 1995  provides a "safe
harbor" for forward-looking  statements. This SEC Form 10-K or any other written
or  oral   statements   made  by  or  on  behalf  of  the  Company  may  include
forward-looking  statements  which  reflect  the  Company's  current  views with
respect  to future  events  and  financial  performance.  These  forward-looking
statements  are subject to certain  uncertainties  and other  factors that could
cause  actual  results  to  differ   materially  from  such  statements.   These
uncertainties and other factors (which are described in more detail elsewhere in
documents  filed by the Company with the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission)
include,  but are not limited  to,  uncertainties  relating to general  economic
conditions  and  cyclical  industry   conditions,   uncertainties   relating  to
government  and regulatory  policies,  volatile and  unpredictable  developments
(including storms and catastrophes), the legal environment, the uncertainties of
the reserving process and the competitive environment in



                                       39
<PAGE>


which  the  Company  operates.  The  words  "believe",  "expect",  "anticipate",
"project", "plan", and similar expressions, identify forward-looking statements.
Readers  are  cautioned  not to place undue  reliance  on these  forward-looking
statements,  which  speak only as of their  dates.  The  Company  undertakes  no
obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements,  whether
as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.

Item 8.   Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

          See page F-1.


Item 9.   Changes  in and  Disagreements  with  Accountants  on  Accounting  and
          Financial Disclosure

          None.


                                    PART III

Item 10.  Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant

     Reference is made to the Registrant's  definitive  proxy  statement,  which
will be filed with the Securities and Exchange  Commission within 120 days after
December 31, 1998, and which is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 11.  Executive Compensation

     Reference is made to the Registrant's  definitive  proxy  statement,  which
will be filed with the Securities and Exchange  Commission within 120 days after
December 31, 1998, and which is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 12.  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management

     Reference is made to the Registrant's  definitive  proxy  statement,  which
will be filed with the Securities and Exchange  Commission within 120 days after
December 31, 1998, and which is incorporated herein by reference.



                                       40
<PAGE>


Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions

     Reference is made to the Registrant's  definitive  proxy  statement,  which
will be filed with the Securities and Exchange  Commission within 120 days after
December 31, 1998, and which is incorporated herein by reference.


                                     PART IV

Item 14. Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules and Reports on Form 8-K

(a)  Financial statements and schedules.

     1.   Financial Statements:

          Report of Independent Accountants

          Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 1998 and 1997

          Consolidated  Statements  of Income for the years ended  December  31,
          1998, 1997 and 1996

          Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31,
          1998, 1997 and 1996

          Consolidated  Statements of  Stockholders'  Equity for the years ended
          December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996

          Consolidated  Statements of  Comprehensive  Income for the years ended
          December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996

          Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     2.   Financial Statement Schedules:

          Schedule II -- Condensed Financial Information of Registrant:

                         Balance Sheets at December 31, 1998 and 1997

                         Statements of Income  for the years  ended December 31,
                         1998, 1997 and 1996

                         Statements  of Cash Flows for the years ended  December
                         31, 1998, 1997 and 1996



                                       41
<PAGE>


                         Notes to Condensed Financial Statements

          Schedule IV -- Reinsurance for the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997
                         and 1996

          Schedule VI -- Supplemental   Information  Concerning   Property   and
                         Casualty  Insurance  Operations  for  the  years  ended
                         December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996

     The   information  for  Schedule  I  is  contained  in  the  Notes  to  the
     Consolidated  Financial  Statements.  The  information  for Schedule III is
     included in Schedule  VI. The  information  required  for Schedule V is not
     applicable.

     3.   Exhibits:


Exhibit
Number   Description

2         Acquisition  Agreement,  dated as of August 3, 1995,  among Kaye Group
          Inc.   (formerly  known  as  Old  Lyme  Holding   Corporation),   Kaye
          International,  L.P.,  certain  individuals and Kaye Holding Corp.,( a
          copy of  which  was  filed  with the  Commission  on  March  31,  1995
          (Registration No. 33-64664),  and which is incorporated herein by this
          reference).

3 (i)     Certificate of Incorporation of Kaye Group Inc. (formerly known as Old
          Lyme  Holding  Corporation)  (a copy  of  which  was  filed  with  the
          Commission   on  June  17,  1993  as  Exhibit  3.1  to  the  Company's
          Registration  Statement on Form S-1 (Registration  No. 33-64664),  and
          which is incorporated herein by this reference).

3 (ii)    By-laws  of Kaye  Group  Inc.  (formerly  known  as Old  Lyme  Holding
          Corporation)  (a copy of which was filed with the  Commission  on June
          17, 1993 as Exhibit 3.2 to the  Company's  Registration  Statement  on
          Form S-1 (Registration No. 33-64664), and which is incorporated herein
          by this reference).

4.1       Form of certificate representing shares of Common Stock of the Company
          (a copy of which  was filed  with the  Commission  on March  31,  1995
          (Registration No. 33-64664),  and which is incorporated herein by this
          reference).


                                       42
<PAGE>


10.1      Kaye Group Inc. (formerly known as Old Lyme Holding  Corporation) 1993
          Stock  Option Plan (a copy of which was filed with the  Commission  on
          August 17, 1993 as Exhibit  10.6 to Amendment  No. 3 to the  Company's
          Registration  Statement on Form S-1 (Registration  No. 33-64664),  and
          which is incorporated herein by this reference).

10.1 (i)  Kaye Group Inc.  Supplemental  Stock  Option Plan (a copy of which was
          filed with the  Commissioner on March 31, 1997)  (Registration  No.33-
          64664),  as Exhibit  10.1(i) to the Company's  Form 10-K, and which is
          incorporated herein by this reference).

10.2      Registration  Agreement  among Kaye Group Inc.  (formerly known as Old
          Lyme  Holding  Corporation),  Kaye  International,  L.P.  and Old Lyme
          Holdings  of Rhode  Island,  Inc.  (a copy of which was filed with the
          Commission  on August 17, 1993 as Exhibit 10.7 to  Amendment  No. 3 to
          the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 33-
          64664), and which is incorporated herein by this reference).

10.11     Loan Agreement  among Summit Bank and Kaye Group Inc.,  dated June 24,
          1998.

10.17     Executive  Employment  Agreement  between Kaye Group Inc. and Bruce D.
          Guthart,  dated as of  January 2, 1997 (a copy of which was filed with
          the  Commission  on March 31,  1997,  (Registration  No.33-64664),  as
          Exhibit 10.17 to the Company's  Form 10-K,  and which is  incorporated
          herein by this reference).

10.18     Employment  Agreement  between Kaye Group Inc. and Michael P. Sabanos,
          dated  as of May 15,  1996  (a  copy  of  which  was  filed  with  the
          Commission on March 31, 1997, (Registration  No.33-64664),  as Exhibit
          10.18 to the Company's Form 10-K, and which is incorporated  herein by
          this reference).

10.18(i)  Amendment of Employment  Agreement between Kaye Group Inc. and Michael
          Sabanos, dated as of March 18, 1998.

10.20     Executive Employment Agreement between Kaye Insurance Associates, Inc.
          and  Richard  Bass,  dated as of October 31, 1991 (a copy of which was
          filed with the  Commission  on March 31,  1997,  (Registration  No.33-
          64664),  as Exhibit  10.20 to the  Company's  Form 10-K,  and which is
          incorporated herein by this reference).


                                       43
<PAGE>


10.20(i)  Amendment to Executive  Employment  Agreement  between Kaye  Insurance
          Associates,  Inc. and Richard  Bass,  dated as of December 11, 1995 (a
          copy of which  was  filed  with the  Commission  on  March  31,  1997,
          (Registration No.33-64664), as Exhibit 10.20 (i) to the Company's Form
          10-K, and which is incorporated herein by this reference).

10.21     Kaye Group Inc. Stock  Performance  Plan, dated as of October 2, 1997.
          (a copy of which was filed with the Commission on December 8, 1997, as
          Annex  B  to  Schedule  14(a),  Information  to  the  Company's  Proxy
          Statement, pursuant to Section 14(a), and which is incorporated herein
          by this reference).

10.22     Asset  Purchase  Agreement  between Kaye Insurance  Associates,  Inc.,
          Seaman,  Ross  &  Weiner,   Inc.,  AMSCO  Coverage  Corp.  and  D.S.I.
          Associates, Inc., dated as of January 1, 1999.

11        Statement regarding computation of earnings per share.

27        Financial Data Schedule


(b)       Reports on Form 8-K

Exhibit
- -------

99.5      Kaye Group Inc.  (the  "Company")  announced  on December 17, 1998 the
          authorization of a stock repurchase of its Common Stock.


                                       44
<PAGE>


                                   SIGNATURES

     Pursuant  to the  requirements  of  Section  13 or 15(d) of the  Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on
its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

                                          KAYE GROUP INC.

                                          By:/ s / Bruce D. Guthart
                                          --------------------------------------
                                          Bruce D. Guthart,  Chairman

Dated: March 26, 1999


     Pursuant to the  requirements  of the  Securities  Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended,  this report has been signed by the following persons in the capacities
and on the dates indicated.

Signature                         Title                                Date

/ s / Bruce D. Guthart        Director, Chairman, President
- ---------------------------   Chief Executive Officer
Bruce D. Guthart              (Principal Executive Officer)       March 26, 1999


/ s / Howard Kaye             Director                            March 26, 1999
- ---------------------------
Howard Kaye


/ s / Michael P. Sabanos      Director, Senior Vice President,
- ---------------------------   Chief Financial Officer (Principal
Michael P. Sabanos            Financial Officer and Accounting
                              Officer)                            March 26, 1999


/ s / Robert Barbanell        Director                            March 26, 1999
- ---------------------------
Robert Barbanell


/ s / Richard Butler          Director                            March 26, 1999
- ---------------------------
Richard Butler


/ s / David Ezekiel           Director                            March 26, 1999
- ---------------------------
David Ezekiel


/ s / Elliot Cooperstone      Director                            March 26, 1999
- ---------------------------
Elliot Cooperstone


/ s / Ned Sherwood            Director                            March 26, 1999
- ---------------------------
Ned Sherwood



                                       45
<PAGE>


Item 8.  Financial Statements and Supplementary Data


                   INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SCHEDULES

                                                                            Page
                                                                            ----

Index to Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements                         F-2

Report of Independent Accountants                                           F-3

Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 1998
            and 1997                                                        F-4

Consolidated Statements of Income for the years
   ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996                                   F-6

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
   for the years ended December 31, 1998,  1997 and 1996                    F-8

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity
   for the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996                     F-9

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income
   for the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997, and 1996                    F-9

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements                                  F-10

Financial Statement Schedules:

Schedule II - Condensed Financial Information of Registrant:
         Balance Sheets at December 31, 1998 and 1997                       F-39

         Statements of Income for the years ended
         December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996                                   F-40

         Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended
         December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996                                   F-41

         Notes to Condensed Financial Statements                            F-42

Schedule IV - Reinsurance for the years ended
   December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996                                         F-43

Schedule VI - Supplemental Information Concerning
   Property-Casualty Insurance Operations for the
   years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996                             F-44

The  information  for Schedule I is  contained in the Notes to the  Consolidated
Financial  Statements.  The information for Schedule III is included in Schedule
VI. The information required for Schedule V is not applicable.
Index to Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements



                                      F-1
<PAGE>


Footnote   Description                                                      Page
- --------   -----------                                                      ----
    1      Business ......................................................  F-10
    2      Organization ..................................................  F-12
    3      Significant Accounting Policies ...............................  F-13
    4      Changes in Accounting Policies ................................  F-17
    5      Funds Held in Fiduciary Capacity ..............................  F-19
    6      Investments ...................................................  F-20
    7      Notes Payable .................................................  F-23
    8      Income Taxes ..................................................  F-24
    9      Lease Commitments and Rentals .................................  F-26
   10      Pension and Retirement Plans ..................................  F-26
   11      Management Services Agreement .................................  F-26
   12      Contingent Liabilities ........................................  F-27
   13      Reinsurance ...................................................  F-28
   14      Losses and Loss Expense .......................................  F-29
   15      Statutory Financial Information and Dividend Restrictions .....  F-30
   16      Related Party Transactions ....................................  F-31
   17      Acquisitions ..................................................  F-32
   18      Preferred Stock ...............................................  F-32
   19      Dividends Declared ............................................  F-33
   20      Stock Performance and Stock Option Plans ......................  F-33
   21      Quarterly Financial Information (Unaudited) ...................  F-35
   22      Premiums ......................................................  F-36
   23      Business Segments .............................................  F-36
   24      Supplemental Cash Flow Disclosures ............................  F-38
   25      Subsequent Event ..............................................  F-38



                                      F-2
<PAGE>


                        REPORT OF INDEPENDENT ACCOUNTANTS


To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of Kaye Group Inc.:

In our opinion,  the  accompanying  consolidated  balance sheets and the related
consolidated  statements  of  income,  cash  flows,   stockholders'  equity  and
comprehensive  income,  present fairly, in all material respects,  the financial
position of Kaye Group Inc. and its subsidiaries (the "Company") at December 31,
1998 and 1997, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each
of the three years in the period ended  December 31, 1998,  in  conformity  with
generally accepted  accounting  principles.  These financial  statements are the
responsibility of the Company's management;  our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these  financial  statements  based on our audits.  We conducted  our
audits of these  statements  in  accordance  with  generally  accepted  auditing
standards which require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain  reasonable
assurance   about  whether  the  financial   statements  are  free  of  material
misstatement.  An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the  amounts  and  disclosures  in  the  financial  statements,   assessing  the
accounting  principles  used and significant  estimates made by management,  and
evaluating the overall  financial  statement  presentation.  We believe that our
audits provide a reasonable basis for the opinion expressed above.






PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
New York, New York
February 26, 1999




                                      F-3
<PAGE>



                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                           CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                     December 31, 1998 and December 31, 1997
                   (in thousands, except par value per share)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                            1998               1997
                                                                                          --------           --------
<S>                                                                                       <C>                <C>
ASSETS:

INSURANCE BROKERAGE COMPANIES
Current assets:
     Cash and cash equivalents
          (including short term investments, and funds held in a fiduciary
          capacity of $33,218 and $22,322)                                                $ 34,267           $ 24,833
     Premiums and other receivables                                                         40,572             32,790
     Prepaid expenses and other assets                                                       1,895              1,385
                                                                                          --------           --------
     Total  current assets                                                                  76,734             59,008

Fixed assets (net of accumulated depreciation of $5,662 and $4,553)                          3,683              3,145
Intangible assets (net of accumulated amortization of $2,750 and $2,072)                     6,795              4,702
Deferred income taxes                                                                          816                966
Other assets                                                                                   205                181
                                                                                          --------           --------
     Total assets - insurance brokerage companies                                           88,233             68,002
                                                                                          --------           --------

PROPERTY AND CASUALTY COMPANIES
Investments available-for-sale:
     Fixed maturities, at market value (amortized cost: 1998, $42,980;
         1997, $41,529)                                                                     43,597             42,099
     Equity securities, at market value (cost: 1998, $646; 1997, $871)                         732                981
     Short term investments, at cost, which approximates market value                        2,950              3,430
                                                                                          --------           --------
     Total investments                                                                      47,279             46,510

Cash and cash equivalents                                                                   10,806              6,409
Accrued interest and dividends                                                                 961                882
Premiums receivable                                                                          2,644              2,344
Premiums receivable - insurance brokerage companies                                          3,041              3,185
Prepaid reinsurance premiums                                                                   162                262
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses and loss expenses                                   3,220              2,811
Funds held under deposit contracts, at market value, which
     approximates cost                                                                                            173
Deferred acquisition costs                                                                   3,921              3,939
Deferred income taxes                                                                          586                379
Other assets                                                                                 2,354              1,810
Intercompany receivable                                                                        508
                                                                                          --------           --------
     Total assets - property and casualty companies                                         75,482             68,704
                                                                                          --------           --------

CORPORATE
Cash and cash equivalents                                                                      370                 65
Prepaid expenses and other assets                                                              248                107
Investments available-for-sale:
     Equity securities, at market value (cost: 1998, $497, and 1997, $557)                     615                442
Deferred income taxes                                                                                              41
Intercompany receivable                                                                      2,118              3,664
                                                                                          --------           --------
     Total assets - corporate                                                                3,351              4,319
                                                                                          --------           --------

     Total assets                                                                         $167,066           $141,025
                                                                                          ========           ========
</TABLE>


                 See notes to consolidated financial statements


                                      F-4
<PAGE>


                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                           CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                     December 31, 1998 and December 31, 1997
                   (in thousands, except par value per share)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                            1998               1997
                                                                                          --------           --------
<S>                                                                                       <C>                <C>
LIABILITIES:

INSURANCE BROKERAGE COMPANIES
Current liabilities:
     Premiums payable                                                                     $ 59,472           $ 40,872
     Premiums payable - property and casualty companies                                      3,041              3,185
     Accounts payable and accrued liabilities                                                9,045              7,983
     Notes payable                                                                             718                434
     Deferred income taxes                                                                     978              1,063
     Intercompany payable                                                                    2,626              3,342
                                                                                          --------           --------
     Total current liabilities                                                              75,880             56,879
Notes payable                                                                                1,369                654
Other liabilities                                                                            1,005              1,466
                                                                                          --------           --------
     Total liabilities-insurance brokerage companies                                        78,254             58,999
                                                                                          --------           --------

PROPERTY AND CASUALTY COMPANIES
Liabilities:
     Unpaid losses and loss expenses                                                        21,567             19,126
     Unearned premium reserves                                                              12,327             12,578
     Accounts payable and accrued liabilities                                                7,451              6,661
     Other liabilities                                                                         143                350
     Intercompany payable                                                                                         322
                                                                                          --------           --------
     Total liabilities - property and casualty companies                                    41,488             39,037
                                                                                          --------           --------

CORPORATE
Current liabilities:
     Accounts payable and accrued liabilities                                                  511                774
     Note and loan payable                                                                   1,153              1,875
     Deferred income taxes                                                                      20
     Income taxes payable                                                                      568                 16
                                                                                          --------           --------
     Total current liabilities                                                               2,252              2,665
Loan payable-long-term                                                                       3,303              5,156
                                                                                          --------           --------
     Total liabilities-corporate                                                             5,555              7,821
                                                                                          --------           --------

     Total liabilities                                                                     125,297            105,857
                                                                                          --------           --------

COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
     Preferred stock, $1.00 par value; 1,000 shares authorized;
          none issued or outstanding
     Common stock, $.01 par value; 20,000 shares authorized;
          8,474 shares issued and outstanding                                                   85                 85
     Paid - in capital                                                                      17,942             17,942
     Accumulated other comprehensive income, net of deferred
          income tax  liability  (1998, $280; 1997, $192)                                      541                373
     Retained earnings                                                                      23,201             16,768
                                                                                          --------           --------

     Total stockholders' equity                                                             41,769             35,168
                                                                                          --------           --------

     Total liabilities and stockholders' equity                                           $167,066           $141,025
                                                                                          ========           ========
</TABLE>


                 See notes to consolidated financial statements


                                      F-5
<PAGE>


                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                        CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
              For the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996
                    (in thousands, except per share amounts)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                    1998             1997             1996
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------
<S>                                                                               <C>              <C>              <C>
INSURANCE BROKERAGE COMPANIES
Revenues:
     Commissions and fees - net                                                    $35,356          $32,217          $31,567
     Investment income                                                               1,846            1,565            1,026
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

     Total revenues                                                                 37,202           33,782           32,593
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

Expenses:
     Salaries and benefits                                                          21,323           18,905           18,763
     Amortization of intangibles                                                       679              507              439
     Other operating expenses                                                       13,446           13,203           13,986
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

     Total operating expenses                                                       35,448           32,615           33,188
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

     Interest expense                                                                   49              400              600
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

     Income (loss) before income taxes-insurance brokerage companies                 1,705              767           (1,195)
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

PROPERTY AND CASUALTY COMPANIES
Revenues:
     Net premiums written                                                           24,538           22,270           20,689
     Change in unearned premiums                                                       151              577           (1,362)
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

     Net premiums earned                                                            24,689           22,847           19,327
     Net investment income                                                           2,920            2,692            2,461
     Net realized gains on investments                                                  85               21               72
     Other income                                                                      146              245              445
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

     Total revenues                                                                 27,840           25,805           22,305
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

Expenses:
     Losses and loss expenses                                                        8,496            8,716            7,036
     Acquisition costs and general and administrative expenses                       9,707            9,370            8,218
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

     Total expenses                                                                 18,203           18,086           15,254
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

     Income before income taxes-property and casualty companies                      9,637            7,719            7,051
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

CORPORATE
Revenues:
     Net investment income (loss)                                                      (31)              55               89

Expenses:
     Other operating expenses                                                          314              438              220

     Interest expense                                                                  443              548              514
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

     Net expenses before income taxes-corporate                                       (788)            (931)            (645)
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------
</TABLE>


See notes to consolidated financial statements


                                      F-6
<PAGE>


                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                        CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
            For the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996
                    (in thousands, except per share amounts)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                    1998             1997             1996
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------
<S>                                                                               <C>              <C>              <C>
Income before income taxes and  minority interest                                  $10,554           $7,555           $5,211
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

     Current                                                                         3,422            1,921              364
     Deferred                                                                         (150)             346            1,120
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

     Total provision for income taxes                                                3,272            2,267            1,484
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

Income before minority interest                                                      7,282            5,288            3,727

Minority interest                                                                                       931              656
                                                                                  --------         --------         --------

Net income                                                                          $7,282           $4,357           $3,071
                                                                                  ========         ========         ========

EARNINGS PER SHARE

     Basic                                                                           $0.86            $0.62            $0.44
                                                                                  ========         ========         ========

     Diluted                                                                         $0.85            $0.62            $0.44
                                                                                  ========         ========         ========


Weighted average of shares outstanding - basic                                       8,474            7,024            7,020
                                                                                  ========         ========         ========

Weighted average shares outstanding and
share equivalents outstanding - diluted                                              8,593            7,083            7,021
                                                                                  ========         ========         ========
</TABLE>


See notes to consolidated financial statements


                                      F-7
<PAGE>



                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                      CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
              For the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996
                                 (in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    1998                1997                1996
                                                                  --------            --------            --------
<S>                                                                <C>                 <C>                 <C>
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
Net income                                                          $7,282              $4,357              $3,071
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net
    cash provided by (used in) operating activities:
    Deferred acquisition costs                                          18                 134                (370)
    Amortization of bond premium - net                                 599                 650                 751
    Deferred income taxes                                             (150)                346               1,120
    Net realized gains on investments                                  (85)                (21)                (72)
    Depreciation and amortization expense                            1,813               1,667               2,000
    Minority interest                                                                      931                 656
    Change in assets and liabilities:
       Accrued interest and dividends                                  (79)                 87                  22
       Premiums and other receivables                               (8,125)             23,011              19,217
       Prepaid expenses and other assets                            (1,253)             (1,785)                760
       Unpaid losses and loss expenses                               2,441               3,899               2,556
       Unearned premium reserves                                      (251)               (598)              1,362
       Premiums payable                                             18,371             (21,870)            (14,865)
       Income taxes payable                                            552                 (79)              1,356
       Accounts payable and accrued liabilities                      2,055               5,116                (767)
                                                                  --------            --------            --------

       Net cash provided by operating activities                    23,188              15,845              16,797
                                                                  --------            --------            --------

CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
Investments available - for - sale :
Purchase of fixed maturities                                       (15,012)            (11,907)            (14,291)
Purchase of equity securities                                         (200)               (500)               (825)
Purchase of short term investments                                                      (2,094)
Maturities of fixed maturities                                       4,861               4,487               3,318
Sales of fixed maturities                                            8,158               5,297               8,707
Sales of equity securities                                             425               1,100
Sales of short term investments                                        480                                   1,814
Funds held under deposit contracts:
Purchase of fixed maturities                                                              (976)               (469)
Sales of short term investments                                        173               2,344                (815)
Sales of fixed maturities                                                                1,851               2,535
Maturities of fixed maturities                                                             452                 480
Purchase of fixed assets                                            (2,089)             (1,481)               (888)
Acquisition payments                                                (1,239)               (777)
                                                                  --------            --------            --------

       Net cash used in investing activities                        (4,443)             (2,204)               (434)
                                                                  --------            --------            --------

CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
Payments under deposit contracts                                      (122)             (3,326)             (1,553)
Acquisition debt-repayment                                            (657)
Notes and loan payable-repayment                                    (7,981)             (6,757)               (416)
Proceeds from borrowings                                             5,000                 642                 553
Payment of dividends                                                  (849)               (702)               (702)
Payment of dividends to minority stockholders                                             (150)               (150)
                                                                  --------            --------            --------

       Net cash used in financing activities                        (4,609)            (10,293)             (2,268)
                                                                  --------            --------            --------

NET CHANGE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS                             14,136               3,348              14,095
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period                    31,307              27,959              13,864
                                                                  --------            --------            --------

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period                         $45,443             $31,307             $27,959
                                                                  ========            ========            ========
</TABLE>


See notes to consolidated financial statements


                                      F-8
<PAGE>



                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                 CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
              For the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996
                    (in thousands, except per share amounts)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            Common Stock                    Accumulated
                                                        ---------------------                   Other                     Total
                                                        Outstanding     Par       Paid-In   Comprehensive   Retained   Stockholders'
                                                          Shares       Value      Capital       Income      Earnings     Equity
                                                        -----------  --------    --------   -------------  ----------  -------------
<S>                                                         <C>           <C>     <C>            <C>        <C>          <C>
Balance, January 1, 1996                                    7,020         $70      $7,776        $236       $14,800      $22,882

Change in unrealized depreciation, net of deferred
    income tax benefit of $138                                                                   (267)                      (267)
Net income                                                                                                    3,071        3,071
Dividends declared (per share-$0.10)                                                                           (702)        (702)
                                                         --------    --------    --------    --------      --------     --------

Balance, December 31, 1996                                  7,020          70       7,776         (31)       17,169       24,984

Change in unrealized appreciation, net of deferred
    income tax of ($174)                                                                          338                        338
Net income                                                                                                    4,357        4,357
Dividends declared (per share-$0.10)                                                                           (702)        (702)
Shares issued to purchase minority interest, net of
   deferred income tax of ($34)                             1,454          15      10,166          66        (4,056)       6,191
                                                         --------    --------    --------    --------      --------     --------

Balance, December 31, 1997                                  8,474          85      17,942         373        16,768       35,168

Change in unrealized appreciation, net of deferred
    income tax of ($88)                                                                           168                        168
Net income                                                                                                    7,282        7,282
Dividends declared (per share-$0.10)                                                                           (849)        (849)
                                                         --------    --------    --------    --------      --------     --------

Balance, December 31, 1998                                  8,474         $85     $17,942        $541       $23,201      $41,769
                                                         ========    ========    ========    ========      ========     ========
</TABLE>

                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                 CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
              For the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996
                                 (in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                   1998         1997          1996
                                                                                                  -------      -------      -------
<S>                                                                                                <C>          <C>          <C>
NET INCOME                                                                                         $7,282       $4,357       $3,071

Other comprehensive income:

  Unrealized appreciation (depreciation) of investments available -for-sale,  net of
  deferred  income tax liability (benefit)  (1998, $116; 1997, $214; 1996, ($114) )                   221          417         (219)

  Less: reclassification adjustment for gain included in net income,
  net of deferred  income tax liability  (1998, $28; 1997, $6; 1996, $24 )                            (53)         (13)         (48)
                                                                                                  -------      -------      -------

  Total other comprehensive income                                                                    168          404         (267)
                                                                                                  -------      -------      -------

COMPREHENSIVE INCOME                                                                               $7,450       $4,761       $2,804
                                                                                                  =======      =======      =======
</TABLE>


See notes to consolidated financial statements


                                      F-9
<PAGE>


                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                  Years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996

1) Business

Kaye Group Inc. (the "Company"),  a Delaware  corporation,  is a holding company
which,  through  its  subsidiaries,  is  engaged in a broad  range of  insurance
brokerage,  underwriting  and related  activities.  The Company  operates in two
insurance  business  segments - the  Insurance  Brokerage  Companies  Operations
("Brokerage  Operations"),  comprised of the Retail  Brokerage  Business and the
Program Brokerage Business, and the Property and Casualty Companies Operations.

In addition,  Corporate  Operations  include those  activities  that benefit the
Company in its  entirety  and cannot be  specifically  identified  to either the
Insurance Brokerage Companies or the Property and Casualty Companies Operations.
Such activities  include debt servicing and public company  expenses,  including
investor relations costs.

Insurance Brokerage Companies Operations

The Retail Brokerage  Business operates an insurance  brokerage business through
four subsidiaries of the Company,  the "Retail Brokerage  Companies".  It offers
commercial  clients  a full  range of  insurance  brokerage  services  including
procurement of property/casualty insurance, risk management consulting, bonding,
loss prevention engineering,  and group employee benefit consulting services. In
addition,  personal lines and life and health  insurance  coverage are placed on
behalf of individuals.

The Retail  Brokerage  Business'  primary  strategy is to service  middle market
companies  and  organizations  just below the  Fortune 500 level for which other
national brokers  intensely  compete.  Within this market,  the Retail Brokerage
Business has developed  particular expertise and knowledge of the risks facing a
number of industry sectors  including  health care, real estate,  manufacturing,
churches, law firms, homes for the aged and fine arts.

During  1998,  the  Retail  Brokerage  Business  serviced  approximately  15,000
insureds.  The  Retail  Brokerage  Business  is  compensated  for  its  services
primarily in the form of commissions paid by insurance companies. The commission
is usually a percentage  of the premium paid by the  insured.  Commission  rates
depend upon the type of insurance,  the particular  insurance  company,  and the
role in which the Retail Brokerage  Business acts. In some cases a commission is
shared  with other  agents or brokers  who have  acted  jointly  with the Retail
Brokerage  Business in connection  with the  transaction.  The Retail  Brokerage
Business may also receive from an insurance company a contingent commission that
is generally based on the profitability and volume of business placed with it by
the Retail Brokerage  Business over a given period of time. The Retail Brokerage
Business may also receive fees in connection with consulting  services  relating
to the  marketing of  insurance.




                                      F-10
<PAGE>


Program  Brokerage  Corporation or "PBC" (the Program  Brokerage  Business) is a
subsidiary of the Company and operates a wholesale  insurance brokerage business
which offers retail  insurance  agents and brokers  innovative  solutions to the
twin insurance  problems of price and availability of coverage.  It accomplishes
this by organizing pools of similar risks into specially designed Affinity Group
Insurance Programs (the "Programs").

Approximately  two thirds of PBC's premium volume is generated by  approximately
450 unrelated retail insurance  agents and brokers serving  approximately  5,800
insureds  during  1998.  The  remaining  one third is  derived  from the  Retail
Brokerage  Business.  Approximately  half of PBC's premium volume is directly or
indirectly  placed  with two  affiliates,  Old Lyme  Insurance  Company of Rhode
Island, Inc. ("OLRI") and Old Lyme Insurance Company, Ltd. (Bermuda) ("OLB").

Property and Casualty Companies Operations

The Company conducts its property and casualty underwriting business through its
two insurance company  subsidiaries (the "Insurance  Companies"),  OLRI and OLB.
OLRI is a property and casualty  insurance  company licensed in Rhode Island and
eligible  as a  surplus  lines  insurer  in New  York and New  Jersey.  OLB is a
property and casualty insurance company organized and licensed under the laws of
Bermuda.  In states where the Insurance  Companies are not admitted  insurers or
surplus lines insurers, the Insurance Companies underwrite risks through various
reinsurance agreements.

The Insurance  Companies  underwrite  property risks (loss or physical damage to
property)  and OLRI  underwrites  casualty  risks (legal  liability for personal
injury or  damaged  property  of others)  for  insureds  in the  United  States.
Insurance is sold principally  through the Programs marketed by PBC which insure
various   types  of   businesses   and   properties   that  have   similar  risk
characteristics,  such as apartments, condominiums,  cooperatives,  restaurants,
building  maintenance  companies,  gas  stations,  churches,  funeral  homes and
pharmacies, among others.

The Insurance Companies' strategy is to underwrite only the first "layer" of the
property and casualty  insurance  provided  under the Programs.  Its exposure to
individual insureds on individual losses is thereby generally limited to between
$10,000 and $25,000 per claim (primarily  inclusive of allocated loss expenses),
depending on the Program.  Under the Programs, the Insurance Companies' policies
are sold in conjunction  with policies issued by unaffiliated  Program  insurers
that provide  coverage for losses above the first layer of risk  underwritten by
the Insurance  Companies.  In addition,  OLRI has issued  policies on a selected
basis with limits up to $1,000,000,  retaining the first $50,000 of exposure and
reinsuring the remaining limits with an unaffiliated reinsurer.


                                      F-11
<PAGE>


The Property and Casualty Companies  Operations  includes Claims  Administration
Corporation  ("CAC"),  a subsidiary of the Company which is responsible  for the
administration  of a large  majority of the claims  submitted  to the  Insurance
Companies.  The administration of claims includes  investigation,  engagement of
legal  counsel,  approval of  settlements  and the making of payments  to, or on
behalf of  insureds.  CAC also  provides  claims  administration  service to the
unaffiliated Program insurers for a fee.

2) Organization

In 1994 the Retail  Brokerage  Business  completed the  integration  of its 1992
acquisition   of  Amalgamated   Programs   Corporation   and  related   entities
("Amalgamated")  and  continued  to downsize to adjust to the  continuing  "soft
market" in property and casualty premium rates. At the time, the officers of the
general partners of Kaye  International L.P. ("KILP") (which included members of
Holding's Board of Directors)  concluded that the combination of Holding and the
Retail  Brokerage  Business would be  advantageous  for both OLRI and KILP. This
conclusion was based on three factors:  (a) improved  operating  results derived
from the Amalgamated integration and "soft market" downsizing,  (b) the improved
outlook  for the  Retail  Brokerage  Business  and (c) the fact that the  Retail
Brokerage Business accounted for approximately half of the PBC's premium volume.

The  combination  was  effective  October  2,  1995 and was  accounted  for as a
transfer and exchange between companies under common control.  Accordingly,  the
assets and liabilities of the Retail Brokerage Business were combined with those
of  Holding  at their  historical  cost in a manner  similar  to a  "pooling  of
interests". The combination was accomplished as follows:

          1. Holding  transferred  to Kaye Holding Corp.  ("KHC") (a subsidiary)
     all of the outstanding  stock of the Insurance  Companies and its two other
     subsidiaries,  PBC and CAC and its other  assets in exchange for (i) 82,400
     shares of KHC common stock, representing 82.4% of the total outstanding KHC
     common  stock,  and (ii) the  assumption  by KHC of  certain  of  Holding's
     liabilities.

          2. KILP  transferred  all of its interest in the limited  partnerships
     conducting the Retail Brokerage  Business (the "Retail  Partnerships")  and
     certain  related  assets to KHC in  exchange  for (i) 17,200  shares of KHC
     common stock, representing 17.2% of the total outstanding KHC common stock,
     and (ii) the assumption by KHC of certain KILP liabilities.

          3. Certain  individuals  transferred to KHC all of their  interests in
     the  corporate  general  partners of the Retail  Partnerships  (the "Retail
     Brokerage  Companies")  in  exchange  for 400 shares of KHC  common  stock,
     representing 0.4% of the total outstanding KHC common stock.


                                      F-12
<PAGE>


          4. KHC  contributed  its interests in the Retail  Partnerships  to the
     Retail  Brokerage  Companies  thereby causing the dissolution of the Retail
     Partnerships.  As a result, the Retail Brokerage Companies, as a group, own
     all of the assets and are subject to all of the liabilities,  of the Retail
     Brokerage Business.

On December 30, 1997, the  stockholders of the Company  approved a restructuring
that merged KHC into the Company.  This eliminated  KILP's minority  interest in
KHC of $6,191,000 as of December 31, 1997 and increased  stockholders' equity of
the Company by the same amount. KILP was the Company's largest shareholder.  The
merger was  accounted  for as a transfer and  exchange  between  entities  under
common control. Accordingly,  common stock of Kaye Group Inc. issued in exchange
for the KHC shares was accounted for by using the closing NASDAQ market price on
(the effective date of the merger) October 24, 1997 ($7.00).  This increased the
number of shares of common stock by 1,454,435 at the par value $.01,  per share,
or  $14,544.  Paid-in  capital  was  increased  by  $10,166,000  which  was  the
difference between the market value price per share and the par value per share.
Minority  interest in KHC was  eliminated as a result of the merger and retained
earnings of Kaye Group Inc.  was reduced to account for the  difference  between
the  market  value of the  shares  issued,  and the book  value of the  minority
interest in KHC.

Effective  May 12, 1998,  KILP,  the  Company's  then largest  stockholder,  was
dissolved, and its shares in the Company were distributed to its partners.

3) Significant Accounting Policies

(a) Basis of Presentation

The  accompanying  consolidated  financial  statements  have  been  prepared  in
accordance  with  generally  accepted  accounting   principles   ("GAAP").   All
significant  intercompany  balances and  transactions  within segments have been
eliminated.

The  preparation  of  financial  statements  in  conformity  with GAAP  requires
management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of
assets and  liabilities  and disclosure of contingent  assets and liabilities at
the date of the  financial  statements  and the reported  amounts of revenue and
expenses  during the reporting  period.  Actual  results could differ from those
estimates.

Certain prior year  information  has been  reclassified to conform with the 1998
presentation.

(b) Segment Reporting

The  accompanying  consolidated  financial  statements  have been  prepared on a
segmented basis. See Note 1 for segments and their respective operations. Income
(loss)  before  income taxes of the two  operating  segments  includes  expenses
incurred  by  Corporate  on  behalf of the  segments,  which  are  allocated  to
operations of the segments.  The allocation



                                      F-13
<PAGE>


is based upon total  revenues of each segment  except for the  allocation of the
incentive   bonus  which  is  allocated  based  on  the  percentage  of  profits
contributed to the Company. Identifiable assets by segment are those assets used
in the  Company's  operations  in each business  segment.  Corporate  assets are
principally cash and cash equivalents and investments in equity securities.

(c) Commission Income

Commission income together with the related accounts receivable from clients and
premiums  payable to  insurance  carriers,  is  recorded  principally  as of the
billing date.  Commission income related to installment billing  arrangements is
recorded at the date of the initial billing. Contingent commissions, commissions
on premiums  billed  directly by insurance  carriers and commission  adjustments
(including cancellations) are recorded when collected or known.

(d) Fixed Assets

Furniture, equipment, computer hardware and software, and leasehold improvements
are carried at cost, less accumulated  depreciation  and  amortization  computed
using the  straight-line  method.  Fixed  assets are  depreciated  over  periods
ranging from three to seven years, and leasehold improvements are amortized over
the remaining terms of the leases which expire through 2002.

(e) Intangible Assets

Acquired expiration lists, covenants not to complete and goodwill are carried at
cost, less accumulated  amortization  which is computed using the  straight-line
method over a period of not more than  twenty  years.  Corporate  organizational
costs are carried at cost, less accumulated amortization and are amortized using
the  straight-line  method  over a period of five  years.  Such costs were fully
amortized at December 31, 1996.

(f) Investments

Fixed  maturity  securities,  funds  held  under  deposit  contracts  and equity
securities,  which  include  common and preferred  stocks,  are stated at market
value as the  Company  considers  these  investments  available  for  sale.  The
difference  between  the cost and  market  value of fixed  maturity  and  equity
securities  is reflected as  unrealized  appreciation  or  depreciation,  net of
applicable  deferred  income  taxes,  as a separate  component of  stockholders'
equity.  Realized gains or losses from the sale of investments are determined on
the  basis of  specific  identification  and are  reflected  as a  component  of
revenues. Investment income is recognized when earned.



                                      F-14
<PAGE>


The fair  value  of  fixed  maturities  is  based  on the  closing  price of the
investments on December 31. The fair value of equity  securities is based on the
closing sale price on December 31.

If a decline  in fair  value of an  investment  is  considered  to be other than
temporary,  the  investment  is  reduced  to its net  realizable  value  and the
reduction is accounted for as a realized  investment loss. In evaluating whether
a decline is other than temporary,  management considers the duration and extent
to which the market value has been less than cost,  the financial  condition and
near-term prospects of the issuer, including events that may impact the issuer's
operations and impair the earnings potential of the investment, and management's
ability and intent to hold an investment for a sufficient period to allow for an
anticipated recovery in fair value.

(g) Insurance Premiums Earned

Insurance  premiums  are  recognized  as revenues  ratably over the terms of the
related  policies  in force.  Unearned  premiums  are  established  to cover the
unexpired  portion of premiums  written and are  calculated  using the daily pro
rata method. Premiums earned are net of reinsurance ceded.

(h) Deferred Acquisition Costs

Deferred  acquisition  costs  represent  costs to  acquire  or  renew  insurance
policies or contracts and are deferred and amortized over the applicable premium
recognition  period,  generally one year. These deferred costs have been limited
to the amount expected to be recovered from future earned premiums.  Acquisition
costs of  $7,630,000,  $7,269,000  and  $6,086,000  were amortized to expense in
1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively.

(i) Unpaid Losses and Loss Expenses

The  estimated  liability  for unpaid  losses and loss  expenses  is based on an
evaluation of claims  reported by  policyholders.  A provision which is based on
historical  experience  and modified for current  trends,  is also  included for
losses and loss expenses which have been incurred but not reported.  The methods
of  determining  such  estimates and  establishing  the  resulting  reserves are
continually  reviewed  and  modified  to  reflect  current  conditions,  and any
adjustments are reflected currently in results of operations.

The Company has received claims related to lead paint exposures it insures under
various residential real estate programs.  There are uncertainties in estimating
the  amount  of  reserves  due to  factors  including:  difficulty  in  properly
allocating responsibility and/or liability for the lead paint exposure;  changes
in the  underlying  laws and the  judicial  interpretation  of those  laws;  and
questions   regarding  the  interpretation  and  application  of  insurance  and
reinsurance coverage. The Company has reserves established for these claims on a
case basis and an incurred but not reported  basis.  The reserves  provided were
established based on Management's estimate of ultimate liabilities. However, due
to the



                                      F-15
<PAGE>


nature of the exposures such reserves cannot be, and are not  established  using
standard actuarial techniques.

(j) Reinsurance

Assumed  reinsurance  premiums  written,   commission,  and  unpaid  losses  are
accounted  for  based  principally  on the  reports  received  from  the  ceding
insurance  companies  and in a manner  consistent  with the terms of the related
reinsurance  agreements.  Liabilities  for  unpaid  losses,  loss  expenses  and
unearned premiums are stated gross of ceded reinsurance  recoverables.  Deferred
acquisition  costs are stated net of the amounts of  reinsurance  ceded,  as are
premiums written and earned,  losses and loss expenses  incurred,  and amortized
acquisition  costs.  Assumed  reinsurance  contracts  which do not  involve  the
transfer of risk to the Company are recorded as deposit contracts (see Note 13).

(k) Income Taxes

The  Company  recognizes  deferred  tax  assets  or  liabilities  for  temporary
differences  between  the  financial  reporting  and tax  basis  of  assets  and
liabilities  based on enacted tax rates.  The  principal  temporary  differences
relate to  deferred  acquisition  costs,  unearned  premiums,  discount  for tax
purposes  of the  unpaid  losses  and loss  expense  reserves,  amortization  of
expiration lists and deferred  compensation,  accrual  adjustment for commission
income and unrealized gains or losses on investments (see Note 8).

(l) Cash and Cash Equivalents

Cash and cash  equivalents  include  money  market  funds  and  certificates  of
deposit,  including funds held in a fiduciary  capacity for Insurance  Brokerage
Companies,  with a maturity of three months or less. The Company  maintains cash
with banks in excess of  federally  insured  limits and is exposed to the credit
risk from this concentration of cash.

(m) Earnings Per Share

Effective  December  31,  1997,  the  Company  adopted  Statement  of  Financial
Accounting  Standards  ("SFAS")  No. 128  Earnings  Per Share which  requires an
enterprise  to present  basic and diluted  earnings per share on the face of the
income statement.  Basic earnings per share, which is calculated by dividing net
income by the weighted  average  number of common shares  outstanding,  replaces
primary earnings per share from the prior standard.  For all periods  previously
reported  by the  Company,  basic  earnings  per  share is the  same as  primary
earnings per share,  since the impact of the Company's common stock  equivalents
for those periods did not reach the significance threshold prescribed to require
adjustment  under the prior  standard.  Diluted  earnings per share  include the
effect of all potentially dilutive securities.


                                      F-16
<PAGE>


Earnings per common share has been computed  below in  accordance  with SFAS No.
128, based upon weighted  average  common and dilutive  shares  outstanding  (in
thousands, except per share accounts):

                                                         1998     1997     1996
                                                        ------   ------   ------
Net income (numerator)                                  $7,282   $4,357   $3,071
                                                        ------   ------   ------

Weighted average common shares and effect of
dilutive shares used in the computation of earnings
per share:

   Average shares outstanding-basic                      8,474    7,024    7,020
   Effect of dilutive shares                               119       59        1
                                                        ------   ------   ------
   Average shares outstanding - diluted
   (denominator)                                         8,593    7,083    7,021
                                                        ------   ------   ------
Earnings per common share:
   Basic                                                 $0.86    $0.62    $0.44
   Diluted                                               $0.85    $0.62    $0.44

A warrant that expired in February 1998,  (relating to 1997 and 1996,  only) and
options to purchase 161,450,  284,000,  and 419,000 common shares at prices from
$7.06 to $11.63, $7.06 to $11.63, and $7.06 to $11.63 per share were outstanding
at December 31, 1998, 1997, and 1996, respectively, but were not included in the
computation  of earnings per diluted  share for the  respective  years,  because
their  exercise  price was greater  than the average  market price of the common
shares. The options,  which expire through December 31, 2008, December 31, 2007,
and December 27, 2006, respectively, were still outstanding at the end of 1998.

4) Changes in Accounting Policies

(a) Newly Adopted Accounting Standards

In  February  1997,  the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission  ("SEC")  issued
Financial  Reporting  Release No. 48,  Disclosure  of  Accounting  Policies  for
Derivative  Financial  Instruments  and  Derivative  Commodity  Instruments  and
Disclosure  of  Quantitative  and  Qualitative  Information  about  Market  Risk
Inherent in Derivative Financial Instruments,  Other Financial Instruments,  and
Derivative  Commodity  Instruments  ("FRR No. 48").  FRR No. 48 amends rules and
forms for  registrants  and  requires  clarification  and  expansion of existing
disclosures for derivative financial  instruments,  other financial  instruments
and derivative commodity instruments, as defined therein. The amendments require
enhanced disclosure with respect to these derivative instruments. As of December
31, 1998, the Company has no derivative financial instruments. Additionally, the
amendments expand existing disclosure  requirements to include  quantitative and
qualitative  discussions  with  respect to market  risk  inherent in market risk
sensitive  instruments such as equity and fixed maturity securities,  as well as
derivative instruments which investors can use to better understand and evaluate
market risk exposures of



                                      F-17
<PAGE>


registrants.  These  disclosures  were effective in 1998 for the Company and are
appropriately disclosed.

In June 1997, the FASB issued SFAS No. 130, Reporting Comprehensive Income. This
statement  establishes  standards for the reporting and display of comprehensive
income and its components in the consolidated financial statements.  The purpose
of  reporting  comprehensive  income  is to  report  the  change  in equity of a
business  enterprise  for the  period  from  transactions  and other  events and
circumstances from non-owner sources. It includes all changes in equity during a
period except those resulting from  investments by owners and  distributions  to
owners.  These items include  currency  translation  adjustments  and unrealized
appreciation of investments, which are currently reported as separate components
of  equity  in  the  balance  sheet.  In  accordance  with  the  statement,  the
Consolidated  Statements  of  Comprehensive  Income are  presented as a separate
statement at December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996.

Also in June 1997, the FASB issued SFAS No. 131, Disclosure about Segments of an
Enterprise  and Related  Information.  This  statement  requires that  companies
report  certain  information  about their  operating  segments in the  financial
statements  including  information  about the products  and services  from which
revenues are derived, the geographic areas of operations,  and information about
major customers. Operating segments are determined by the way management decides
how  to  allocate  resources  and  how  it  assesses  performance.   Descriptive
information about the method used to identify the reportable  operating segments
must  also be  disclosed.  The  statement  also  requires  a  reconciliation  of
revenues, net income, and assets and other amounts disclosed for the segments to
the corresponding amounts in the consolidated financial statements.  The Company
implemented  SFAS No. 131  effective  December  31,  1998 and  identified  three
operating segments: Insurance Brokerage, Property & Casualty, and Corporate. The
financial  position  and  operating  results of the Company were not affected by
this statement.

(a) Accounting Standards Not Yet Adopted

In June 1998,  the  Financial  Accounting  Standards  Board issued  Statement of
Financial  Accounting  Standards  ("SFAS") No. 133,  Accounting  for  Derivative
Instruments and Hedging  Activities.  This statement requires all derivatives to
be  recognized  as either  assets or  liabilities  in the statement of financial
position and to be measured at fair value.  This  statement is effective for all
fiscal  quarters and fiscal  years  beginning  after June 15,  1999.  Management
believes  that the  statement  will not have a material  impact on the financial
position of the Company.

In March 1998, the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants  ("AICPA")
issued Statement of Position ("SOP") 98-1,  Accounting for the Costs of Computer
Software  Developed or Obtained for Internal Use, which requires  capitalization
of  external  and  certain   internal   costs  incurred  to  obtain  or  develop
internal-use  computer  software during the application  development  stage. SOP
98-1 is effective for fiscal years beginning after



                                      F-18
<PAGE>


December 15, 1998.  This  statement  is not  expected to  materially  impact the
Company's consolidated financial statements.

In late 1998,  the AICPA issued SOP 98-7.  Deposit  Accounting:  Accounting  for
Insurance and  Reinsurance  Contracts that Do Not Transfer  Insurance Risk. This
SOP effective for fiscal years beginning after June 15, 1999,  provides guidance
to both the insured and insurer on how to apply the deposit method of accounting
when it is required for insurance and reinsurance contracts that do not transfer
insurance  risk.  This SOP is not expected to  materially  impact the  Company's
consolidated financial statements.

In December 1997,  the AICPA issued SOP 97-3,  Accounting by Insurance and Other
Enterprises for  Insurance-Related  Assessments.  SOP 97-3 provides guidance for
assessments  related to insurance  activities and requirements for disclosure of
certain  information.  SOP 97-3 is effective for financial statements issued for
periods  beginning  after December 31, 1998.  Restatement  of previously  issued
financial  statements  is not  required.  SOP  97-3  is not  expected  to have a
material impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements.

5) Funds Held in Fiduciary Capacity

Premiums collected by the Insurance  Brokerage Companies but not yet remitted to
insurance carriers are approximately $33,218,000 and $22,322,000 at December 31,
1998 and 1997,  respectively,  some of which are  restricted as to use by law in
certain  states  in which  the  Insurance  Brokerage  Companies  operate.  These
balances are held in cash and cash  equivalents or short term  investments.  The
offsetting obligation is recorded in premiums payable.


                                      F-19
<PAGE>


6) Investments

Net investment  income for the years ended  December 31, 1998,  1997 and 1996 is
derived from the following sources (in thousands):

                                              1998          1997          1996
                                             ------        ------        ------
Insurance Brokerage Companies
Short term investments                       $1,846        $1,565        $1,026
                                             ------        ------        ------

Property and Casualty Companies
Fixed maturities                              2,031         2,083         2,099
Equity securities                                67           119           114
Short term investments                          791           382            82
Other                                            98           143           191
                                             ------        ------        ------
Total Investment income                       2,987         2,727         2,486
Investment expenses                             (67)          (35)          (25)
                                             ------        ------        ------
                                              2,920         2,692         2,461
                                             ------        ------        ------

Corporate
Short term investments                          (31)           55            89

Net investment income                        $4,735        $4,312        $3,576
                                             ======        ======        ======

Net  realized  gains or  losses  and the  increase  or  decrease  in  unrealized
appreciation  (depreciation)  on  investments  for the years ended  December 31,
1998, 1997 and 1996 are summarized below (in thousands):

                                                         1998     1997      1996
                                                         ----     ----      ----

Net realized gains (losses):
   Fixed maturities:
         Gross realized gains                             $85      $26      $82
         Gross realized losses                                      (5)     (10)
                                                         ----     ----    -----
Net realized gains on investments                         $85      $21      $72
                                                         ----     ----    -----

Change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation):
   Fixed maturities                                       $47     $636    $(543)
   Equity securities                                      209      (14)      48
                                                         ----     ----    -----
   Net change in unrealized appreciation
   (depreciation)                                        $256     $622    $(495)
                                                         ====     ====    =====


                                      F-20
<PAGE>


The composition, cost (amortized cost for fixed maturities) and estimated market
values of the Company's  investments at December 31, 1998 and 1997 are presented
below.

                                                        Gross          
                                                  Unrealized Holding   Aggregate
                                                  ------------------     Fair
                                         Cost      Gains     Losses     Value
                                       -------    -------    -------   ---------
                                                     (in thousands)

1998
Investments available for sale:
      Fixed Maturities:
         U.S. Government (a)            $2,144       $18                $2,162
         States (b)                     36,144       643       $(75)    36,712
         Corporate                       4,692        42        (11)     4,723
                                       -------      ----      -----    -------

      Total fixed maturities           $42,980      $703       $(86)   $43,597
                                       -------      ----      -----    -------

      Equity Securities:
         Common Stock                     $643      $204                  $847
         Preferred Stock                   500                             500
                                       -------      ----               -------

      Total equity securities           $1,143      $204                $1,347
                                       -------      ----               -------



1997
Investments available for sale:
      Fixed Maturities:
         U.S. Government (a)            $3,641       $10       $(24)    $3,627
         States (b)                     34,013       591         (3)    34,601
         Corporate                       3,875        44        (48)     3,871
                                       -------      ----      -----    -------

      Total fixed maturities           $41,529      $645       $(75)   $42,099
                                       -------      ----      -----    -------

      Equity Securities:
         Common Stock                     $703      $111      $(115)      $699
         Preferred Stock                   725                   (1)       724
                                       -------      ----      -----    -------

      Total equity securities           $1,428      $111      $(116)    $1,423
                                       -------      ----      -----    -------

Funds held under deposit contracts
    - Cash and cash equivalents           $173                            $173
                                       -------                         -------

(a)  Includes U.S. Government agencies and authorities

(b)  Includes municipalities and subdivisions



                                      F-21
<PAGE>


The amortized  cost and estimated  market value of fixed  maturities at December
31, 1998, by contractual  maturity date, are listed below.  Expected  maturities
may differ from contractual  maturities  because borrowers may have the right to
call or prepay obligations with or without penalties.

                                                   Investments Available
                                                         for Sale
                                           -------------------------------------
                                                      (in thousands)

                                           Amortized Cost   Aggregate Fair Value
                                           --------------   --------------------

Due in one year or less                          $3,769             $3,774

Due after one year through five years            21,193             21,624

Due after five years through ten years           13,474             13,599

Due after ten years                               4,544              4,600
                                                -------            -------

Total                                           $42,980            $43,597
                                                =======            =======

Fixed maturities and cash carried at market value of $3,560,000,  and $3,511,000
in 1998 and 1997, respectively, were on deposit for governmental authorities, as
required by law. Fixed maturity, equity securities, and cash equivalents carried
at market value of $13,747,000 and  $11,733,000 in 1998 and 1997,  respectively,
have been deposited in trust funds or pledged to  collateralize  the obligations
of OLB and OLRI to ceding companies under reinsurance agreements.

The Company's short term investment of cash is maintained principally with three
banks and an institutional  money market fund. To control this risk, the Company
utilizes only high credit quality financial  institutions.  Additionally,  under
the  insurance  laws of the  State of Rhode  Island,  where  OLRI is  domiciled,
insurers and reinsurers  are restricted as to the types of investments  they may
purchase  and the  concentration  of risk they may  accept in any one  issuer or
group of issuers.  The  Company  complies  with such laws which  insure that the
concentration  of risk  in its  investment  portfolio  is at an  acceptable  and
authorized level.



                                      F-22
<PAGE>


7) Notes Payable

Notes payable consist of the following in thousands at December 31,:

                                                                  1998     1997
                                                                 ------   ------
Insurance Brokerage:

Acquisition debt due to seller, due through 7/1/2002,
    interest at prime                                            $1,406
Finance company notes, due through 2000, interest at
    prime rate plus 1/2%                                             86     $179

Finance company notes, due through 2002, interest at 7.75%          445      546
Capital lease due through 8/30/99, interest at 7.375%               150      363
                                                                 ------   ------
                                                                  2,087    1,088
Less current portion                                                718      434
                                                                 ------   ------
Notes payable - long term                                        $1,369     $654
                                                                 ======     ====

Corporate:

Term loan, due through 2000, interest at 7.8%                    $4,456
Revolving line of credit, due through 2001
    interest at 5.9375% plus 2.5%                                         $7,031
Less current portion                                              1,153    1,875
                                                                 ------   ------
Notes payable-long term                                          $3,303   $5,156
                                                                 ======   ======

On June 23, 1998 the Company paid in full the $6,094,000  bank revolving line of
credit,  and replaced it with a  $5,000,000  term loan (the "Loan") with another
bank.  The Loan is  collateralized  by the stock of the  Property  and  Casualty
Companies. The Loan bears interest at a fixed rate per year of 7.8%. At December
31, 1998,  $4,456,000 was outstanding  under the Loan. In addition,  the Company
has  available  a  $4,500,000  revolving  line of  credit  with the  same  bank,
collateralized by the stock of the Property and Casualty Companies. The proceeds
are available for general operating needs and  acquisitions.  As of December 31,
1998, no amount was outstanding on the revolving line of credit. A quarterly fee
is assessed in the amount of 0.05% on the unused balance. Among other covenants,
the Loan agreement requires  maintenance of minimum consolidated GAAP net worth,
statutory  surplus,  ratio of net premiums written to surplus,  and minimum debt
service  coverage.  As of December 31, 1998, the Company was in compliance  with
the covenants of the Loan agreement.

The  Company's  required  payments  on the Loan  for the  respective  years  are
$1,153,000  in 1999,  $1,245,000 in 2000,  $1,345,000  in 2001,  and $713,000 in
2002. Interest expense for the loans mentioned above for the year ended December
31, 1998, 1997, and 1996 were $443,000, $548,000 and $514,000, respectively.




                                      F-23
<PAGE>


On  August  29,  1997  the  Company  paid in full the  note  payable  to KILP of
$6,000,000.  This note was subject to repayment  restrictions  stipulated in the
then  existing  bank  agreement.  The due date of the note  pursuant to the then
existing bank loan agreement  would have been in 2001. The bank consented to the
payment on August 25,  1997.  Interest  expense for the year ended  December 31,
1997 and 1996 was $400,000 and $600,000, respectively.

The  aggregate  maturities  of all  notes  payable  by year are as  follows  (in
thousands):

       1999 ..................................................   $1,871
       2000 ..................................................    1,773
       2001 ..................................................    1,866
       2002 ..................................................    1,033
       Thereafter ............................................       0

Based on the borrowing rates  currently  available to the Company for bank loans
with similar terms and average  maturities,  the fair value of the notes payable
at December 31, 1998 and 1997 approximates their carrying value.

Interest expense in the accompanying  consolidated  statements of income for the
years  ended  December  31,  1998,  1997 and 1996 was  $492,000,  $948,000,  and
$1,114,000, respectively.

8) Income Taxes

The Company's  effective  income tax rate for the years ended December 31, 1998,
1997 and 1996 differs from the statutory  rate on ordinary  income before income
taxes as follows (in thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           1998                      1997                      1996
                                                     -----------------        -------------------       ------------------
                                                                 % of                       % of                     % of
                                                                Pretax                     Pretax                   Pretax
                                                     Amount     Income        Amount       Income       Amount      Income
                                                     ------     ------        ------       ------       ------      ------
<S>                                                  <C>         <C>          <C>           <C>         <C>          <C>  
Income taxes computed at the                         $3,588      34.0%        $2,569        34.0%       $1,772       34.0%
statutory rate

Increase (decrease) in taxes resulting from:

Tax-exempt investment income                           (456)     (4.3)          (516)       (6.8)         (403)      (7.7)

State and local income taxes and other                  140       1.3            214         2.8           115        2.2
                                                     ------      ----         ------        ----        ------       ----

Provision for income taxes                           $3,272        31%        $2,267        30.0%       $1,484       28.5%
                                                     ======      ====         ======        ====        ======       ====
</TABLE>



                                      F-24
<PAGE>


The source of the significant temporary differences and the related deferred tax
effects are as follows:

                                              1998          1997          1996
                                            -------       -------       -------
                                                       (in thousands)

Expiration lists                               $394          $394          $393
Unearned premium reserves                        10            40           (93)
Deferred compensation                                                       850
Deferred acquisition costs                       (6)          (46)          126
Accrual adjustment                              (85)          (59)          (56)
Other                                          (217)           47          (137)
Loss reserve discount                          (246)          (30)           37
                                            -------       -------       -------

Deferred tax (benefit) expense                $(150)         $346        $1,120
                                            =======       =======       =======

The components of the net deferred tax asset, in the  accompanying  consolidated
balance sheets at December 31, 1998 and 1997, are as follows:

                                                              1998         1997
                                                             ------       ------
                                                               (in thousands)
Deferred tax assets:
  Loss and loss expense reserves                             $1,296       $1,048
  Expiration lists                                              547          941
  Unearned premium reserves                                     827          837
  Unrealized losses on investments and other                    304           91
                                                             ------       ------

  Total deferred tax asset                                    2,974        2,917
                                                             ------       ------

Deferred tax liabilities:
  Deferred acquisition costs                                  1,333        1,339
  Unrealized gains on investments and other
  accrual adjustments                                         1,237        1,255
                                                             ------       ------

  Total deferred tax liability                                2,570        2,594
                                                             ------       ------

Net deferred tax asset                                         $404         $323
                                                             ======       ======

Management  believes it is more likely than not that all deferred tax assets are
realizable based upon the past earnings history of the Company.

OLB, as a Bermuda  domiciled company is not subject to federal income taxes but,
rather,  the Company is subject to federal  income taxes based on OLB's  taxable
income for the entire year. Accordingly, the Company includes the taxable income
of OLB in its  separate  company  income  for  tax  purposes,  but  for  segment
reporting the income is included with the Property and Casualty  Companies.  OLB
has received an undertaking  from the Bermuda  Government  exempting it from all
taxes  computed on profit or income,  or  computed on any capital  asset gain or
appreciation until 2016.

The  Company and its wholly  owned  subsidiaries  are party to a Tax  Allocation
Agreement (the  "Agreement").  The Agreement  requires these companies to file a
U.S.  consolidated income tax return. The Agreement provides that each member of
the group will  compute  its  separate  tax  liability  or benefit on a separate
return  basis  and pay or  receive  such  amounts  to or from the  Company.  For
purposes  of  segment  information,  amounts  due to or from the  Company by its
subsidiaries  are  included  in  the  intercompany   receivable/payable  in  the
accompanying consolidated balance sheets.



                                      F-25
<PAGE>


9) Lease Commitments and Rentals

Minimum annual rental commitments under various non-cancelable  operating leases
for office space, automobiles and equipment are as follows (in thousands):

                               Years Ending December 31,
                               -------------------------
               1999 .......................................          $2,656
               2000 .......................................           2,493
               2001 .......................................           2,203
               2002 .......................................             351
               Thereafter .................................              22
                                                                    -------
                                                                      7,725
      Sub-lease rental income .............................            (139)
                                                                    -------
      Net rental commitments ..............................          $7,586
                                                                    =======

Leases  for office  space  include  various  escalation  clauses,  none of which
individually or in the aggregate are material.  Escalation clauses are accounted
for on a straight-line basis over the life of the lease. The leases also contain
provisions for the payment of certain operating expenses and real estate taxes.

Rent expense for the years ended December 31, 1998,  1997 and 1996,  amounted to
approximately  $2,928,000,  $2,992,000  and  $2,857,000,  respectively,  net  of
sublease rental income of $117,000, $193,000 and $197,000, respectively.

10) Pension and Retirement Plans

Substantially  all  officers  and  employees  of the  Company  are  entitled  to
participate in a qualified  retirement savings plan (defined  contribution plan)
and prior to 1995 were  entitled to  participate  in a defined  benefit  pension
plan.  The cost to the Company to  participate  in these  plans  included in the
accompanying  consolidated  statements  of income  was  approximately  $255,000,
$385,000, and $55,000 for 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively.

11) Management Services Agreement

In September 1992, Kaye Insurance Associates, L.P. ("KIA"), a predecessor of one
of the  entities  comprising  the  Retail  Brokerage  Business,  entered  into a
management  services  agreement  with APCO Corp.  (the  "Manager"),  whereby the
Manager was obliged to provide the administrative and operational  functions for
the  Amalgamated  Division,  from  which  certain  assets and  liabilities  were
acquired  in  1992.  The  Manager  was  owned  by the  individuals  who sold the
Amalgamated  Division to KIA. In return for the Manager's  services,  commencing
September 1, 1992 and continuing through August 31, 1997, KIA was obliged to pay
annually to the Manager a base fee which was subject to certain



                                      F-26
<PAGE>


adjustments as specified in the agreement.  KIA incurred management service fees
of  $911,000  and  $1,536,000  for the years ended  December  31, 1997 and 1996,
respectively,  which was included in other  operating  expenses of the Insurance
Brokerage Companies.

In addition, the Manager was entitled to receive an incentive bonus in an amount
equal to a specified percentage (ranging from 16% to 19%) of gross income of the
Amalgamated division, as defined in the agreement, for each of the five years of
the period ended August 31, 1997. In accordance with the terms of the agreement,
however,  in no event should the cumulative  amount paid by KIA, with respect to
this incentive  bonus, be less than $2,876,000 or exceed  $4,220,000  subject to
the continued  employment  of certain key personnel by the Manager.  The cost of
this bonus to KIA,  which was  charged to salaries  and  benefits as the related
gross income  earned,  was $0 and $364,000 for the years ended December 31, 1997
and 1996, respectively. These agreements expired on August 31, 1997.

12) Contingent Liabilities

In the ordinary course of business, the Company and its subsidiaries are subject
to various  claims  and  lawsuits  consisting  primarily  of alleged  errors and
omissions in connection  with the  placement of insurance.  Subject to specified
limits,  the shareholders of predecessors to the Retail  Brokerage  Business are
responsible for any costs arising from those claims which were asserted prior to
November  1,  1991,  the  date on which  KILP  was  formed.  In the  opinion  of
management,  the ultimate  resolution of all asserted and potential  claims both
prior and subsequent to the formation of KILP,  will not have a material  effect
on the consolidated financial position of the Company.

As licensed brokers,  the Insurance  Brokerage Companies are or may become party
to administrative inquiries and at times to administrative proceedings commenced
by state insurance  regulatory bodies.  Certain subsidiaries were involved in an
administrative  investigation  commenced  in  1992  by the  New  York  Insurance
Department  ("Department")  relating to how  property  insurance  policies  were
issued for the Residential Real Estate Program. As a result, the manner in which
policies are structured for certain  clients in this Program was altered,  which
has not had a material  adverse  effect on this  Program.  While the Company had
discussions with the Department regarding settlement of such investigation, this
matter has not been  pursued for several  years.  If the matter is not closed or
settled,   the  Department  could  institute  formal  proceedings   against  the
subsidiaries  seeking fines or license  revocation.  Management does not believe
the resolution of this issue will have a material adverse effect on the Company.


                                      F-27
<PAGE>


13)      Reinsurance

As of December  31, 1998 and 1997,  included  in the  amounts  reflected  in the
consolidated  financial  statements  are  unearned  premiums of  $4,779,000  and
$4,963,000, respectively, and unpaid losses and loss expenses of $16,068,000 and
$12,445,000, respectively, for reinsurance assumed from non-affiliates, although
all such  reinsurance  assumed  relates to business  produced  by the  Insurance
Brokerage  Companies.  The Insurance  Companies have established trust funds and
deposited fixed maturities,  equity securities,  and cash therein to satisfy the
collateral  requirements  of certain  reinsurance  agreements.  The trust  funds
established  for the  benefit  of ceding  companies  amounted  to  approximately
$13,747,000 and $11,872,000 as of December 31, 1998 and 1997, respectively.

In accordance with the normal practice of the insurance  industry,  OLRI assumes
and cedes  reinsurance  with  other  insurers  or  reinsurers.  The  reinsurance
arrangements  provide  greater  diversification  of business and minimize OLRI's
maximum net loss arising from large risks.

OLRI assumes  reinsurance  under  reinsurance  treaty  arrangements  with limits
varying from $25,000 to $100,000 per occurrence.  OLRI retains the first $25,000
of exposure  and cedes  $75,000 in excess of $25,000 for  business  assumed with
$100,000 per occurrence to an unaffiliated  company,  PXRE  Reinsurance  Company
("PXRE")  (A.M.  Best rated Ag). In addition,  OLRI  purchased  annual stop loss
policies to limit its exposure from reinsurance  assumed.  These policies insure
OLRI in the event the  losses  under the  policy  exceed a fixed  percentage  of
premium earned. OLRI will be reimbursed up to $3,000,000.

OLRI's ceded  reinsurance  is on an excess of loss basis with PXRE.  OLRI issues
policies on a selected  basis with limits up to  $1,000,000  retaining the first
$50,000 of exposure and reinsuring $950,000 to PXRE.

The Insurance  Companies also entered into reinsurance  agreements  wherein they
reinsured  certain  general  liability  and property  risks.  These  reinsurance
agreements  include per claim and  aggregate  limits and provide  funds that are
placed  into  trusts for the benefit of the  insurers.  Since these  reinsurance
contracts do not transfer risk to the Insurance Companies,  they are included in
"Funds Held Under Deposit  Contracts" in the accompanying  consolidated  balance
sheets.



                                      F-28
<PAGE>


A contingent  liability  exists with respect to reinsurance  ceded,  which would
become an ultimate  liability of OLRI in the event that the  assuming  companies
were unable to meet their obligations under the reinsurance  agreements in force
at December  31,  1998.  The amounts  deducted  from  revenues  and expenses for
reinsurance ceded by OLRI were as follows:

                                                           1998             1997
                                                           ----             ----
                                                              (in thousands)

Revenue and expenses:
   Premiums earned                                         $355            $ 558
   Commission expense                                        45               88
   Losses and loss expenses                                 409            1,929

14) Losses and Loss Expenses

The following table sets forth a  reconciliation  of the changes in the reserves
for  outstanding  losses  and loss  expenses,  including  paid  losses  and loss
expenses, for each year in the three year period ended December 31, 1998.

                                                   Years Ended December 31,
                                                --------------------------------
                                                  1998        1997        1996
                                                --------    --------    --------
                                                        (in thousands)

Balance at January 1, .......................    $19,126     $15,227     $12,671
         Less: reinsurance recoverables .....     (2,811)       (882)
                                                --------    --------    --------

         Net balance ........................     16,315      14,345      12,671
                                                --------    --------    --------

Incurred related to:
         Current year .......................      8,461       8,824       6,621
         Prior years ........................         35        (108)        415
                                                --------    --------    --------
         Total incurred .....................      8,496       8,716       7,036
                                                --------    --------    --------

Paid related to:
         Current year .......................      1,877       1,802       1,832
         Prior years ........................      4,587       4,944       3,530
                                                --------    --------    --------
         Total paid .........................      6,464       6,746       5,362
                                                --------    --------    --------

Net balance at December 31, .................     18,347      16,315      14,345
         Add: reinsurance recoverables ......      3,220       2,811         882
                                                --------    --------    --------

         Balance ............................    $21,567     $19,126     $15,227
                                                ========    ========    ========



                                      F-29
<PAGE>


15) Statutory Financial Information and Dividend Restrictions

The  Company's  insurance  subsidiaries  file separate  financial  statements in
accordance  with accounting  practices  prescribed or permitted by the insurance
regulatory authorities where they are domiciled.  Statutory financial statements
do not reflect deferred  acquisition costs,  deferred income taxes, market value
changes and certain other items recognized under GAAP.

OLB is required to maintain a minimum  statutory  capital and surplus based upon
the higher of $1,000,000 or an amount derived by applying a variable rate to its
current  premium volume or outstanding  losses at December 31, 1998. At December
31, 1998,  $419,000 was available for distribution  from OLB and its subsidiary,
Park  Brokerage Ltd.  Pursuant to Rhode Island  Insurance Law, OLRI may pay cash
dividends only from earned surplus  determined on a statutory basis,  subject to
the maintenance of minimum capital and surplus of $3,000,000.  Further,  OLRI is
restricted (on the basis of the lesser of 10% of OLRI's statutory surplus at the
end of the preceding twelve-month period or 100% of OLRI's net income, excluding
realized capital gains, for the preceding  twelve-month period) as to the amount
of the dividends it may declare or pay in any twelve-month  period without prior
approval of the Department of Business  Regulation of Rhode Island.  At December
31, 1998,  $2,786,000 is available for distribution  during 1999,  without prior
approval. Statutory information is as follows:

                                         Old Lyme        Old Lyme
                                       Rhode Island       Bermuda      Combined
                                       ------------       -------      --------
                                                      (in thousands)
Policyholders' surplus at
December 31,
         1998                             $27,867          $1,419       $29,286
         1997                             $23,662          $1,904       $25,566

Net income for the years ended
December 31,
         1998                              $5,703          $1,215        $6,918
         1997                              $5,178          $1,453        $6,631
         1996                              $2,459          $2,890        $5,349



                                      F-30
<PAGE>


The  following  is  a  reconciliation   of  net  income  and  surplus  regarding
policyholders  in accordance  with statutory  accounting  principles  ("SAP") as
reported to the Rhode Island and Bermuda insurance regulatory authorities to net
income  and  capital  as  determined  in  conformity  with  generally   accepted
accounting principles ("GAAP") basis.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     Statutory Surplus /
                                                                    Stockholders' Equity            Net Income for years ended
                                                                     as of December 31,                    December 31,
                                                                   ----------------------      ------------------------------------
                                                                     1998          1997          1998          1997          1996
                                                                   --------      --------      --------      --------      --------
                                                                                         (in thousands)
<S>                                                                 <C>           <C>            <C>           <C>           <C>
Consolidated amount in accordance with GAAP                         $41,769       $35,168        $7,282        $4,357        $3,071

Deficit (equity) in net assets and net loss
of non-insurance companies                                           (7,273)       (4,388)         (141)        2,086         3,217
                                                                   --------      --------      --------      --------      --------

Combined amount in accordance with GAAP                              34,496        30,780         7,141         6,443         6,288

Excess of statutory formula reserves over
GAAP reserves                                                                        (890)

Deferred acquisition costs                                           (3,921)       (3,939)           18           134          (370)


Non-admitted assets, deferred income taxes and other                 (1,289)         (385)         (241)           54          (569)
                                                                   --------      --------      --------      --------      --------

Combined amount in accordance with SAP                              $29,286       $25,566        $6,918        $6,631        $5,349
                                                                   ========      ========      ========      ========      ========
</TABLE>

16) Related Party Transactions

The  administrative  support  for  OLB is  provided  by  International  Advisory
Services,  Ltd. ("IAS"),  an insurance  management company located in Bermuda. A
director  of IAS  is an  officer  of  OLB  and  is a  director  of the  Company.
Management  fees  paid to IAS  under a  service  contract  for the  years  ended
December  31,  1998,   1997  and  1996  were   $30,000,   $37,500  and  $36,250,
respectively.

The director of IAS, who is a director of the Company,  is also a director of an
insurance  brokerage  company,  H  &  H  Reinsurance  Brokers,   Ltd.  ("H  &  H
Reinsurance").  H & H Reinsurance  has a reinsurance  contract  between OLRI and
unrelated  insurance  carriers,   (Transatlantic  Reinsurance  Company  and  USF
Reinsurance  Company). H & H Reinsurance received commissions of $0, $38,114 and
$7,000 in 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively, as a result of such transaction.

The Company had a $6,000,000  note payable to KILP which was paid in full during
1997 (see Note 7).

KIA incurred a management fee of $175,000  annually to ZS Fund,  L.P., which was
one of the general  partners of KILP (prior to KILP's  dissolution).  KIA had an
accrued  payable to ZS Fund,  L.P. as of December  31,  1996 of  $175,000.  This
management fee arrangement terminated on December 31, 1996.


                                      F-31
<PAGE>


In January 1997, KIA entered into a management  agreement with KILP, whereby the
KIA provided certain  administrative  services for a fee of $50,000 per year. At
December  31, 1998 and 1997,  the  Company  recorded  $50,000 for such  services
provided.   This  management  fee  arrangement   terminated  in  1998  with  the
dissolution of KILP.

A  director  of the  Company is also a  director  of, and has shared  beneficial
ownership  of more  than ten  percent  of the  outstanding  common  stock of Sun
Television and Appliances,  Inc. ("Sun TV"). In 1994, Sun TV and a subsidiary of
the Company entered into two agreements whereby the Company's  subsidiary agreed
to assume  certain  service  contracts  that  were sold by Sun TV to its  retail
customers (the  "Agreement")  and contracted  with Sun TV to have Sun TV provide
repair services under certain service contracts. The Board of Directors believes
that the agreements were commercially reasonable.  On September 11, 1998, Sun TV
filed  bankruptcy  petitions  under  Chapter  11 of  the  Bankruptcy  Code.  The
Company's  subsidiary  filed a proof of claim on March 11,  1999 for any and all
amounts that are due and owing under the Agreement.

17) Acquisitions

During 1998,  the Company  acquired  certain  assets and  liabilities of Florida
Insurance  Associates,  Inc. ("FIA"),  Daniel V. Keane Agency, Inc. ("DVK"), and
Laub  Group of  Florida,  Inc.  ("LGF")  for  cash of  $250,000,  $657,000,  and
$200,000,  respectively  and  estimated  amounts  payable  in future  periods of
$14,000  (FIA),   $1,406,000  (DVK)  and  $550,000  (LGF).  The  total  acquired
intangible assets (including  expiration lists) were $263,000,  $2,063,000,  and
$750,000 for FIA, DVK, and LGF, respectively.  These acquisitions were accounted
for under the purchase method.

During 1997,  the Company  acquired  certain  assets and  liabilities of Western
Insurance Associates,  Inc. ("WIA") for cash of $1,567,000 paid through December
31,  1998 and  amounts  payable in future  periods of  $1,330,000.  The  amounts
payable  are the  Company's  estimate  of the  costs it will  incur.  The  total
acquired  expiration list was $2,897,000 and $3,062,000 at December 31, 1998 and
1997, respectively. This acquisition was accounted for as a purchase.

18) Preferred Stock

The Board of  Directors is  authorized  to issue  preferred  stock in classes or
series and to fix the designations, preferences, qualifications,  limitations or
restrictions  of any  class or series  with  respect  to the rate and  nature of
dividends,  the price and terms and  conditions on which shares may be redeemed,
the amount  payable in the event of voluntary or  involuntary  liquidation,  the
terms and  conditions  for conversion or exchange into any other class or series
of stock,  voting  rights  and other  terms.  No  preferred  stock is  currently
outstanding.


                                      F-32
<PAGE>


19) Dividends Declared

The Board of Directors of the Company  declared annual dividends of $849,000 and
$702,000, respectively for the years ended December 1998 and 1997, respectively,
of which $212,000 and $175,000,  respectively,  were unpaid at December 31, 1998
and 1997, respectively.

20) Stock Performance and Stock Option Plans

On December 30, 1997, the Company adopted a Stock  Performance Plan, under which
up to 350,000 shares of the Company's common stock may be granted and awarded to
key  employees.  The grant of stock under this plan is contingent  upon criteria
established by the Company's  Compensation  Committee of the Board of Directors.
Awards  are  based  on  performance  targets  of the  Company's  stock  based on
increases  in the market value of the  Company's  common stock from the price on
the date the stock is initially granted by the Company.  Shares must be granted,
awarded,  and vested  before  participants  take full  title to the  performance
stock. Awards vest on the occurrence of any of the following events, (i) fifteen
years of continuous service with the Company from the date shares are granted to
the participant, (ii) death or disability of the participant,  (iii) immediately
before a change of control (as defined under the plan),  (iv)  attaining the age
of 65, or (v)  immediately  before a sale or merger (as defined under the plan).
During 1998,  185,282 shares of performance  stock were granted under this plan.
At  December  31,  1998,  no  performance  stock  under this plan was awarded or
vested.

At December  31, 1998,  the Company has a Stock  Option Plan and a  Supplemental
Stock Option Plan (the  "Plans").  The plans are identical  and are  stock-based
compensation   plans,  which  are  described  below.  The  Company  adopted  the
disclosure  requirements of SFAS 123 effective  January 1, 1996 and continues to
account  for  its  employee   stock-based   compensation  plans  under  APB  25.
Accordingly,  the adoption of SFAS 123 had no impact on the Company's  financial
position or results of operations.

Under the Plans a total of  700,000  shares of  common  stock are  reserved  for
issuance.  The Plans provide for the granting to directors,  executives or other
key employees  (including  officers) of the Company  non-qualified stock options
("NQOs") or incentive  stock options  ("ISOs") within the meaning of Section 422
of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended. The exercise price of all ISOs
and NQOs under the Plans are  generally  at least the fair  market  value of the
common stock of the Company on the date of grant.

The Compensation Committee (the "Committee") determines the terms of the options
including  the  exercise   price,   number  of  shares  subject  to  option  and
exercisability.


                                      F-33
<PAGE>


A summary of the status of the Plans as of December 31, 1998,  1997 and 1996 and
changes during the years ended on those dates is presented below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  1998                           1997                          1996
                                          ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                     Weighted-Average              Weighted-Average               Weighted-Average
                                                         Exercise                      Exercise                       Exercise
Fixed Options                              Shares         Price         Shares           Price         Shares           Price
                                          ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                       <C>             <C>           <C>              <C>           <C>              <C>
Outstanding at beginning of year          624,850         $6.12         528,550          $7.53         323,000          $9.33


Granted                                    54,500          6.46         450,750           5.14         225,000           5.09


Exercised

Forfeited                                 (20,150)         7.88        (354,450)          6.87         (19,450)          9.24

Outstanding at end of year                659,200         $6.15         624,850          $6.12         528,550          $7.53
                                          -------                      --------                        -------

Options exercisable at year-end           232,900                       143,450                        124,150
                                          -------                      --------                        -------

Weighted-average fair value of
options granted during the year             $2.17                         $1.29                          $1.21
                                          -------                      --------                        -------
</TABLE>

The following table summarizes  information about the stock options  outstanding
at December 31, 1998:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                         Options Outstanding                                Options Exercisable
                       ----------------------------------------------------------     -------------------------------
                         Number              Weighted-Average        Weighted-          Number           Weighted-
                       Outstanding               Remaining            Average         Exercisable         Average
Exercise Prices        at 12/31/98           Contractual Life      Exercise Price     at 12/31/98      Exercise Price
                       ----------------------------------------------------------     -------------------------------
<S>                    <C>                      <C>                    <C>             <C>                 <C>
    $11.63                 500                  5.08 years             $11.63              400             $11.63

    $10.91               5,000                  5.08                    10.91            4,000              10.91
                                                            
    $10.00              75,750                  4.63                    10.00           75,750              10.00
                                                            
     $8.43              40,200                  6.83                     8.43           24,300               8.43
                                                            
     $8.03              15,000                  8.83                     8.03            3,000               8.03
                                                            
     $7.88              15,000                  6.70                     7.88            9,000               7.88
                                                            
     $7.06              10,000                  7.37                     7.06            4,000               7.06
                                                            
     $6.70              10,000                  9.50                     6.70
                                                            
     $6.64               5,000                  9.00                     6.64            1,000               6.64
                                                            
     $6.60              24,500                  9.94                     6.60
                                                            
     $6.17              20,000                  9.84                     6.17
                                                            
     $5.06             178,250                  8.15                     5.06           36,450               5.06
                                                            
     $5.00             250,000                  8.20                     5.00           73,000               5.00
                                                            
     $4.97              10,000                  8.49                     4.97            2,000               4.97
                       -------                                                         -------
                                                            
                       659,200                  7.78                    $6.15          232,900              $7.30
                       =======                                                         =======
</TABLE>                                              



                                      F-34
<PAGE>


Unless otherwise specified, the options vest and are exerciseable at the rate of
20% per year and terminate  ten years from date of grant.  At December 31, 1998,
1997 and 1996, 232,900,  143,450 and 124,150 options were exerciseable and there
were  40,800,   75,150  and  171,450   options   available  for  future  grants,
respectively.

Had the compensation cost for the Company's stock based  compensation plans been
determined  based on the fair  value at the grant date for  awards  under  those
plans  consistent  with the method of SFAS No. 123, the Company's net income and
earnings  per share would have been reduced to the pro forma  amounts  indicated
below (in thousands, except per share amounts):

                                                      1998       1997      1996
                                                      ----       ----      ----
Net Income                         As reported       $7,282     $4,357    $3,071
                                   Pro forma          7,167      4,280     3,060

Earnings per share - basic         As reported        .86        .62       .44
                                   Pro forma          .85        .61       .44

Earnings per share - diluted       As reported        .85        .62       .44
                                   Pro forma          .84        .60       .44

The fair value of each option  grant is estimated on the date of grant using the
Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following assumptions:  (i) dividend
yield of 1.6%, (ii) expected  volatility range of 30%, (iii) risk-free  interest
rate of 4.7%, and (iv) expected life of 5 years.

21) Quarterly Financial Information (Unaudited)

The following quarterly financial information for each of the three months ended
March 31, June 30,  September 30 and  December  31, 1998 and 1997 is  unaudited.
However,  in the opinion of management,  all  adjustments  (consisting of normal
recurring adjustments) necessary to present fairly the results of operations for
such periods, have been made for a fair presentation of the results shown.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                              For the three months ended
====================================================================================================================================
                                                                           (in thousands, except for per share)

                                                            March 31,          June 30,          September 30,        December 31,
                                                       -----------------   -----------------   -----------------   -----------------
                                                         1998      1997     1998      1997      1998      1997      1998      1997
====================================================================================================================================
<S>                                                    <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>
Revenues                                               $14,809   $12,952   $15,548   $13,787   $17,230   $16,744   $17,424   $16,159
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Net income                                                $971      $228    $1,734      $724    $2,296    $1,547    $2,281    $1,858
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Earnings per share:
         Basic                                           $0.11     $0.03     $0.20     $0.11     $0.27     $0.22     $0.27     $0.26
         Diluted                                          0.11      0.03      0.20      0.11      0.27      0.22      0.27      0.26
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Weighted average shares outstanding:
         Basic                                           8,474     7,020     8,474     7,020     8,474     7,020     8,474     7,036
         Diluted                                         8,596     7,020     8,595     7,020     8,591     7,161     8,580     7,164
====================================================================================================================================
</TABLE>



                                      F-35
<PAGE>


22) Premiums

Of the Company's net premiums earned  approximately  60%, 62% and 63% related to
the  residential  real  estate  program  and  23%,  25% and 24%  related  to the
restaurant  program  for the years  1998,  1997 and 1996,  respectively.  Of the
Company's net premiums earned approximately 90%, 82% and 83% related to insureds
located in New York State for the years 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively.

Premiums  earned for the three years ended  December  31,  1998,  1997 and 1996,
which include assumed  premiums  relating to reinsurance  agreements with RLI of
$6,229,000,  $4,272,000 and $3,878,000 in 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively, are
summarized below:

                                         1998            1997            1996
                                       --------        --------        --------
                                                    (in thousands)

         Direct                         $11,652         $11,496          $9,979

         Assumed                         13,392          11,909           9,869
                                       --------        --------        --------


         Total                           25,044          23,405          19,848

         Ceded                             (355)           (558)           (521)
                                       --------        --------        --------

         Net Premiums Earned            $24,689         $22,847         $19,327
                                       ========        ========        ========

23) Business Segments

The Company  operates in two  insurance  business  segments,  the  procuring  of
property  and  casualty  insurance  ("Insurance  Brokerage  Companies")  and the
underwriting of property and casualty risks ("Property and Casualty Companies").
In addition,  Corporate  Operations  include those  activities  that benefit the
Company in its  entirety  and cannot be  specifically  identified  to either the
Insurance  Brokerage  Companies or the Property  and  Casualty  Companies.  Such
activities  include  debt  servicing  and  public  company  expenses,  including
investor relations costs. The identifiable segment assets, operating profits and
income before income taxes and minority  interests are shown on the accompanying
consolidated balance sheets and statements of income.


                                      F-36
<PAGE>


The following  table is a summary of certain other segment  information  for the
years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996:


                            Business Segments - 1998
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                             Insurance             Property &
(in thousands)                               Brokerage              Casualty
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Revenue from external sources                 $31,324               $24,689
Revenue from other segments                     4,032                    69
Depreciation expense                            1,114                    21
Amortization expense                              678                 7,630
Capital expenditures                            2,089

                            Business Segments - 1997
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                             Insurance             Property &
(in thousands)                               Brokerage              Casualty
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Revenue from external sources                 $28,387               $22,847
Revenue from other segments                     3,830                    65
Depreciation expense                            1,123                    24
Amortization expense                              520                 7,269
Capital expenditures                            1,481

                            Business Segments - 1996
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                             Insurance             Property &
(in thousands)                               Brokerage              Casualty
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Revenue from external sources                 $28,199               $19,327
Revenue from other segments                     3,368                    62
Depreciation expense                            1,024                    23
Amortization expense                              953                 6,086
Capital expenditures                              888

The foreign operations set forth below,  relate solely to the operations of OLB,
and its wholly owned subsidiary Park Brokerage,  and include reinsurance assumed
from  OLRI,  as well as from third  party  insurance  companies.  All such risks
assumed originate in the United States.

                                                  1998
                               --------------------------------------------
                                  Foreign         Domestic       Total
                               --------------------------------------------
                                              (in thousands)
Consolidated Revenues             $2,092          $62,919        $65,011
Income before minority
  interest and income taxes        1,169            9,385         10,554
Identifiable assets                2,936          164,130        167,066


                                      F-37
<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  1997                                 1996
                                     --------------------------------    ----------------------------------
                                      Foreign    Domestic    Total         Foreign    Domestic     Total
                                     --------------------------------    ----------------------------------
                                                                  (in thousands)

<S>                                   <C>        <C>        <C>            <C>         <C>        <C>
Consolidated  Revenues                $2,246     $57,396    $59,642        $2,104      $52,883    $54,987
Income before minority interest
  and income taxes                     1,398       6,157      7,555         2,857        2,354      5,211
Identifiable assets                    3,575     137,450    141,025         4,925      151,177    156,102
</TABLE>

There were no material intercompany revenue transactions between OLB and OLRI.

In 1997, OLRI entered into a novation reinsurance  agreement with National Union
Fire Insurance Company of Pittsburgh, PA. ("N.U."),  pursuant to which OLRI paid
$807,000 and transferred its $950,000 IBNR liability to N.U.

24)  Supplemental Cash Flow Disclosures

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                         1998        1997        1996
                                                         ----        ----        ----
<S>                                                     <C>        <C>          <C>
Cash paid during the period for:
         Interest expense                                 $501        $948      $1,114
         Income taxes (refunded)                        $2,870      $2,000       ($992)

Noncash investing and financing activities:
         Stock issued to purchase minority interest                $10,181

Details of acquisitions:
         Purchase price                                 $5,196      $3,062
         Amounts payable in future periods              (3,300)     (2,285)
         Less acquisition debit repayment                 (657)
                                                      --------    --------

         Cash paid for acquisitions                     $1,239        $777
                                                      ========    ========
</TABLE>

25)  Subsequent Event

On February  25, 1999,  the  Company,  through its  brokerage  subsidiary,  Kaye
Insurance Associates,  Inc., purchased the assets, including customer lists, and
certain liabilities of Seaman,  Ross, & Wiener, Inc. and related entities for an
initial purchase price of $2,930,000 in cash and stock of the Company, effective
January 1, 1999.  The total  purchase  price is  contingent  on future  billings
related to the  acquired  customer  list and could vary  significantly  from the
initial purchase price.


                                      F-38
<PAGE>


                                                                     Schedule II
                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                              (Parent Company Only)
                            Condensed Balance Sheets
                           December 31, 1998 and 1997
                   (in thousands, except par value per share)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                              1998                   1997
                                                                             -------               -------
<S>                                                                          <C>                   <C>
ASSETS

Cash and  cash equivalents                                                      $370                   $65
Prepaid expenses and other assets                                                863                   549
Deferred income taxes                                                                                   41
Due from subsidiaries                                                          2,118                 3,664
Investment in subsidiaries                                                    43,973                38,670
                                                                             -------               -------

    Total assets                                                             $47,324               $42,989
                                                                             =======               =======


LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

LIABILITIES

Accounts payable and other liabilities                                          $511                  $774
Note payable                                                                   1,153                 1,875
Deferred income taxes                                                             20
Income taxes payable                                                             568                    16
                                                                             -------               -------

Total current liabilities                                                      2,252                 2,665
Note payable - long term                                                       3,303                 5,156
                                                                             -------               -------

    Total liabilities                                                          5,555                 7,821
                                                                             -------               -------

STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:

Preferred stock, $1.00 par value; 1,000 shares authorized;
  none issued or outstanding
Common stock, $.01 par value; 20,000 shares authorized;
  8,474 shares issued and outstanding                                             85                    85
Paid-in capital                                                               17,942                17,942
Unrealized appreciation  of investments, net of deferred
  income tax provision , (1998, $280; 1997, $192)                                541                   373
Retained earnings                                                             23,201                16,768
                                                                             -------               -------

    Total stockholders' equity                                                41,769                35,168
                                                                             -------               -------


    Total liabilities and stockholders' equity                               $47,324               $42,989
                                                                             =======               =======
</TABLE>

        The condensed financial statements should be read in conjunction
                 with the consolidated financial statements and
                   notes thereto and the accompanying notes.



                                      F-39
<PAGE>


                                                                     Schedule II

                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                              (Parent Company Only)
                         Condensed Statements of Income
              For the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996
                                 (in thousands)

                                                      1998       1997      1996
                                                    -------    -------   -------
REVENUES:

  Net investment loss                                   (31)
  Equity in income of subsidiaries                   11,342      7,555     5,211

EXPENSES:

  Other operating expenses                              314
  Interest expense                                      443
                                                    -------    -------   -------

Income before income taxes and minority interest     10,554      7,555     5,211

  Provision for income taxes                          3,272      2,267     1,484
                                                    -------    -------   -------

Income before  minority interest                      7,282      5,288     3,727

  Minority interest                                                931       656
                                                    -------    -------   -------

NET INCOME                                            7,282      4,357     3,071
                                                    =======    =======   =======

        The condensed financial statements should be read in conjunction
                 with the consolidated financial statements and
                   notes thereto and the accompanying notes.



                                      F-40
<PAGE>


                                                                     Schedule II

                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                              (PARENT COMPANY ONLY)
                       Condensed Statements of Cash Flows
              For the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996
                                 (in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                         1998          1997          1996
                                                       --------      --------      --------
<S>                                                      <C>          <C>            <C>
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income                                             $7,282        $4,357        $3,071

Adjustment to reconcile net income to net cash
provided by (used in) operating activities:
  Deferred income tax benefit                              (150)
  Equity in net income of subsidiaries                   (7,826)       (6,590)       (3,071)
  Dividends received from subsidiaries                    4,060         6,350           702
  Minority interest                                                       931
  Change in assets and liabilities:
    Prepaid expenses and other assets                       (20)         (199)
    Due from subsidiaries                                 1,294        (3,892)       (1,356)
    Accounts payable and other liabilities                 (263)
    Income taxes payable                                    552          (137)        1,356
                                                       --------      --------      --------

  Net cash provided by operating activities               4,929           820           702
                                                       --------      --------      --------

CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Payment of dividends                                     (849)         (852)         (702)
  Notes payable-repayment                                (7,575)          (69)
  Proceeds from borrowing                                 5,000
  Capital contribution to subsidiary                     (1,200)         (300)
                                                       --------      --------      --------

  Net cash used in financing activities                  (4,624)       (1,221)         (702)
                                                       --------      --------      --------

NET CHANGE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS                     305          (401)

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period             65           466
                                                       --------      --------      --------

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period                 $370           $65
                                                       ========      ========      ========


SUPPLEMENTAL CASH FLOW DISCLOSURES

Cash paid during the period for:
  Interest expense                                         $480          $548          $514
  Income taxes (refunded)                                $2,870        $2,000         ($992)

Noncash investing and financing activities:
  Stock issued to purchase minority interest                          $10,181
</TABLE>

        The condensed financial statements should be read in conjunction
                 with the consolidated financial statements and
                   notes thereto and the accompanying notes.



                                      F-41
<PAGE>


                                                                     Schedule II

                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                              (Parent Company Only)
                     Notes to Condensed Financial Statements

1.   Condensed Financial Statements

     Certain information and footnote disclosures normally included in financial
     statements  prepared  in  accordance  with  generally  accepted  accounting
     principles  have been  condensed  or omitted.  It is  suggested  that these
     condensed  financial  statements be read in conjunction  with the Company's
     consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto.

2.   Basis of Presentation

     As  detailed  in Note 2 to the  consolidated  financial  statements  of the
     Company,  Kaye Holding Corp.  ("KHC"),  (a subsidiary)  was merged into the
     Company on December 30, 1997. Accordingly, prior to 1998 corporate expenses
     and  investment  income  were  recorded  by KHC  and are  reflected  in the
     condensed   statements   of  income   included   in  equity  in  income  of
     subsidiaries.

3.   Significant Accounting Policies

     The Company carries its investment in subsidiaries under the equity method.
     All other accounting policies are consistent with those of the Company on a
     consolidated basis.



                                      F-42
<PAGE>


                                                                     Schedule IV


                                 KAYE GROUP INC.
                                   REINSURANCE
              For The Years Ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996
                                 (in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
================================================================================================================================

     Column A             Column B            Column C                Column D               Column E              Column F

================================================================================================================================
                                                                                                                  Percentage
     Insurance              Gross          Ceded To Other           Assumed from                                  of Amount
  Premiums Earned          Amount             Companies           Other Companies           Net Amount          Assumed to Net
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                        <C>                   <C>                   <C>                    <C>                    <C>
        1998               $11,652               $355                  $13,392                $24,689                54%

        1997               $11,496               $558                  $11,909                $22,847                52%

        1996                $9,979               $521                   $9,869                $19,327                51%
</TABLE>



                                      F-43
<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                         Schedule VI


                                                           KAYE GROUP INC

                           SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION CONCERNING PROPERTY AND CASUALTY INSURANCE OPERATIONS
                                        For the years ended December 31, 1998, 1997 and 1996
                                                           (in thousands)

==============================================================================================================================

  Column A            Column B           Column C          Column D          Column E           Column F       Column G
==============================================================================================================================

                                        Reserves For
                                       Unpaid Claims        Discount
Affiliation            Deferred          And Claim           If Any                                               Net
    With             Acquisition         Adjustment       Deducted In       Unearned            Earned         Investment
 Registrant             Costs             Expenses          Column C        Premiums           Premiums          Income
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                     <C>              <C>                  <C>           <C>                <C>               <C>
Foreign                   $193              $295              N/A              $916             $1,957             $135
Domestic                 3,728            21,272              N/A            11,411             22,732            2,453
                    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

1998                    $3,921           $21,567              N/A           $12,327            $24,689           $2,588
                    ==========================================================================================================

Foreign                   $240              $204              N/A            $1,132             $2,118             $127
Domestic                 3,699            18,922              N/A            11,446             20,729            2,565
                    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

1997                    $3,939           $19,126              N/A           $12,578            $22,847           $2,692
                    ==========================================================================================================

Foreign                   $295              $160              N/A            $1,311             $1,542             $271
Domestic                 3,778            15,067              N/A            11,865             17,785            2,190
                    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

1996                    $4,073           $15,227              N/A           $13,176            $19,327           $2,461
                    ==========================================================================================================

<CAPTION>
==================================================================================================================================

  Column A                   Column H                      Column I              Column J           Column K           Column L
==================================================================================================================================
                           Claims and Claim
                         Adjustment Expenses                                      Paid
                         Incurred Related to            Amortization             Claims
Affiliation              (1)               (2)           Of Deferred            and Claim                                Other
    With               Current            Prior          Acquisition            Adjustment          Premiums           Operating
 Registrant             Year              Years             Costs                Expenses           Written             Expenses
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                    <C>                  <C>             <C>                   <C>               <C>                  <C>
Foreign                  $313                $95              $414                  $317             $1,742                $102
Domestic                8,148                (60)            7,216                 6,147             22,796               2,178
                    --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

1998                   $8,461                $35            $7,630                $6,464            $24,538              $2,280
                    ==============================================================================================================

Foreign                  $326               ($47)             $456                  $234             $1,938                $113
Domestic                8,498                (61)            6,813                 6,512             20,332               1,988
                    --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

1997                   $8,824              ($108)           $7,269                $6,746            $22,270              $2,101
                    ==============================================================================================================

Foreign                  $313            ($1,580)             $347                $3,637             $1,411                $167
Domestic                6,308              1,995             5,739                 1,725             19,278               1,965
                    --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

1996                   $6,621               $415            $6,086                $5,362            $20,689              $2,132
                    ==============================================================================================================
</TABLE>


                                                                F-44














                                 LOAN AGREEMENT

                                 by and between

                                 KAYE GROUP INC.

                                       and

                                   SUMMIT BANK





                                  June 24, 1998






<PAGE>




                                TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                            Page
                                                                            ----


I. DEFINITIONS...............................................................  1
           1.1 Defined Terms.................................................  1


II.  LOANS ..................................................................  8
           2.1 Advances......................................................  8
           2.2 Procedure for Advances........................................  8
           2.3 Revolving Credit Note.........................................  8
           2.4 Interest Rate Under Revolving Credit Note.....................  8
           2.5 Payments Under Revolving Credit Note..........................  9
           2.6 Use of Proceeds of Advances...................................  9
           2.7 Optional Prepayments of Revolving Credit Note.................  9
           2.8 Mandatory Prepayment of Revolving Credit Note.................  9
           2.9 Acquisition Advances..........................................  9
           2.10 Procedure for Acquisition Advances...........................  9
           2.11 Acquisition Notes............................................ 10
           2.12 Interest Rate Under Acquisition Notes........................ 10
           2.13 Principal and Interest Payments Under Acquisition Notes...... 11
           2.14 Optional Prepayments of Acquisition Notes.................... 11
           2.15 Use of Proceeds of Acquisition Advances...................... 11
           2.16 Term Loan and Term Note...................................... 11
           2.17 Interest Rate Under Term Note................................ 11
           2.18 Principal and Interest Payments Under Term Note.............. 11
           2.19 Use of Proceeds of Term Loan................................. 12
           2.20 Optional Prepayments of Term Note............................ 12
           2.21 LIBOR Based Rate Loan Limitations............................ 12
           2.22 Interest Periods............................................. 12
           2.23 Conversion................................................... 12
           2.24 Alternate Interest Rate...................................... 13
           2.25 Indemnification For LIBOR Based Rate Loans................... 13
           2.26 Changes in Circumstances..................................... 13
           2.27 Additional Costs and Expenses................................ 14
           2.28 Method of Payment............................................ 15
           2.29 Business Day................................................. 15
           2.30 Charge....................................................... 16
           2.31 Bank Fees.................................................... 16
           2.32 Bank's Counsel Fees.......................................... 16


III. COLLATERAL SECURITY..................................................... 16
           3.1 Collateral Security........................................... 16


                                      -i-
<PAGE>

IV. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES........................................... 17
           4.1 Controlling Shareholders; Subsidiaries........................ 17
           4.2 Organization; Power; Qualification............................ 17
           4.3 Authorization of Agreement.................................... 17
           4.4 No Legal Bar.................................................. 17
           4.5 Consent....................................................... 17
           4.6 Compliance With Law........................................... 18
           4.7 Title to Properties and Assets; Liens......................... 18
           4.8 No Default.................................................... 18
           4.9 No Litigation................................................. 18
           4.10 No Burdensome Restrictions................................... 18
           4.11 Tax Returns and Payments..................................... 19
           4.12 Financial Statements......................................... 19
           4.13 No Adverse Changes........................................... 19
           4.14 ERISA ....................................................... 19
           4.15 Federal Reserve Regulations.................................. 20
           4.16 Solvency..................................................... 20
           4.17 Accuracy and Completeness of Information..................... 20
           4.18 Permits...................................................... 21
           4.19 Year 2000 Compliance......................................... 21


V. COVENANTS................................................................. 21
           5.1 Preservation of Existence..................................... 21
           5.2 Nature of Business............................................ 21
           5.3 Compliance with Laws.......................................... 22
           5.4 Maintenance of Properties..................................... 22
           5.5 Accounting Methods............................................ 22
           5.6 Payment of Taxes and Claims................................... 22
           5.7 Visits and Inspections; Field Examinations.................... 22
           5.8 Information Covenants......................................... 23
                      (i) Annual Financial Statements........................ 23
                      (ii) Annual SAP Financial Statements................... 23
                      (iii) Quarterly SAP Statements......................... 24
                      (iv) SEC Filings....................................... 24
                      (v) Adequacy of Reserves............................... 24
                      (vi) Certificate....................................... 24
                      (vii) Copies of Other Reports.......................... 24
                      (viii) Notice of Litigation and Other Matters.......... 25
                      (ix) ERISA ............................................ 25
           5.9 Accuracy and Completeness of Information...................... 25
           5.10 Insurance.................................................... 26
           5.11 Indebtedness................................................. 26
           5.12 Liens ....................................................... 26
           5.13 Sale of Assets; Merger; Acquisitions......................... 26
           5.14 Guarantees................................................... 26


                                      -ii-
<PAGE>

           5.15 Issuance of Stock............................................ 26
           5.16 [Intentionally Omitted]...................................... 27
           5.17 Financial Covenants.......................................... 27
           5.18 OLRI Rating.................................................. 27
           5.19 New Subsidiaries............................................. 27
           5.20 Out-of-Debt Period........................................... 28
           5.21 Further Documentation........................................ 28
           5.22 Bank's Appointment as Attorney-in-Fact....................... 28
           5.23 Performance by Bank of Borrower's Obligations................ 29
           5.24 Year 2000 Compliance......................................... 29


VI. CONDITIONS PRECEDENT..................................................... 29
           6.1 Initial Conditions Precedent.................................. 29
           6.2 Conditions Precedent to Additional
               Advances and Acquisition Advances............................. 30


VII. EVENTS OF DEFAULT....................................................... 31


VIII. REMEDIES............................................................... 33


IX. INDEMNIFICATION.......................................................... 34
           9.1 Indemnification............................................... 34


X. MISCELLANEOUS............................................................. 35
           10.1 Notice....................................................... 35
           10.2 No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies............................... 36
           10.3 Survival of Agreements....................................... 36
           10.4 Amendment.................................................... 36
           10.5 Successors and Assigns....................................... 36
           10.6 Severability................................................. 36
           10.7 Counterparts................................................. 36
           10.8 Governing Law; No Third Party Rights......................... 36
           10.9 WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL; CONSENT TO JURISDICTION................ 37






                                     -iii-
<PAGE>


     THIS LOAN AGREEMENT is dated June 24, 1998 and is by and between KAYE GROUP
INC., a Delaware  corporation having its principal  executive offices located at
122 East 42nd Street, New York, New York 10168 (the "Borrower") and SUMMIT BANK,
a banking institution of the State of New Jersey having an office located at 250
Moore Street, Hackensack, New Jersey 07601 (the "Bank").

                                    RECITALS

     A. The Borrower has  requested  that the Bank make certain loans and extend
certain credit to the Borrower.

     B. The Bank has agreed to make such loans and extend  such  credit,  all on
the terms and conditions hereinafter set forth.

     NOW,  THEREFORE,  in  consideration  of the premises and mutual  agreements
herein  contained,  and other good and valuable  consideration,  the receipt and
sufficiency  of which are  hereby  acknowledged,  the  parties  hereto  agree as
follows:

     I. DEFINITIONS

     1.1 Defined Terms. As used in this Agreement, the following words and terms
shall have the following meanings:

     "Acquisition"  shall  mean  the  purchase  by  the  Borrower  or one of its
Subsidiaries of (i) all or substantially  all of the capital stock,  partnership
interests  or  other   beneficial   ownership   interests  of  any  corporation,
partnership,   limited  liability  company  or  other  entity  or  (ii)  all  or
substantially  all of the assets of any such corporation,  partnership,  limited
liability company or other entity.

     "Acquisition  Advance Request" shall have the meaning ascribed to such term
in Section 2.10 hereof.

     "Acquisition Advances" shall mean advances by the Bank to the Borrower, all
of the proceeds of which are used to finance one or more Acquisitions.

     "Acquisition Notes" shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in Section
2.11 hereof.

     "Advance  Request" shall have the meaning  ascribed to such term in Section
2.2 hereof.

     "Advances"  shall have the  meaning  ascribed  to such term in Section  2.1
hereof.

     "Affiliate" shall mean as to any specified Person:

     (a)  any  Person  that   directly  or   indirectly   through  one  or  more
intermediaries  controls or is controlled by or is under common control with the
specified Person;


<PAGE>


     (b) any Person that is an officer of,  partner in, or trustee of, or serves
in a similar capacity with respect to, the specified  Person,  or of or in which
the specified Person is an officer, partner or trustee, or with respect to which
the specified Person serves in a similar capacity;

     (c) any Person that, directly or indirectly, is the beneficial owner of 20%
or more of any  class of equity  securities  of the  specified  Person or is the
beneficial  owner of an  interest  of 20% or more in the  capital  profit of the
specified Person;

     (d) any Person of which the specified  Person is directly or indirectly the
beneficial  owner of any amount of any class of equity  securities or any Person
of which the  specified  Person is the  beneficial  owner of any interest in the
capital and profits; or

     (e) any member of the immediate family of the specified Person.

     "Agreement"  shall  mean this  Loan  Agreement,  together  with any and all
exhibits, schedules, amendments or supplements hereto.

     "Applicable  Amortization  Period" shall have the meaning  ascribed to such
term in Section 2.10 hereof.

     "Applicable  Interest  Rate"  shall mean either the LIBOR Based Rate or the
Base Rate.

     "Bank" shall mean Summit Bank,  a banking  institution  of the State of New
Jersey, and its successors and assigns.

     "Bank Costs" shall mean all taxes and insurance  premiums of every kind and
nature of the Borrower paid by the Bank; all filing, recording, publication, and
search fees incurred in connection with and relating to the Borrower paid by the
Bank; all  out-of-pocket  costs incurred and sums expended by the Bank,  with or
without suit, to correct any default, to make advances of principal and interest
or  payments  to prior  secured  parties,  to enforce any right or remedy of the
Bank, or in connection with any other provision of any Loan Document,  including
without limitation, any out-of-pocket costs incurred by the Bank with respect to
any other lender in  connection  with the Loan  Documents  and the  transactions
contemplated  thereby;  all  out-of-pocket  costs  incurred and sums expended in
gaining possession of, inspection of, maintaining,  handling, selling, preparing
for sale,  and  advertising  to sell the  Collateral,  whether  or not a sale is
consummated;  out-of-pocket  costs of suit  incurred by the Bank in enforcing or
defending this Agreement or any other Loan Document or any portion thereof;  all
out-of-pocket  costs  and  expenses  including  reasonable  attorneys'  fees and
expenses  incurred by the Bank in  preparing,  reviewing,  enforcing,  amending,
modifying,  extending  administering,  defending  or otherwise  concerning  this
Agreement  or any other Loan  Document  or any portion  hereof or  thereof;  and
whether or not suit is  brought,  all  out-of-pocket  costs of  arbitration  and
insolvency proceedings.

     "Base Rate" shall mean the rate of interest  announced from time to time by
the Bank as its "base  rate" or "base  lending  rate".  This rate of interest is
determined from time to time by the Bank


                                      -2-
<PAGE>

as a means of pricing  some loans to its  customers  and is neither  tied to any
external  rate of interest or index nor does it  necessarily  reflect the lowest
rate of  interest  actually  charged  by the  Bank to any  particular  class  or
category of customers of the Bank.

     "Base  Rate  Loans"  shall  collectively  mean that  portion  of the Credit
Facility bearing interest at the Base Rate.

     "Borrower"  shall mean Kaye Group  Inc.,  a Delaware  corporation,  and its
successors and assigns.

     "Business  Day" shall mean any day other than a  Saturday,  Sunday or other
day on which state or federally  chartered  banks in the State of New Jersey are
authorized to close.

     "Collateral"  shall have the  meaning  ascribed to such term in Section 3.1
hereof.

     "Consolidated  GAAP Net Worth"  means the sum of (a) the capital  stock and
additional   paid-in  capital  of  the  Borrower  and  its   Subsidiaries  on  a
consolidated  basis,  plus  (without  duplication)  (b) the  amount of  retained
earnings (or, in the case of a deficit,  minus the deficit),  minus (c) treasury
stock,  plus or  minus  (d) any  other  account  which is  customarily  added or
deducted in determining  stockholders'  equity, all of which shall be determined
on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP,  provided that unrealized gains
or losses in respect of publicly traded debt and equity securities (as otherwise
required by the  Statement of Financial  Accounting  Standards No. 115) shall be
excluded in determining Consolidated GAAP Net Worth.

     "Consolidated Net Income" shall mean, for any period,  the consolidated net
income of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries determined in accordance with GAAP.

     "Credit  Facility"  shall  mean,  collectively,  the  Revolving  Loan,  the
Acquisition Advances and the Term Loan.

     "Debt Service Coverage Ratio" shall mean, for any period,  the ratio of (i)
Consolidated Net Income,  plus  depreciation and  amortization,  plus historical
interest expense,  minus dividends and distributions,  to the current portion of
the Borrower's  Indebtedness  (but excluding the outstanding  Advances under the
Revolving Loan) plus the Borrower's interest expense.

     "Default"  shall mean any of the  events  specified  in Article  VII hereof
which, with the passage of time or giving of notice or both, would constitute an
Event of Default.

     "Event of Default"  shall mean any of the events  specified  in Article VII
hereof,  provided that any  requirement for notice or lapse of time or any other
condition has been satisfied.

     "Existing  Guarantors" shall  collectively mean Kaye Insurance  Associates,
Inc., Kaye Corporation of Connecticut,  Kaye Administrators Corp., Kaye Services
Corp.,  Kaye-Western  Insurance & Risk  Services,  Inc.  and  Program  Brokerage
Corporation, each of which is a wholly owned subsidiary of the Borrower.



                                      -3-
<PAGE>

     "GAAP" shall mean generally  accepted  accounting  principles in the United
States of America as in effect from time to time.

     "Guarantors" shall  collectively mean (i) the Existing  Guarantors and (ii)
any other Affiliate or Subsidiary of the Borrower which executes and delivers to
the Bank a guaranty  agreement in form and substance  satisfactory  to the Bank,
pursuant to which such Affiliate or Subsidiary unconditionally guarantees all of
the Borrower's obligations hereunder.

     "Guaranty  Agreement"  shall  mean  the  guaranty  agreement  of even  date
herewith  executed and delivered by each of the Existing  Guarantors in favor of
the Bank,  together  with all  modifications  thereto,  extensions  thereof  and
substitutions therefor.

     "Indebtedness"  shall mean (i) all items (other than capital stock, capital
surplus and retained  earnings)  which in accordance with GAAP would be included
in  determining  total  liabilities  as shown on the liability side of a balance
sheet as at the date on which  Indebtedness is to be determined and (ii) whether
or not so  reflected,  all  indebtedness,  contingent  or otherwise  and whether
unsecured or secured by any Lien, and all capitalized lease obligations.

     "Insurance  Subsidiary" shall mean OLRI, Old Lyme Insurance Company,  Ltd.,
and any other insurance company Subsidiary  hereafter acquired or created by the
Borrower.

     "Interest  Payment Date" shall mean (i) with respect to any Base Rate Loan,
the fifth day of each calendar  month,  and (ii) with respect to any LIBOR Based
Rate Loan, the last day of the Interest Period applicable thereto.

     "Interest  Period" shall have the meaning  ascribed to such term in Section
2.22 hereof.

     "LIBOR Based Rate" shall mean the LIBOR Rate plus 175 basis points.

     "LIBOR Based Rate Loans" shall collectively mean that portion of the Credit
Facility bearing interest at the LIBOR Based Rate.

     "LIBOR Rate" shall mean the rate of interest  for deposits in U.S.  Dollars
for a maturity equal to the Interest  Period  therefor which appears on Telerate
Page 3750 as of 11:00 a.m.,  London time,  on the date that is two Business Days
prior to the commencement of such Interest Period.  If such rate does not appear
on Telerate Page 3750, the rate utilized shall be the rate which appears,  or if
two or more such rates appear, the average (rounded upward, if necessary, to the
next 1/16 of 1%) of the rates which appear,  on the Reuters  Screen LIBO Page as
of 11:00 a.m.,  London time,  on the date that is two Business Days prior to the
commencement of such Interest Period.

     "Lien" shall mean any lien  (statutory or  otherwise),  security  interest,
mortgage,  deed of trust,  priority,  pledge,  charge,  conditional  sale, title
retention  agreement,  financing lease or other  encumbrance or similar right of
others, or any agreement to give any of the foregoing.



                                      -4-
<PAGE>

     "Loan Documents"  shall  collectively  mean this Agreement,  the Notes, the
Guaranty Agreement,  the Pledge and Security Agreement and all other agreements,
documents,  financing  statements,  instruments  and  certificates  executed and
delivered to the Bank in  connection  herewith or  therewith,  together with all
modifications to, extensions of and substitutions for the foregoing.

     "Maximum Amount" shall mean $4,500,000.

     "Net  Premiums  Written" for any period means the net premiums that appear,
or should appear, on the SAP Financial Statements of an Insurance Subsidiary.

     "Notes" shall  collectively  mean the Revolving Note, the Term Note and the
Acquisition Notes, together with all modifications  thereto,  extensions thereof
and substitutions therefor.

     "Notice of Conversion/Continuation" shall have the meaning ascribed to such
term in Section 2.23 hereof.

     "Obligations" shall mean all loans, advances,  extensions of credit, letter
of credit fees, debts, liabilities, obligations, payments, guarantees, covenants
and  duties  owing by the  Borrower  to the Bank,  of any kind and  description,
direct or indirect  (including any  participation or interest of the Bank in any
obligation  of the  Borrower to any other  Person),  voluntary  or  involuntary,
absolute or contingent, due or to become due, now existing or hereafter incurred
or  created,  whether  or not  related  to or of the  same  class  as the  loans
described  herein,  and  further  including  all  Bank  Costs,  audit  fees  and
commitment fees.

     "OLRI"  shall mean Old Lyme  Insurance  Company of Rhode  Island,  Inc.,  a
wholly owned Subsidiary of the Borrower, and its successors and assigns.

     "Permits"  shall have the  meaning  ascribed  to such term in Section  4.19
hereof.

     "Permitted Acquisition" shall mean an Acquisition of an insurance brokerage
firm  in  which  the  total  consideration  being  paid by the  Borrower  or its
Subsidiary   (including  without  limitation  purchase  price,   non-competition
payments and the amount of debt assumed)  does not exceed 15% of the  Borrower's
Consolidated  GAAP Net Worth as  reflected  on the most recent  fiscal  year-end
financial statement or Form 10-Q report delivered by the Borrower to the Bank.

     "Permitted Indebtedness" shall mean:

     (i) Indebtedness owing to the Bank;

     (ii) Indebtedness  incurred in favor of trade creditors and in the ordinary
course of business and not more than 90 days overdue  (unless a longer period is
consistent with accepted trade practice,  provided that such longer period shall
not exceed 120 days or unless being  contested in good faith and by  appropriate
proceedings  promptly  initiated and diligently  conducted,  but only as long as
foreclosure,  distraint,  sale or other similar  proceedings shall not have been
commenced


                                      -5-
<PAGE>

and such reserve or other appropriate provision, if any, as shall be required by
GAAP shall have been provided therefor);

     (iii) Indebtedness in respect of taxes, assessments,  governmental charges,
worker's  compensation,  levies and claims for labor,  materials,  supplies  and
rentals to the extent otherwise  permitted under this Agreement to remain unpaid
and undischarged; and

     (iv)  Indebtedness  existing  on the date  hereof  and fully  described  on
Schedule I attached hereto.

     "Permitted Liens" shall mean:

     (i) any Lien in favor of the Bank;

     (ii) Liens that exist on the date  hereof and are set forth on  Schedule II
attached hereto;

     (iii) Liens for taxes,  assessments or  governmental  charges or levies not
yet due or which are delinquent and which are being  contested in good faith and
by appropriate proceedings promptly initiated and diligently conducted for which
reserves have been  established in accordance with GAAP with respect thereto and
as to which foreclosure,  distraint, sale or other similar proceedings shall not
have been commenced;

     (iv) carriers', warehousemen's,  mechanics', materialmen's,  repairmen's or
other  like Liens  arising  in the  ordinary  course of  business  which are not
overdue  or  which  are  being  contested  in  good  faith  and  by  appropriate
proceedings  promptly initiated and diligently conducted for which reserves have
been  established in accordance  with GAAP with respect  thereto and as to which
foreclosure,  distraint,  sale or other similar  proceedings shall not have been
commenced;

     (v) pledges or deposits in connection with workers' compensation,  workers'
compensation  insurance,   unemployment  insurance  and  other  social  security
legislation;

     (vi) deposits to secure the  performance of bids,  trade  contracts  (other
than for  borrowed  money),  statutory  obligations,  surety and  appeal  bonds,
performance  bonds  and  other  obligations  of a like  nature  incurred  in the
ordinary course of business; and

     (vii) Liens created by or existing from any litigation or legal proceeding;
provided that the execution or other  enforcement  of such Liens is  effectively
stayed, the claims secured thereby are being actively contested in good faith by
appropriate  proceedings,  adequate  book  reserves  have  been  established  in
accordance  with GAAP with  respect  thereto  and no Default or Event of Default
arises or is created as a result thereof.

     "Person" shall mean any individual, corporation,  partnership, association,
limited  liability   company,   joint  stock  company,   trust,   unincorporated
organization,  joint  venture,  court or government or political  subdivision or
agency thereof.



                                      -6-
<PAGE>

     "Plans"  shall have the meaning  ascribed  to such term in Section  4.14(b)
hereof.

     "Pledge  and  Security  Agreement"  shall  mean  the  pledge  and  security
agreement of even date herewith from the Borrower in favor of the Bank, together
with all modifications thereto,  extensions thereof and substitutions  therefor,
pursuant to which the Borrower has pledged, assigned and transferred to the Bank
all of the Borrower's  right,  title and interest in and to the capital stock of
OLRI, Old Lyme Insurance Company,  Ltd. and Claims  Administration  Corporation,
all on the terms and conditions set forth therein.

     "Revolving  Loan" shall have the  meaning  ascribed to such term in Section
2.3 hereof.

     "Revolving  Note" shall have the  meaning  ascribed to such term in Section
2.3 hereof.

     "Revolving Loan Termination Date" shall mean July 31, 1999.

     "SAP" means the statutory  accounting  practices permitted or prescribed by
the  insurance   regulatory  authority  having  authority  over  each  Insurance
Subsidiary.

     "SAP Financial Statements" means the financial statements of each Insurance
Subsidiary,  which have been  submitted  or are  required to be submitted to the
insurance regulatory authority having authority over each Insurance Subsidiary.

     "Statutory Net Income" for any period means the net income that appears, or
should appear, on the SAP Financial Statements of an Insurance Subsidiary.

     "Statutory  Surplus"  for any period  means the surplus  that  appears,  or
should appear, on the SAP Financial Statements of an Insurance Subsidiary.

     "Subsidiary" with respect to any Person means any corporation,  partnership
or joint venture whether now existing or hereafter organized or acquired: (i) in
the case of a corporation, of which a majority of the securities having ordinary
voting power for the election of directors  (other than  securities  having such
power only by reason of the happening of a contingency) are at the time owned by
such Person and/or one or more  Subsidiaries  of such Person or (ii) in the case
of a partnership or joint venture,  in which such Person is a general partner or
joint  venturer or of which a majority  of the  partnership  or other  ownership
interests  are at the  time  owned  by  such  Person  and/or  one or more of its
Subsidiaries.   Unless  the  context  otherwise  requires,  references  in  this
Agreement to "Subsidiary" or "Subsidiaries"  shall be deemed to be references to
a Subsidiary  or  Subsidiaries  of the (i) Borrower or (ii) a Subsidiary  of the
Borrower.

     "Term Loan" shall have the  meaning  ascribed to such term in Section  2.16
hereof.

     "Term Loan Maturity Date" shall mean June 24, 2002.

     "Term Note" shall have the  meaning  ascribed to such term in Section  2.16
hereof.



                                      -7-
<PAGE>

     1.2 The words  "hereof",  "herein",  and  "hereunder"  and words of similar
import when used in this Agreement  shall refer to this Agreement as a whole and
not to any  particular  provision of this  Agreement,  and section,  subsection,
schedule  and  exhibit   references  are  to  this  Agreement  unless  otherwise
specified.

     1.3 As  used in this  Agreement  or in any  certificate,  report  or  other
document made or delivered  pursuant to this Agreement,  accounting  terms which
are not otherwise defined shall have the meanings given to them under GAAP.

     II. LOANS

     A. Revolving Loan.

     2.1  Advances.  From time to time,  during the period  from the date hereof
until the Revolving Loan Termination Date, in the manner  hereinafter set forth,
the Borrower may borrow from the Bank and, upon request of the Borrower and upon
the terms and conditions contained herein, the Bank shall lend to the Borrower a
sum or sums (the "Advances") which, when added to the aggregate principal amount
of all other  Advances and  Acquisition  Advances  then  outstanding,  shall not
exceed in the aggregate at any time the Maximum  Amount.  It is  understood  and
agreed that the term  "Advances"  shall not be deemed to include any Acquisition
Advances made hereunder.

     2.2 Procedure for Advances.  Subject to the terms and  conditions set forth
herein,  the Borrower may borrow, pay or prepay and reborrow from the Bank under
this Revolving Loan. Each Advance shall be made upon prior written or telephonic
(followed  by  written)  notice  from the  Borrower  to the  Bank  (an  "Advance
Request") specifying (i) the proposed date of such borrowing, (ii) the principal
amount thereof,  (iii) the Applicable Interest Rate and (iv) if the Advance will
be a LIBOR Based Rate Loan, the applicable Interest Period. Each Advance Request
shall be  received  by the Bank not later  than 12:00  p.m.  (A) at least  three
Business Days prior to the requested  date of the Advance in the case of a LIBOR
Based Rate Loan or (B) on the same  Business  Day of the  requested  date of the
Advance in the case of a Base Rate Loan. On the date of each such Advance,  upon
fulfillment  of the conditions  precedent set forth herein,  the Bank shall make
available to the Borrower the amount of such Advance by transferring  such funds
to the account  maintained at the Bank's principal office located at the address
set forth on the first page of this  Agreement  or in  accordance  with  written
instructions provided by the Borrower and reasonably acceptable to the Bank.

     2.3  Revolving  Note.  The  indebtedness  of the  Borrower to the Bank with
respect to the Advances made from time to time hereunder (the "Revolving  Loan")
shall be  evidenced  by a revolving  note made payable to the order of the Bank,
dated the date hereof,  signed by the  Borrower and  delivered to the Bank (such
revolving  credit note,  together  with all  modifications  thereto,  extensions
thereof and  substitutions  therefor,  is herein  referred to as the  "Revolving
Note").

     2.4 Interest Rate Under Revolving Note. Except as provided in Sections 2.24
and 2.26 hereof,  (a) the outstanding  daily principal  balance of the Revolving
Note  representing  LIBOR Based Rate Loans shall bear  interest for the Interest
Periods  applicable  thereto at a rate per annum


                                      -8-
<PAGE>

equal to the LIBOR Based Rate, and (b) the outstanding  daily principal  balance
of the  Revolving  Note  representing  Base Rate Loans shall bear  interest at a
fluctuating  rate  per  annum  equal  to  the  Base  Rate.  Notwithstanding  the
foregoing,  upon the  occurrence  of an Event of Default,  the entire  principal
amount  outstanding  under the  Revolving  Note shall bear such  higher  rate as
provided in the Revolving  Note.  Interest shall be calculated on the basis of a
360-day year for the actual number of days elapsed. The rate of interest on that
portion of the outstanding  principal amount of the Revolving Note  representing
Base Rate Loans shall be adjusted automatically as of the opening of business on
each day on which any  change in the Base Rate is  announced  by the Bank at its
principal office.

     2.5 Payments Under Revolving Note.

     (a) Interest  under the  Revolving  Note shall be payable on each  Interest
Payment  Date  applicable  to the Base Rate  Loans and LIBOR  Based  Rate  Loans
outstanding thereunder.

     (b) Subject to the Bank's right of  acceleration  upon the occurrence of an
Event of Default,  all principal,  interest and other amounts  outstanding under
the Revolving  Note shall be  immediately  due and payable on the Revolving Loan
Termination Date, without any requirement of notice or otherwise.

     2.6 Use of Proceeds of  Advances.  Proceeds  of the  Advances  have been or
shall be utilized by the Borrower for general corporate purposes.

     2.7 Optional Prepayments of Revolving Note. Subject to Section 2.25 hereof,
the  Borrower  shall have the right to prepay,  in whole or in part and  without
premium or penalty, the Revolving Note at any time and from time to time.

     2.8 Mandatory Prepayment of Revolving Note. If at any time and for whatever
reason the aggregate  outstanding  principal amount of Advances hereunder,  when
added to the aggregate  original  principal  amount of all Acquisition  Advances
made hereunder,  exceeds the Maximum Amount, such excess,  together with accrued
interest  thereon,  shall be due and payable by the  Borrower  immediately  upon
demand by the Bank.

     B. Acquisition Advances.

     2.9  Acquisition  Advances.  From time to time,  during the period from the
date hereof until the Revolving Loan Termination Date, in the manner hereinafter
set forth,  the  Borrower  may  borrow  from the Bank and,  upon  request of the
Borrower and upon the terms and conditions contained herein, the Bank shall lend
a sum or sums (the  "Acquisition  Advances")  which, when added to the aggregate
principal  amount of all Advances then  outstanding  and the aggregate  original
principal  amount of all other  Acquisition  Advances made hereunder,  shall not
exceed in the aggregate at any time the Maximum Amount.

     2.10  Procedure  for  Acquisition  Advances.   Subject  to  the  terms  and
conditions set forth herein, the Borrower may borrow from, and pay or prepay to,
the Bank  Acquisition  Advances.  The Borrower  shall give the Bank at least ten
Business  Days' prior written  notice of any requested


                                      -9-
<PAGE>

Acquisition Advance (an "Acquisition Advance Request"). Each Acquisition Advance
Request shall specify (a) the proposed date of such borrowing, (b) the principal
amount thereof, (c) the Applicable Interest Rate, (d) if the Acquisition Advance
will be a LIBOR Based Rate Loan, the applicable Interest Period, (e) the period,
which shall not be more than five years,  over which the Acquisition  Note shall
be repaid (the  "Applicable  Amortization  Period") and (f) the salient terms of
the Acquisition,  including without limitation a description of the Acquisition,
the purchase price and all other  consideration being paid to or received by the
seller(s),  the  identity  of the  seller(s)  and the nature of the  transaction
(i.e., a stock purchase or an asset purchase).  Concurrently  with providing the
Acquisition Advance Request (or as soon thereafter as the Acquisition  agreement
has been  executed and  delivered),  the Borrower  shall provide the Bank with a
copy of the fully executed Acquisition agreement certified by the Borrower to be
true and accurate.  Notwithstanding  anything to the contrary  contained herein,
however,  the Bank shall have no obligation  to fund any  requested  Acquisition
Advance  with  respect  to any  Acquisition  unless  (i) such  Acquisition  is a
Permitted Acquisition or (ii) the Bank has granted its prior written approval of
such Acquisition  pursuant to Section 5.13 hereof.  Upon the satisfaction of the
conditions  precedent  set forth  herein,  the Bank shall make  available to the
Borrower the amount of each  Acquisition  Advance by transferring  such funds to
the account maintained at the Bank's principal office located at the address set
forth  on the  first  page of  this  Agreement  or in  accordance  with  written
instructions provided by the Borrower and reasonably acceptable to the Bank.

     2.11  Acquisition  Notes. The indebtedness of the Borrower to the Bank with
respect to each  Acquisition  Advance made from time to time hereunder  shall be
evidenced by an  acquisition  note made  payable to the Bank,  dated the date of
such  Acquisition  Advance,  signed by the  Borrower  and  delivered to the Bank
substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto (such acquisition notes,  together
with all modifications thereto,  extensions thereof and substitutions  therefor,
are collectively  referred to as the "Acquisition  Notes"). Upon receipt of each
Acquisition Advance Request,  and based upon the information  contained therein,
the Bank or its counsel shall prepare, and forward to the Borrower for execution
and delivery on or before the date of the  Acquisition  Advance,  an Acquisition
Note.

     2.12 Interest Rate Under Acquisition Notes.

     (a)  Except  as  provided  in  Sections  2.24  and  2.26  hereof,  (i)  the
outstanding daily principal  balance of any Acquisition Note representing  LIBOR
Based Rate Loans shall bear interest for the Interest Periods applicable thereto
at a rate per annum  equal to the LIBOR  Based  Rate,  and (ii) the  outstanding
daily principal  balance of any Acquisition  Note  representing  Base Rate Loans
shall bear  interest  at a  fluctuating  rate per annum  equal to the Base Rate.
Notwithstanding the foregoing,  upon the occurrence of an Event of Default,  all
principal amounts outstanding under each Acquisition Note shall bear such higher
rate as provided in such Acquisition  Note.  Interest shall be calculated on the
basis of a  360-day  year for the  actual  number of days  elapsed.  The rate of
interest on that portion of the outstanding  principal amount of any Acquisition
Note  representing  Base Rate Loans  shall be adjusted  automatically  as of the
opening  of  business  on each  day on which  any  change  in the  Base  Rate is
announced by the Bank at its principal office.



                                      -10-
<PAGE>

     2.13 Principal and Interest Payments Under Acquisition Notes.

     (a) Each  Acquisition  Note shall be payable in  consecutive  equal monthly
installments  of principal on the fifth day of each  calendar  month,  each such
installment in the amount required to amortize such  Acquisition Note fully over
the Applicable  Amortization  Period. In addition,  all accrued interest on such
Acquisition Note shall be paid on each Interest Payment Date applicable thereto.

     (b) The principal  amortization of each  Acquisition Note shall commence no
later  than 90 days  after  the date of the  making of the  Acquisition  Advance
evidenced by such  Acquisition  Note. If not sooner paid,  the entire  principal
balance of each Acquisition  Note,  together with all accrued interest and other
amounts  owing  thereunder,  shall be due and payable on the  expiration  of the
Applicable Amortization Period applicable to such Acquisition Note.

     2.14 Optional  Prepayments  of Acquisition  Notes.  Subject to Section 2.25
hereof,  the  Borrower  shall have the right to prepay,  in whole or in part and
without premium or penalty,  any Acquisition  Notes at any time and from time to
time.  Each  prepayment of principal  shall be accompanied by payment of accrued
interest on the amount being prepaid  through the date of  prepayment,  and each
partial  prepayment  of an  Acquisition  Note  shall be  applied  by the Bank to
payments due under each Acquisition Note in their inverse order of maturity.

     2.15 Use of Proceeds of Acquisition  Advances.  Proceeds of the Acquisition
Advances shall be used by the Borrower to finance one or more Acquisitions.

     C. Term Loan.

     2.16 Term Loan and Term Note.  The Borrower  hereby  borrows from the Bank,
and the Bank hereby loans to the Borrower,  the principal sum of $5,000,000 (the
"Term  Loan").  The Term Loan shall be  evidenced by a term note made payable to
the  order of the Bank,  dated  the date  hereof,  signed  by the  Borrower  and
delivered to the Bank (such term note, together with all modifications  thereto,
extension thereof and substitutions therefor, is herein referred to as the "Term
Note").

     2.17 Interest Rate Under Term Note.  The Term Note shall bear interest from
the date thereof on the outstanding  daily  principal  amount thereof at a fixed
rate per annum  equal to 7.8% or,  upon the  occurrence  of an Event of Default,
such higher rate as provided in the Term Note.  Interest  shall be calculated on
the basis of a 360-day year for the actual number of days elapsed.

     2.18 Principal and Interest Payments Under Term Note. Subject to the Bank's
right  of  acceleration  upon  the  occurrence  of  an  Event  of  Default,  the
outstanding  principal  balance  of the  Term  Note  shall be  payable  in equal
consecutive quarterly installments of principal and interest, each in the amount
of  $366,793.68  commencing on September 24, 1998 and continuing on the 24th day
of each and every December,  March,  June and September  thereafter  through and
including  June 24, 2002.  In any event,  if not sooner paid,  the entire unpaid
principal balance of, together with all accrued


                                      -11-
<PAGE>

interest and other amounts  owing under,  the Term Note shall be due and payable
on the Term Loan Maturity Date.

     2.19 Use of Proceeds of Term Loan.  The  proceeds of the Term Loan shall be
used by the Borrower to repay the Borrower's existing debt with Fleet Bank.

     2.20 Optional Prepayments of Term Note. Subject to Section 2.25 hereof, the
Borrower shall have the right to prepay, in whole or in part and without premium
or penalty,  the Term Note at any time and from time to time. Each prepayment of
principal  shall be  accompanied  by payment of accrued  interest  on the amount
being prepaid through the date of prepayment,  and each partial prepayment shall
be  applied  by the Bank to  payments  due under the Term Note in their  inverse
order of maturity.

     D. General Provisions.

     2.21 LIBOR Based Rate Loan Limitations.  Notwithstanding anything contained
herein to the  contrary,  (a) each LIBOR Based Rate Loan shall be in the minimum
amount of $100,000 or integral multiples of $10,000 in excess thereof and (b) at
no time  shall  there  be  more  than  ten  different  LIBOR  Based  Rate  Loans
outstanding under the Credit Facility.

     2.22 Interest Periods. As used herein,  "Interest Period" shall mean either
30,  60 or 90 days,  as  designated  by the  Borrower  in the  Advance  Request,
Acquisition Advance Request or Notice of  Conversion/Continuation,  with respect
to each LIBOR Based Rate Loan; provided, however, that (i) if an Interest Period
would  otherwise end on a day which is not a Business Day, such Interest  Period
shall be extended to the next succeeding  Business Day, unless such Business Day
falls in another calendar month, in which case such Interest Period shall end on
the next  preceding  Business Day subject to clause (iii) below;  (ii)  interest
shall accrue from and including  the first day of each  Interest  Period to, but
excluding,  the day on which any Interest Period expires;  (iii) with respect to
any Interest  Period which begins on the last  Business Day of a calendar  month
(or on a day for which there is no numerically corresponding day in the calendar
month at the end of such Interest Period),  the Interest Period shall end on the
last Business Day of a calendar  month and (iv) no Interest  Period shall extend
beyond (A) in the case of Advances,  the Revolving Loan Termination Date, (B) in
the case of  Acquisition  Advances,  the maturity date of the  Acquisition  Note
under  which  such LIBOR  Based Rate is payable  and (C) in the case of the Term
Loan, the Term Loan Maturity Date.

     2.23 Conversion.  Subject to the provisions of Sections 2.21, 2.24 and 2.26
hereof,  the Borrower  shall have the option (a) to convert at any time, so long
as no Event of Default  exists,  all or any part of its Base Rate Loans to LIBOR
Based Rate Loans or (b) upon the expiration of any Interest Period applicable to
a LIBOR Based Rate Loan, to continue all or any portion thereof as a LIBOR Based
Rate Loan or to convert all or any portion thereof to a Base Rate Loan. In order
to  effect  any of the  foregoing,  the  Borrower  shall  deliver  a  notice  of
conversion/continuation  (the "Notice of  Conversion/Continuation")  to the Bank
not later than 12:00 p.m.  New York City time (i) at least three  Business  Days
prior  to  the  requested  conversion/continuation  date  with  respect  to  the
conversion  to or  continuation  of a LIBOR  Based Rate Loan or (ii) on the same
Business Day of the proposed  conversion  in the case of a conversion of a LIBOR
Based Rate Loan to a Base Rate Loan. A Notice


                                      -12-
<PAGE>

of  Conversion/Continuation  shall be  irrevocable  and  shall  specify  (i) the
proposed  conversion/continuation  date, which shall be a Business Day, (ii) the
amount of the Advance, Acquisition Advance or Term Loan which is to be converted
or continued,  (iii) the nature of the proposed  conversion or continuation  and
(iv) in the case of a conversion  to, or a  continuation  of, a LIBOR Based Rate
Loan, the requested  Interest  Period.  In the event the Bank does not receive a
Notice of  Conversion/Continuation in accordance with the provisions hereof with
respect to a LIBOR Based Rate Loan,  upon the expiration of the Interest  Period
applicable  thereto,  the same shall  automatically  be converted to a Base Rate
Loan.

     2.24  Alternate  Interest Rate. If within one Business Day of any date that
the Borrower  requests a LIBOR Based Rate Loan, the Bank shall  determine in its
sole discretion,  reasonably exercised, that it is unable to quote the requested
LIBOR  Based  Rate,  or that  the  Bank  is  unable,  or  that  it is  otherwise
impossible,  to fund the requested LIBOR Based Rate Loan for the Interest Period
requested, the Bank shall promptly notify the Borrower of such determination and
no LIBOR Based Rate Loan shall be made by the Bank on the borrowing  date and/or
no Base Rate Loan shall be converted to a LIBOR Based Rate Loan, as  applicable.
Upon receipt of such  notification,  the  Borrower may withdraw any  outstanding
request for a LIBOR Based Rate Loan by giving  written  notice of  withdrawal to
the Bank prior to such borrowing date.  Unless withdrawn in accordance with this
Section 2.24,  any  outstanding  request for such LIBOR Based Rate Loan shall be
deemed to be a request for a Base Rate Loan in equal principal amount,  and such
Base Rate Loan shall be made on such borrowing date.

     2.25  Indemnification  For LIBOR  Based Rate  Loans.  Except as provided in
Section  2.24  hereof,  each  request  for a LIBOR  Based  Rate  Loan  shall  be
irrevocable  and  binding  upon the  Borrower.  The  Borrower  hereby  agrees to
indemnify  the Bank,  upon  demand by the Bank at any time,  against any and all
actual losses (including any actual loss of profit), costs or expenses which the
Bank may at any time or from time to time sustain or incur as a consequence  of:
(a) any breach by the Borrower of its obligation to borrow on the borrowing date
specified  in any request  for a LIBOR  Based Rate Loan,  (b) any failure by the
Borrower to pay  punctually on the due date thereof,  any amount  payable by the
Borrower to the Bank on LIBOR Based Rate Loans, (c) the acceleration of the time
of payment of any of the  Borrower's  obligations in respect of LIBOR Based Rate
Loans in accordance with Article VIII hereof, (d) the repayment or prepayment of
the  principal of any of the LIBOR Based Rate Loans on a date other than the end
of the  applicable  Interest  Period or (e) the conversion of a LIBOR Based Rate
Loan to a Base Rate Loan on a date other than the end of the applicable Interest
Period. Such losses,  costs or expenses shall include,  without limitation,  (i)
any  costs  incurred  by the Bank in  carrying  funds  which  were to have  been
borrowed by the  Borrower or in carrying  funds to cover any overdue  principal,
overdue  interest or any other  overdue sums payable by the Borrower to the Bank
in respect of LIBOR Based Rate Loans,  (ii) any interest  payable by the Bank to
the lenders of the funds referred to in the  immediately  preceding  clause (i),
and (iii) any actual losses  (including  any actual loss of profit)  incurred or
sustained by the Bank in liquidating or  re-employing  funds acquired from third
parties to make any of the LIBOR Based Rate Loans or to fund or maintain  all or
any part of the principal of any of the LIBOR Based Rate Loans.

     2.26  Changes in  Circumstances.  If at any time the Bank shall  reasonably
determine that:



                                      -13-
<PAGE>

     (a) the Bank is unable to obtain funds in the principal amount specified in
any  request  for a LIBOR  Based Rate Loan for  periods  equal to the  specified
Interest Period;

     (b) the LIBOR Based Rate does not or will not  accurately  reflect the cost
to the Bank of  obtaining  or  maintaining  any LIBOR Based Rate Loan during any
Interest Period despite the Borrower's  compliance  with its  obligations  under
Section 2.27 hereof; or

     (c) any change in applicable  law or regulation  (or in the  interpretation
thereof  by any  governmental  authority  charged  with  the  administration  or
interpretation  thereof)  has made or will make it unlawful for the Bank to make
or  maintain  any LIBOR  Based  Rate Loan or to  comply  with any of the  Bank's
obligations in respect of any LIBOR Based Rate Loan;

then, in each case, the Bank may promptly give notice of such  determination and
the  reasons  therefor  to the  Borrower.  Upon such  notification,  the  Bank's
obligations  to make LIBOR  Based Rate Loans shall be  suspended  until the Bank
determines that the circumstances described in subparagraphs (a), (b) and (c) of
this  Section  2.26 have  ceased to exist.  Following  the Bank's  notice  under
subparagraphs  (b) or (c) of this Section 2.26, all outstanding LIBOR Based Rate
Loans  shall  be  converted  to Base  Rate  Loans  at the end of the  applicable
Interest  Period;  provided,  however,  that if it  shall  be  unlawful  for the
conversion  of such LIBOR Based Rate Loans to Base Rate Loans to be effective as
of the end of the applicable Interest Period, such conversion shall be deemed to
occur as of the date of such notice by the Bank.

     2.27 Additional Costs and Expenses.  The Borrower  recognizes that the cost
to the Bank of making or  maintaining  LIBOR  Based  Rate  Loans or any  portion
thereof may fluctuate,  and the Borrower  agrees to pay to the Bank,  within ten
Business Days after written demand,  an additional amount or amounts as the Bank
shall  reasonably  determine  will  compensate  the  Bank for  additional  costs
incurred  by the Bank in  maintaining  LIBOR  Based  Rate  Loans or any  portion
thereof as a result of:

     (a) the  imposition  after  the date of any  LIBOR  Based  Rate Loan of, or
changes after the date of any LIBOR Based Rate Loan in, the reserve requirements
promulgated  by the Board of  Governors  of the  Federal  Reserve  System of the
United  States,  including,  but not  limited  to, any  reserve on  Eurocurrency
Liabilities (as defined in Regulation D of the Board of Governors of the Federal
Reserve System of the United States) at the ratios  provided in such  Regulation
from time to time,  it being  agreed  that the portion or portions of the Credit
Facility  bearing  interest at LIBOR  Based Rates shall be deemed to  constitute
Eurocurrency  Liabilities,  as defined by such Regulation,  and it being further
agreed that such Eurocurrency  Liabilities shall be deemed to be subject to such
reserve requirements  without benefit of, or credit for, prorations,  exceptions
or  offsets  that may be  available  to the Bank or from time to time under such
regulations and  irrespective of whether the Bank actually  maintains all or any
portion of the reserve;

     (b) any  change,  after  the date of any  LIBOR  Based  Rate  Loan,  in any
applicable laws, rules or regulations or in the interpretation or administration
thereof by any  domestic  or foreign  governmental  authority  charged  with the
interpretation  or  administration  thereof  (whether or not


                                      -14-
<PAGE>

having the force of law) or by any domestic or foreign court  changing the basis
of taxation of payments to the Bank of the principal of or interest on any LIBOR
Based Rate Loan or any other payments made  hereunder  (other than taxes imposed
on all or any  portion of the  overall  net income of the  Bank),  or  imposing,
modifying  or  applying  any  reserve,  special  deposit or similar  requirement
against assets of,  deposits with or for the account of, credit  extended by, or
any other acquisition of funds for loans by the Bank, or imposing on the Bank or
on the London Interbank  market any other condition  affecting this Agreement or
the portion or portions of the Credit Facility  bearing  interest at LIBOR Based
Rates so as to  increase  the cost to the Bank of  making or  maintaining  LIBOR
Based Rate Loans or to reduce the amount of any sum  received or  receivable  by
the  Bank  under  the  Credit  Facility  (whether  of  principal,   interest  or
otherwise); or

     (c) if after the date of any LIBOR  Based  Rate  Loan,  the Bank shall have
determined  that the  applicability  of any law,  rule,  regulation or guideline
adopted or arising out of the July 1988 report of the Basle Committee on Banking
Regulations and Supervisory  Practices  entitled  "International  Convergence of
Capital  Measurement  and Capital  Standards",  or the  adoption  after the date
hereof of any  other  law,  rule,  regulation  or  guideline  regarding  capital
adequacy, or any change therein, or any change in any of the foregoing or in the
interpretation  or  administration  of any of the  foregoing  by any domestic or
foreign governmental  authority,  central bank or comparable agency charged with
the interpretation or administration thereof, or compliance by the Bank with any
request or directive regarding capital adequacy (whether or not having the force
of law) of any such authority,  central bank or comparable  agency, has or would
have the  effect  of  reducing  the rate of return on the  Bank's  capital  as a
consequence  of  the  Bank's  obligations  with  respect  to the  Advances,  the
Acquisition Advances or the Term Loan, or under the Notes or this Agreement,  to
a level  below that which the Bank could have  achieved  but for such  adoption,
change or compliance (taking into consideration the Bank's policies with respect
to capital adequacy).

     Any amount or amounts  payable by the  Borrower  to the Bank in  accordance
with the  provisions of this Section shall be paid within ten (10) Business Days
of receipt by the Borrower from the Bank of a statement setting forth the amount
or  amounts  due and the basis for the  determination  from time to time of such
amount or amounts,  which  statement  shall be  conclusive  and binding upon the
Borrower  absent  manifest  error.  Failure  on the part of the  Bank to  demand
compensation for any increased costs in any Interest Period shall not constitute
a waiver of the Bank's  right to demand  compensation  for any  increased  costs
incurred  during any such Interest Period or in any other or subsequent or prior
Interest Period.

     2.28 Method of Payment.  The Borrower shall make each payment to be made by
it hereunder and under the Notes (including,  without limitation, all principal,
interest  and  optional  and   mandatory   prepayments),   without   set-off  or
counterclaim,  not later than 2:00 p.m. (New York City time) on the day when due
in lawful  money of the United  States of America and in  immediately  available
funds to the Bank at its  principal  office  set forth on the first page of this
Agreement.

     2.29 Business Day.  Whenever any payment hereunder or under the Notes shall
be stated as due on any day other  than a Business  Day,  the  maturity  of such
payment shall (except as otherwise  provided in Section 2.22 hereof) be extended
to the next succeeding Business Day and interest and all other fees shall accrue
during such extension.



                                      -15-
<PAGE>

     2.30 Charge. Without in any way limiting any right of offset,  counterclaim
or banker's lien which the Bank may otherwise  have at law, the Borrower  hereby
irrevocably  authorizes  and directs the Bank to charge  against the  Borrower's
account or  accounts  at the Bank an amount or amounts as are due and payable to
the Bank hereunder or under the Notes from time to time.

     2.31 Bank Fees.

     (a) The Borrower shall pay to the Bank quarterly,  within five (5) Business
Days  after  the  Bank  has  rendered  an  invoice,  and on the  Revolving  Loan
Termination  Date, a revolving loan fee equal to (i) 0.05% multiplied by (ii) an
amount equal to (A) the Maximum  Amount,  minus (B) the average daily  principal
amount of all Advances and Acquisition  Advances outstanding during the previous
calendar  quarter,  or, in the case of the fee  payable  on the  Revolving  Loan
Termination Date, during such shorter period.

     (b)  Concurrently  herewith,  the Borrower has paid to the Bank a Term Loan
fee equal to $5,000.

     2.32  Bank's  Counsel  Fees.   Concurrently   herewith,   the  Borrower  is
reimbursing  the Bank for all legal fees and  expenses  incurred  by the Bank in
connection with the negotiation and preparation of the Loan Documents, review of
pre-closing  documents and  materials  required by the Bank and  performance  of
customary closing and post-closing tasks, which in no event shall exceed $10,000
plus disbursements of the Bank's counsel.

     III. COLLATERAL SECURITY

     3.1 Collateral Security.

     (a) As  collateral  security  for  the  prompt  and  complete  payment  and
performance  when due  (whether  at the  stated  maturity,  by  acceleration  or
otherwise) of all Obligations and in order to induce the Bank to enter into this
Agreement  and,  among other things,  make the  Advances,  the Term Loan and the
Acquisition  Advances to the  Borrower as provided  herein,  the  Borrower  has,
simultaneously  herewith,  executed  and  delivered  to the Bank the  Pledge and
Security Agreement.

     (b) All collateral heretofore,  herein or hereafter given or granted to the
Bank  by  the  Borrower  (collectively,  the  "Collateral"),  including  without
limitation  the  collateral  pledged  to the Bank  pursuant  to the  Pledge  and
Security  Agreement,  shall secure payment of all of the  Obligations.  The Bank
shall be under no  obligation to proceed  against any or all of such  collateral
before proceeding directly against the Borrower or the Guarantors.

     (c) In addition to the foregoing,  all of the Obligations  shall be secured
by the Guaranty Agreement, in accordance with the terms and provisions set forth
therein.



                                      -16-
<PAGE>

     IV. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

     4. In order to induce  the Bank to enter  into this  Agreement  and,  among
other things, make the Advances,  the Term Loan and the Acquisition  Advances as
provided  herein,  the Borrower,  for itself and on behalf of its  Subsidiaries,
hereby represents, warrants and agrees that:

     4.1  Controlling  Shareholders;  Subsidiaries.  Schedule IV attached hereto
sets forth a list of all of the  Subsidiaries of the Borrower and the percentage
of each class of stock of each such Subsidiary owned by the Borrower and by each
other  shareholder of such  Subsidiary.  Other than as set forth on Schedule IV,
the Borrower has no  Subsidiaries.  Except as set forth on Schedule IV,  neither
the Borrower nor any of its  Subsidiaries  conducts  business,  or has conducted
business within the five years prior to the date hereof, under any trade name or
alternate or fictitious name.

     4.2 Organization;  Power; Qualification. The Borrower is a corporation duly
organized,  validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the State of
Delaware.  Each  Subsidiary  of the Borrower is a  corporation  duly  organized,
validly  existing  and in good  standing  under  the  laws of the  state  of its
incorporation.  Each of the  Borrower and each of its  Subsidiaries  (i) has the
full power and  authority  to own and operate its  properties  and assets and to
carry on the business now conducted by it and (ii) is qualified or authorized to
do business and in good standing in all  jurisdictions  wherein the character of
the  property  owned or the nature of the  business  conducted  by it makes such
qualification or authorization necessary, except such jurisdictions in which the
lack of qualification or authorization does not materially  adversely affect the
business,  results of operations or financial  condition of the Borrower and its
Subsidiaries.

     4.3  Authorization of Agreement.  The Borrower has full power and authority
to execute,  deliver and perform any action  which may be necessary or advisable
to carry out the terms of the Loan  Documents  to which it is a party;  and each
Loan  Document  to which the  Borrower  is a party has been  duly  executed  and
delivered by the Borrower and is the legal,  valid and binding obligation of the
Borrower enforceable in accordance with its terms.

     4.4 No Legal Bar.  The  execution,  delivery  and  performance  of the Loan
Documents will not (i) violate any provision of any existing law, statute, rule,
regulation or ordinance, (ii) conflict with, result in a breach of or constitute
a default under (a) the certificate of  incorporation or by-laws of the Borrower
or any of its  Subsidiaries,  (b) any  order,  judgment,  award or decree of any
court,  governmental  authority,  bureau or agency, or (c) any mortgage,  lease,
material  contract  or other  material  agreement  or  undertaking  to which the
Borrower or any of its  Subsidiaries  is a party or by which the Borrower or any
of its  Subsidiaries,  or any of their respective  properties or assets,  may be
bound,  or (iii) result in the creation or  imposition  of any Lien upon or with
respect to any  property or asset now or  hereafter  acquired by the Borrower or
any of its Subsidiaries other than the Liens created by the Loan Documents.

     4.5 Consent.  No consent,  license,  permit,  approval or authorization of,
exemption by, notice to, report to, or registration,  filing or declaration with
any Person is required in connection with the execution,  delivery,  performance
or validity of the Loan  Documents by the Borrower and its


                                      -17-
<PAGE>

Subsidiaries  or the  transactions  contemplated  thereby,  other than filing of
financing  statements  and like  documents  in  connection  with the Liens being
granted in favor of the Bank.

     4.6 Compliance With Law.  Neither the Borrower nor any of its  Subsidiaries
is in violation of any applicable law, rule, regulation,  statute, ordinance, or
any  order,  judgment,  award or decree of any  court,  governmental  authority,
bureau or agency,  the violation of which might have a materially adverse effect
on the business, assets, liabilities,  financial condition, results of operation
or business prospects of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries.

     4.7 Title to Properties and Assets;  Liens. Except for Permitted Liens, the
Borrower and its  Subsidiaries  have good,  marketable  and legal title to, or a
valid  leasehold  interest  in, the  properties  and assets as  reflected on the
audited  consolidated  and  consolidating  balance sheet of the Borrower and its
Subsidiaries as at December 31, 1997, a copy of which was delivered to the Bank,
except such properties or assets as have been disposed of by the Borrower or its
Subsidiaries  subsequent to the date thereof in the ordinary course of business.
All of said properties and assets are in good working order. Except as set forth
on Schedule V attached hereto,  neither the Borrower nor any of its Subsidiaries
owns, or has any interest in, any real property. Except for financing statements
naming the Bank as secured party,  and except as otherwise set forth on Schedule
II  attached  hereto,  no  financing  statement  under the Code which  names the
Borrower  or  any  of  its   Subsidiaries  as  debtor  has  been  filed  in  any
jurisdiction,  and neither the Borrower nor any of its  Subsidiaries  has signed
any such financing  statement or any security agreement  authorizing any secured
party thereunder to file any such financing statement in any such jurisdiction.

     4.8 No Default.  Neither the  Borrower  nor any of its  Subsidiaries  is in
default in any  material  respect in the  payment or  performance  of any of its
obligations or in the performance of any mortgage, indenture, lease, contract or
other  agreement or  undertaking to which it is a party or by which it or any of
its  properties  or assets may be bound,  and no Default or Event of Default has
occurred and is continuing.  Neither the Borrower nor any of its Subsidiaries is
in default under any material order,  award or decree of any court,  arbitrator,
or  governmental  authority  binding upon or affecting it or by which any of its
properties  or assets  may be bound or  affected,  and no such  order,  award or
decree, if any, materially  adversely affects the ability of the Borrower or its
Subsidiaries to carry on their  businesses as presently  conducted or to perform
their respective obligations under the Loan Documents.

     4.9 No Litigation.  Except as set forth on Schedule III attached hereto, no
litigation,  investigation  or proceeding of or before any court,  arbitrator or
governmental  authority is currently pending, nor, to the knowledge of Borrower,
threatened,  against the  Borrower or any of its  Subsidiaries,  or any of their
respective  properties  and  revenues,  which,  if adversely  determined,  would
materially  adversely affect the business,  operations,  financial  condition or
results of operations of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries.

     4.10  No  Burdensome  Restrictions.  Neither  the  Borrower  nor any of its
Subsidiaries  is a party to or bound by any contract or agreement or  instrument
or subject to any restriction  materially and adversely  affecting the business,
operations,  properties or financial or other  condition of the Borrower and its
Subsidiaries.



                                      -18-
<PAGE>

     4.11 Tax Returns and Payments.  All federal, state and other tax returns of
the  Borrower  and its  Subsidiaries  required by law to be filed have been duly
filed  or  extensions  obtained,   and  all  federal,  state  and  other  taxes,
assessments and  governmental  charges or levies upon the Borrower or any of its
Subsidiaries,  or any of their respective properties,  income, profits or assets
which are due and  payable  have  been paid or  provided  for,  except  such tax
returns the non-filing of which,  and such taxes the nonpayment of which,  would
not have a material  adverse  effect  upon the  business,  assets,  liabilities,
financial condition,  results of operation or business prospects of the Borrower
and its  Subsidiaries  and  except  for such  taxes  and  assessments  which the
Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries is disputing in good faith and for which the
Borrower or such Subsidiary has established  adequate  reserves on its books for
the payment of such disputed taxes or assessments in accordance with GAAP.

     4.12 Financial Statements. The Borrower has furnished to the Bank a copy of
its  consolidating  and consolidated  balance sheet as at December 31, 1997, and
the  related  consolidating  and  consolidated  statements  of income,  retained
earnings and cash flows for the 12 months then ended,  as certified by certified
public accountants.  Such financial  statements fairly present the consolidating
and consolidated  financial position and results of operations and cash flows of
the Borrower and the Borrower's Subsidiaries on the date and for the period then
ended,  in accordance  with GAAP,  consistently  applied  throughout the periods
involved and show all direct liabilities and all known contingent liabilities of
a material nature of the Borrower and the Borrower's  Subsidiaries in accordance
with GAAP.

     4.13 No Adverse  Changes.  Since  December  31, 1997,  no material  adverse
change has occurred in the business, assets,  liabilities,  financial condition,
results of  operations  or  business  prospects  of the  Borrower  or any of its
Subsidiaries,  and no event has  occurred or failed to occur which has had or is
likely to have a material adverse effect on the business,  assets,  liabilities,
financial condition, results of operations or business prospects of the Borrower
or any of its Subsidiaries.

     4.14 ERISA.

     (a) The Borrower and its  Subsidiaries  are in  compliance  in all material
respects  with the  applicable  provisions  of the  Employee  Retirement  Income
Security  Act  of  1974,  as  amended  ("ERISA")  and  all  regulations   issued
thereunder; and

     (b)  No  "employee  benefit  plan",  as  defined  in  Section  3 of  ERISA,
maintained  and  administered  by the Borrower or any of its  Subsidiaries  (but
excluding  any  multi-employer  plan  in  which  any  Borrower  or  any  of  its
Subsidiaries  participates  but does not  administer),  as from  time to time in
effect (the  "Plans"),  nor any trusts  created  thereunder,  nor any trustee or
administrator thereof, has engaged in a "prohibited  transaction," as defined in
Section  4975 of the  Internal  Revenue  Code of 1986,  which could  subject the
Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries,  any Plan or any such trust, or any trustee
or administrator  thereof,  or any party dealing with any Plan or any such trust
to the tax or penalty on prohibited  transactions  imposed by said Section 4975.
Neither any of the Plans nor any such trusts have been terminated, nor has there
been  any  "reportable   event,"  as  defined  in  Section  4043


                                      -19-
<PAGE>

of ERISA, or "accumulated  funding  deficiency." Neither the Borrower nor any of
its  Subsidiaries  has incurred any  liability to the Pension  Benefit  Guaranty
Corporation.

     4.15  Federal  Reserve  Regulations.  Neither the  Borrower  nor any of its
Subsidiaries is engaged principally,  or as one of its important activities,  in
the business of extending  credit for the purpose of  purchasing or carrying any
margin  stock  (within  the  meaning  of  Regulations  U and X of the  Board  of
Governors  of the Federal  Reserve  System).  No part of any of the  Advances or
Acquisition  Advances  hereunder  or  proceeds of the Term Loan shall be used to
purchase  or carry any such margin  stock or to extend  credit to others for the
purpose of purchasing or carrying any such margin stock.

     4.16 Solvency.

     (a) The present fair saleable  value of the assets of the Borrower and each
of its  Subsidiaries,  after giving effect to all the transactions  contemplated
herein,  exceeds the amount that will be required to be paid on or in respect of
the existing debts and other liabilities  (including contingent  liabilities) of
the Borrower or such Subsidiary as they mature.

     (b) The property of the Borrower and each  Subsidiary  does not  constitute
unreasonably  small capital for the Borrower or such Subsidiary to carry out its
business as now conducted and as proposed to be conducted, including the capital
needs of the Borrower or such Subsidiary.

     (c) Neither the Borrower nor any of its  Subsidiaries  intends to, nor does
the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries believe that it will, incur debts beyond
its ability to pay such debts as they mature (taking into account the timing and
amounts  of cash to be  received  by the  Borrower  or such  Subsidiary,  and of
amounts to be payable on or in respect of  Indebtedness  of the Borrower and its
Subsidiaries, including the Obligations). The cash available to the Borrower and
each of its Subsidiaries after taking into account all other anticipated uses of
the cash of the Borrower and its  Subsidiaries,  is anticipated to be sufficient
to pay all  such  amounts  on or in  respect  of debt of such  Borrower  and its
Subsidiaries when such amounts are required to be paid.

     (d) Neither the Borrower nor any of its  Subsidiaries  believes  that final
judgments  against it in actions  for money  damages  will be rendered at a time
when, or in an amount such that, the Borrower or such  Subsidiary will be unable
to satisfy any such  judgments  promptly in accordance  with their terms (taking
into account the maximum reasonable amount of such judgments in any such actions
and the earliest reasonable time at which such judgments might be rendered). The
cash  available to the Borrower and its  Subsidiaries  after taking into account
all other  anticipated  uses of the cash of the  Borrower  and its  Subsidiaries
(including  the  payments  on or in respect of the  Indebtedness  referred to in
subsection  (c) of this Section 4.16) is anticipated to be sufficient to pay all
such judgments promptly in accordance with their terms.

     4.17 Accuracy and Completeness of Information. All information, reports and
other papers and data  furnished to the Bank were,  at the time the same were so
furnished,  complete and correct in all material respects. No document furnished
or statement made to the Bank in connection with the negotiation, preparation or
execution of the Loan Documents contains or will contain any


                                      -20-
<PAGE>

untrue  statement  of fact or  omits  or will  omit  to  state a  material  fact
necessary in order to make the statements  contained therein not misleading.  No
fact is known to the Borrower which has had or may in the future have (so far as
the  Borrower  can  reasonably  foresee) a  materially  adverse  effect upon the
Borrower's or any of its Subsidiaries' business, assets, liabilities, condition,
financial or otherwise,  or results of operations that has not been set forth in
the financial  statements furnished to the Bank or other reports or other papers
or data otherwise disclosed in writing to the Bank.

     4.18 Permits. The Borrower and each of its Subsidiaries have obtained,  and
taken all necessary  steps to preserve,  the  franchises,  licenses,  approvals,
certificates of occupancy, permits and other authorizations  (collectively,  the
"Permits")  required to conduct its business in accordance  with all  applicable
laws and with all material  agreements to which it is subject and has not failed
to  adhere to the  requirements  thereof  in any  material  respect.  All of the
Permits are valid, in good standing and in full force and effect.

     4.19 Year 2000 Compliance.  The Borrower and each of its Subsidiaries  have
taken all  reasonable  steps to assure that all  computer  software and hardware
used by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries in the operation of its business
are designed to be used prior to, during, and after the calendar year A.D. 2000,
and such  software and  hardware is intended to operate  during each time period
without error relating to date data,  including without  limitation dates on and
after January 1, 2000.

     V. COVENANTS

     5. The Borrower  covenants and agrees that until all the  Obligations  have
been  satisfied  and paid in full,  the Borrower  will comply with the following
covenants:

     5.1 Preservation of Existence. The Borrower will do or cause to be done all
things  necessary to preserve and maintain in full force and effect its and each
of its Subsidiaries'  corporate existence and all contracts,  rights,  licenses,
permits,  franchises  and trade names which in its  judgment  are  necessary  or
useful to the proper  conduct of their  respective  businesses and shall qualify
and remain  qualified as a foreign  corporation and authorized to do business in
each  jurisdiction in which the character of their respective  properties or the
nature  of  their   respective   businesses   requires  such   qualification  or
authorization,  except such  jurisdictions in which the lack of qualification or
authorization  does not  materially  adversely  affect the business,  results of
operations  or  financial   condition  of  the  Borrower  or  its  Subsidiaries.
Notwithstanding  the  foregoing,  nothing herein shall be deemed or construed to
prohibit the Borrower from causing one or more of its Subsidiaries  (whether now
owned or hereafter  acquired) to merge with or into, or to be consolidated with,
one or more of its other Subsidiaries (whether now owned or hereafter acquired);
provided that the business  operations of the Borrower and its Subsidiaries,  as
the same were conducted  immediately prior to such merger or consolidation,  are
maintained substantially undisturbed following such merger or consolidation.

     5.2 Nature of  Business.  The  Borrower  will not,  directly or through its
Subsidiaries,  engage in any business, other than the ownership of (a) the stock
of  the  Borrower's  Subsidiaries  and  (b)  insurance  brokerage,  underwriting
businesses and related businesses.



                                      -21-
<PAGE>

     5.3 Compliance  with Laws. The Borrower will comply,  and cause each of its
Subsidiaries  to  comply,  with all  laws,  ordinances,  governmental  rules and
regulations  to which it or its  properties  or  assets  are,  or might  become,
subject  (unless  the  same  shall  be  contested  by the  Borrower  or any such
Subsidiary in good faith and by appropriate  proceedings  and such contest shall
operate to stay any such  non-compliance),  the  noncompliance  with which might
materially  interfere  with the  performance of its  obligations  under the Loan
Documents to which it is a party or with the proper conduct of its business.

     5.4  Maintenance of  Properties.  The Borrower will maintain or cause to be
maintained in working order and condition,  ordinary wear and tear excepted, all
of its assets and  properties,  and all of the assets and  properties of each of
its  Subsidiaries,  which are material to the conduct of its business,  and from
time to time,  make or cause to be made  all  necessary  repairs,  replacements,
additions, betterments and improvements thereto, so that the business carried on
in  connection  therewith  may be properly and  advantageously  conducted at all
times.

     5.5  Accounting  Methods.  The  Borrower  will,  and will cause each of its
Subsidiaries to, maintain a system of accounting established and administered in
accordance  with  GAAP,  keep  adequate  records  and books of  account in which
complete  entries will be made in accordance  with GAAP,  make  provision in its
accounts in accordance with GAAP for reserves for depreciation, obsolescence and
amortization and all other proper reserves and accruals which in accordance with
GAAP should be  established.  The Borrower will also cause each of its Insurance
Subsidiaries to maintain a system of accounting  established and administered in
accordance  with  SAP,  keep  adequate  records  and books of  account  in which
complete  entries will be made in  accordance  with SAP,  make  provision in its
accounts in accordance with SAP for reserves for depreciation,  obsolescence and
amortization and all other proper reserves and accruals which in accordance with
SAP should be established.

     5.6 Payment of Taxes and Claims.  The Borrower will, and will cause each of
its Subsidiaries to, pay and discharge  promptly (i) all taxes,  assessments and
governmental  charges or levies imposed upon it or upon its income or profits or
upon any of its  properties or assets  before the same shall become  delinquent,
(ii) all  lawful  claims  of  materialmen,  mechanics,  carriers,  warehousemen,
landlords, and other similar persons for labor, materials,  supplies and rentals
which,  if unpaid,  might by law become a Lien or charge upon its  property  and
(iii) all of its Indebtedness and other  obligations of whatever nature when due
(subject,  where applicable,  to grace periods, normal credit terms and to other
forbearance in the ordinary course of business); provided, however, that none of
the  foregoing  need  be  paid  while  being  contested  in  good  faith  and by
appropriate proceedings, so long as adequate book reserves have been established
in  accordance  with  GAAP  with  respect  thereto  and the  Borrower's  or such
Subsidiary's  title to, and its right to use, its  properties are not materially
adversely affected thereby.

     5.7 Visits and Inspections;  Field  Examinations.  The Borrower will permit
the Bank and its agents and representatives,  at any time during normal business
hours,  to (i) visit and inspect the premises and the properties of the Borrower
and each of its Subsidiaries,  (ii) inspect and make extracts from the books and
records of the Borrower and each of its  Subsidiaries and (iii) discuss with the
Borrower's or each Subsidiary's  principal  officers,  employees and independent
public


                                      -22-
<PAGE>

accountants  any  and  all  matters  with  respect  to  the  business,   assets,
liabilities,  financial condition,  results of operations and business prospects
of the  Borrower or such  Subsidiary.  Without  limiting the  generality  of the
foregoing, the Bank shall be permitted to conduct periodic field examinations of
the Borrower and its Subsidiaries  and their respective  business and operations
in accordance  with the Bank's normal and  customary  practices.  So long as any
Obligations are outstanding, the Borrower shall pay the Bank a field examination
fee in the amount of $600 per person per day,  together  with the  out-of-pocket
expenses  incurred by the Bank or its  representatives  in performing such field
examinations. Notwithstanding the foregoing, however, the Bank shall not conduct
more than two (2) such field  examinations  in any calendar year unless,  in the
judgment of the Bank,  there  exists at any time a  reasonable  basis to conduct
same more frequently.

     5.8  Information  Covenants.   The  Borrower  will  furnish  the  following
information to the Bank for itself and on behalf of its Subsidiaries:

     (i) Annual Financial Statements. As soon as practicable,  and, in any case,
within  120 days  after  the end of each  fiscal  year of the  Borrower  and its
Subsidiaries, a consolidated and consolidating balance sheet of the Borrower and
its Subsidiaries as at the end of such fiscal year and the related  consolidated
and consolidating  statements of income, retained earnings and cash flows of the
Borrower and its Subsidiaries for such fiscal year, setting forth in comparative
form the figures as at the end of and for the previous  fiscal year,  audited by
independent  certified  public  accountants  satisfactory  to  the  Bank,  whose
certificate  shall not  contain  any  qualification  and shall  state  that such
financial  statements  have been prepared in accordance  with GAAP  consistently
applied and that the  examination of such  accountants  in connection  with such
financial  statements  has  been  made in  accordance  with  generally  accepted
auditing  standards  and,  accordingly,  included  such tests of the  accounting
records and such other auditing  procedures as were considered  necessary in the
circumstances  and who shall  have  authorized  the  Borrower  to  deliver  such
financial  statements  and  certifications  thereof to the Bank pursuant to this
Agreement.  Together with such financial statements,  the Borrower shall deliver
(A) a certificate of such accountants (1) stating that in making the examination
necessary for the certification of such financial  statements they have obtained
no knowledge of any Default or Event of Default,  or if they shall have obtained
knowledge of any such Default or Event of Default,  disclosing each such Default
and  Event of  Default  and its  nature,  when it  occurred  and  whether  it is
continuing  and (2) which shall have  attached the  calculations  made which are
required to establish whether or not the Borrower and its Subsidiaries  were, as
of the date of such  statements,  in  compliance  with the  financial  covenants
contained in this Agreement and (B) copies of all "management letters" issued to
the Borrower or its Subsidiaries by its accountants.

     (ii) Annual SAP  Financial  Statements.  As soon as  available,  and in any
event within 60 days (with respect to unaudited SAP  Financial  Statements)  and
150 days (with respect to audited SAP Financial Statements) following the end of
each Insurance  Subsidiary's fiscal year (or such earlier date as such are filed
with the applicable insurance regulatory authority), copies of the unaudited (if
required to be filed with a  regulatory  authority)  and  audited SAP  Financial
Statements  for  such  Insurance  Subsidiary,  in each  case  setting  forth  in
comparative  form the figures  for the  preceding  fiscal  year and  prepared in
accordance  with SAP, all in  reasonable  detail and  accompanied  by an opinion
thereon of a firm of  independent  public  accountants  of  recognized  national
standing selected by the Borrower and reasonably  acceptable to the Bank, to the
effect that the financial  statements  have


                                      -23-
<PAGE>

been prepared in accordance with SAP (except for changes in application in which
such  accountants  concur)  and  present  fairly  in all  material  respects  in
accordance with SAP the financial  condition of such Insurance  Subsidiary as of
the end of such  fiscal year and the  results of its  operations  for the fiscal
year then ended and that the examination of such  accountants in connection with
such financial  statements has been made in accordance  with generally  accepted
auditing  standards  and,  accordingly,  included  such tests of the  accounting
records and such other auditing  procedures as were  considered  necessary under
the circumstances.

     (iii)  Quarterly SAP  Statements.  As soon as  available,  and in any event
within the time period required by the applicable regulatory  authority,  copies
of the unaudited SAP Financial  Statements for each  quarterly  fiscal period of
each Insurance  Subsidiary,  in each case setting forth in comparative  form the
figures for the preceding  fiscal year and prepared in accordance  with SAP, all
in  reasonable  detail and  certified  by the chief  executive  officer or chief
financial  officer  of  such  Insurance   Subsidiary  as  presenting  fairly  in
accordance with SAP the financial  condition of such Insurance  Subsidiary as of
the end of such period and results of  operations  for such  period,  subject to
normal year-end accruals and audit adjustments.

     (iv) SEC Filings.  Promptly  after the same are  available,  copies of each
annual  report,  proxy or financial  statement or other report or  communication
sent to the  stockholders  of the  Borrower  and copies of all annual,  regular,
periodic and special reports and registration  statements which the Borrower may
file or be required to file with the  Securities and Exchange  Commission  under
Sections 13 and 15(d) of the  Securities  and  Exchange  Act of 1934,  including
without limitation Forms 10-Q and 10-K filed by the Borrower.

     (v) Adequacy of Reserves. As soon as practicable,  and, in any case, within
60 days after the end of each fiscal year of OLRI,  written  confirmation of the
adequacy  of the  reserves  of  OLRI  from  an  independent  actuarial  firm  of
recognized  standing  selected by the Borrower and reasonably  acceptable to the
Bank.

     (vi)  Certificate.  At the  time the  financial  statements  are  furnished
pursuant to  subsections  (i),  (ii) and (iii) above,  the  Borrower  shall also
furnish a certificate of the chief executive  officer or chief financial officer
of the Borrower  stating that no event has occurred which  constitutes a Default
or an Event of Default  under any of the Loan  Documents or if such an event has
occurred,  disclosing  each  such  event  or  failure  and its  nature,  when it
occurred,  whether it is continuing and the steps being taken by the Borrower or
the Guarantors with respect to such event or failure.

     (vii) Copies of Other Reports.

     (1) From time to time and promptly upon each request, such existing reports
and other information  regarding the business,  assets,  liabilities,  financial
condition,  results of operations or business  prospects of the Borrower and its
Subsidiaries as the Bank may reasonably request; and

     (2) Within 15 days after the Borrower and its Subsidiaries have filed their
federal tax returns each year, a copy of such tax returns.



                                      -24-
<PAGE>

     (viii) Notice of Litigation and Other Matters. Prompt notice of:

     (1) the  commencement of any proceeding or  investigation  by or before any
governmental  body and any  action or  proceeding  in any  court or  before  any
arbitrator against or in any other way relating adversely to the Borrower or any
of its Subsidiaries or any of their respective  properties,  assets or business,
which, in the reasonable  judgment of the senior management of the Borrower,  if
adversely   determined,   would  singly  or  when   aggregated  with  all  other
proceedings,  investigations  or actions,  materially  and adversely  affect the
business,  results of operations  or financial  condition of the Borrower or its
Subsidiaries;

     (2) any notice received from any administrative official or agency relating
to any order, ruling, statute or other law or information which would materially
and adversely affect the operations of the Borrower or its Subsidiaries;

     (3) any amendment of the  certificate  of  incorporation  or by-laws of any
Borrower or its Subsidiaries;

     (4) any  material  adverse  change with  respect to the  business,  assets,
liabilities, financial condition or results of operations of the Borrower or its
Subsidiaries;

     (5) any  Default  or Event of  Default  by the  Borrower  hereunder  or any
default under any other  material  agreement to which the Borrower or any of its
Subsidiaries  is a party or by which any of their  respective  properties may be
bound; and

     (6) any event which  would  result in a  representation  or warranty of the
Borrower  contained  herein being false or incorrect in any material  respect if
made on and as of the date of occurrence of such event.

     (ix) ERISA

     (a) As soon  as  possible,  and in any  event  within  30  days  after  any
executive officer of the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries knows or has reason
to know that any  reportable  event (as  defined in Section  4043 of ERISA) with
respect to any Plan has  occurred,  a statement of the chief  executive  officer
setting  forth  details  as to such  reportable  event and the  action  that the
Borrower or any such Subsidiary proposes to take with respect thereto,  together
with a copy of the notice of such reportable  event given to the Pension Benefit
Guaranty Corporation.

     (b) Promptly  after receipt  thereof,  a copy of any notice the Borrower or
any  of  its   Subsidiaries  may  receive  from  the  Pension  Benefit  Guaranty
Corporation  relating to the intention of said Corporation to terminate any Plan
or to appoint a trustee to administer any Plan.

     5.9 Accuracy and Completeness of Information.  The Borrower  covenants that
all information, reports, statements, and other papers and data furnished to the
Bank pursuant to any


                                      -25-
<PAGE>

provision or term of any of the Loan Documents shall be, at the time the same is
so furnished, complete and correct in all material respects.

     5.10 Insurance.  The Borrower will, and will cause each of its Subsidiaries
to, maintain with financially sound and reputable  insurance companies insurance
in such types and amounts as is customarily  maintained for companies in similar
industries and reasonably acceptable to the Bank.

     5.11  Indebtedness.  The  Borrower  will not, and will not allow any of its
Subsidiaries  to,  create,  assume,  incur,  guarantee  or in any manner  become
liable,  contingently or otherwise,  in respect of any  Indebtedness  except for
Permitted  Indebtedness;  provided,  however, that the foregoing provision shall
not  apply  if,  concurrently  with the  incurrence  of such  Indebtedness,  the
proceeds thereof are applied to the complete satisfaction and payment in full of
all Obligations.

     5.12  Liens.  The  Borrower  will  not,  and  will  not  allow  any  of its
Subsidiaries  to,  create,  assume or incur or cause to be  created,  assumed or
incurred,  or permit to exist,  any Liens on its properties or assets except for
Permitted Liens.

     5.13 Sale of Assets; Merger; Acquisitions.

     (a) The  Borrower  will  not,  and  will  not  allow  or  cause  any of its
Subsidiaries  to (i) sell,  transfer,  assign,  lease or  otherwise  dispose  of
(whether in one transaction or a series of  transactions)  all or  substantially
all of its assets  (whether now owned or hereafter  acquired) or (ii) subject to
the provisions of Section 5.1 hereof,  consolidate  with or merge into any other
corporation or permit any corporation to merge into it.

     (b) Except for Permitted Acquisitions,  the Borrower will not, and will not
allow  or  cause  any  of its  Subsidiaries  to,  undertake  or  consummate  any
Acquisition  without the prior written  approval of the Bank, which approval may
be granted or withheld in the Bank's sole discretion.

     5.14 Guarantees.  The Borrower will not, and will not allow or cause any of
its Subsidiaries to, guarantee,  endorse, become surety for, or otherwise in any
way become or be responsible for, the obligations of any other Person whether by
agreement to purchase the indebtedness of any other Person, or agreement for the
furnishing  of funds,  directly  or  indirectly,  for the  purpose of payment of
indebtedness  of any other  Person,  other  than in  connection  with  Permitted
Indebtedness  and   endorsements  of  negotiable   instruments  for  deposit  or
collection in the ordinary course of its business.

     5.15 Issuance of Stock.  Except (a) pursuant to and in accordance  with the
employee  stock  option plan of the Borrower in effect as of the date hereof and
more fully  described  on  Schedule  VI  attached  hereto,  and (b) for  issuing
securities  in an amount  which does not  exceed  fifteen  percent  (15%) of the
shareholders  equity of the issuer, the Borrower will not, and will not allow or
cause any of its  Subsidiaries to, issue to any Person any shares of its capital
stock (whether  common or preferred) nor any options,  subscriptions,  warrants,
rights,  contracts,  commitments,  understandings  or  agreements to purchase or
otherwise  acquire  any such  shares  (including  any  rights of  conversion  or
exchange) without the prior written consent of the Bank.



                                      -26-
<PAGE>

     5.16 [Intentionally Omitted].

     5.17 Financial Covenants.

     (a) Minimum  Consolidated GAAP Net Worth. The Borrower shall not permit, as
of the end of any fiscal  quarter,  Consolidated  GAAP Net Worth of the Borrower
and  its  Subsidiaries  to be  less  than  an  amount  equal  to the  sum of (a)
$30,000,000,  plus (b) 50% of the  Consolidated  Net Income for the fiscal  year
ending December 31, 1997, plus (c) 50% of any cumulative positive net income (as
determined in accordance with GAAP) for each fiscal quarter following the fiscal
quarter ending December 31, 1997.

     (b) Minimum Statutory Surplus. The Borrower shall not permit, as of the end
of any fiscal quarter, Statutory Surplus of OLRI to be less than an amount equal
to the sum of (a) $23,000,000,  plus (b) 50% of the Statutory Net Income of OLRI
for the fiscal year ending  December 31, 1997,  after dividends to the Borrower,
plus (c) 50% of any  cumulative  positive  Statutory  Net Income of OLRI,  after
dividends to the Borrower,  for each fiscal quarter following the fiscal quarter
ending December 31, 1997.

     (c) Maximum Premiums to Surplus.  The Borrower shall not permit,  as of the
end of any fiscal  quarter,  the ratio of Net  Premiums  Written by OLRI for the
immediately  preceding  four  fiscal  quarters  (ending  on such date) to OLRI's
Statutory Surplus at the end of such fiscal quarter to be greater than 2.5 to 1.

     (d) Debt Service Coverage Ratio. The Borrower and its Subsidiaries shall at
all times maintain a Debt Service Coverage Ratio of not less than 1.25 to 1.

     5.18 OLRI Rating.  The Borrower shall at all times cause OLRI to maintain a
minimum  rating  of  "A-"  as  assigned  in  A.M.   Best's   Insurance   Reports
Property/Casualty Edition.

     5.19 New Subsidiaries.  Simultaneously  with the creation or Acquisition of
each new  Subsidiary  by the Borrower or one of its  Subsidiaries,  the Borrower
shall, or shall cause the acquiring Subsidiary to, either:

     (a) If permitted by applicable  law,  cause such new  Subsidiary to execute
and deliver to the Bank a joinder of guaranty in form and substance satisfactory
to the Bank,  pursuant  to which such new  Subsidiary  joins in,  and  becomes a
Guarantor  under,  the  Guaranty  Agreement  with the same effect as if such new
Subsidiary had executed and delivered the Guaranty Agreement on the date hereof;
or

     (b) If such new  Subsidiary is not  permitted by applicable  law to join in
the Guaranty Agreement and such new Subsidiary is an Insurance  Subsidiary,  (i)
execute  and  deliver  to the  Bank an  amendment  to the  Pledge  and  Security
Agreement, in form and substance satisfactory to the Bank, pursuant to which the
Borrower  shall  pledge  to the  Bank  all of the  capital  stock  of  such  new



                                      -27-
<PAGE>

Subsidiary, and (ii) deliver to the Bank an opinion of local counsel to such new
Subsidiary,  covering  such matters and otherwise in form and substance as shall
be reasonably acceptable to the Bank.

     5.20 Out-of Debt Period.  For a period of 30 consecutive days commencing no
later  than the date which is 30 days prior to the  Revolving  Loan  Termination
Date,  the Borrower  shall reduce its  outstanding  Advances under the Revolving
Loan to, and shall maintain the outstanding balance under the Revolving Loan at,
$0.

     5.21  Further  Documentation.  At any time and from  time to time  upon the
Bank's  written  request and at the Borrower's  sole expense,  the Borrower will
promptly and duly execute and deliver such further documents and instruments and
do such further acts and things as the Bank may  reasonably  request in order to
obtain the full benefits of this Agreement and the Loan Documents and the rights
and powers herein and therein granted,  including the filing of any financing or
continuation  statements and amendments  thereto under the Code in effect in any
jurisdiction and any and all other recording documents with respect to the Liens
and security  interests granted to the Bank pursuant to the Loan Documents.  The
Borrower  also  hereby  authorizes  the  Bank  to file  any  such  financing  or
continuation  statement  without  the  signature  of the  Borrower to the extent
permitted by applicable  law. If any amount payable under or in connection  with
any of the Collateral  shall be or become  evidenced by any  promissory  note or
other  instrument  or chattel  paper,  such note or other  instrument or chattel
paper shall be  immediately  pledged to the Bank  hereunder,  duly endorsed in a
manner satisfactory to the Bank and delivered to the Bank.

     5.22 Bank's Appointment as  Attorney-in-Fact.  To the extent not prohibited
by applicable law or by any applicable  rule or regulation of the Securities and
Exchange  Commission or any insurance  regulatory  authority having jurisdiction
over the Borrower:

     (a) The Borrower hereby irrevocably  constitutes and appoints the Bank, and
any officer or agent thereof,  with full power of substitution,  as its true and
lawful  attorney-in-fact  with full irrevocable power and authority in the place
and stead of the  Borrower  and in the name of the  Borrower or in its own name,
from  time  to  time in the  Bank's  discretion  following  the  occurrence  and
continuance of an Event of Default, for the purpose of carrying out the terms of
this Agreement,  to take any and all  appropriate  action and to execute any and
all documents and instruments  which may be necessary or desirable to accomplish
the purposes of this Agreement.

     (b) The Borrower  hereby ratifies all that said attorneys shall lawfully do
or cause to be done by virtue hereof.  This power of attorney is a power coupled
with an interest and shall be irrevocable.

     (c) The powers  conferred on the Bank  hereunder  are solely to protect the
interests of the Bank and shall not impose any duty upon it to exercise any such
powers. The Bank shall be accountable only for amounts that it actually receives
as a result  of the  exercise  of such  powers,  and  neither  it nor any of its
directors,  officers,  employees or agents shall be  responsible to the Borrower
for any act or  failure  to act,  except  for its gross  negligence  or  willful
misconduct.



                                      -28-
<PAGE>

     5.23 Performance by Bank of Borrower's  Obligations.  If the Borrower fails
to perform or comply with any of its agreements  contained herein, and the Bank,
as provided  for by the terms of this  Agreement,  shall  perform or comply,  or
otherwise cause performance or compliance,  with such agreement, the expenses of
the Bank incurred in connection  with such  performance or compliance  (together
with  interest  thereon at the rate of 5% in excess of the Base  Rate)  shall be
payable by the Borrower to the Bank on demand and shall  constitute  Obligations
secured hereby.

     5.24 Year 2000 Compliance.  The Borrower and each of its Subsidiaries shall
take all action  reasonably  necessary to assure that all computer  software and
hardware used by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries in the operation of its
business are designed to be used prior to,  during,  and after the calendar year
A.D.  2000,  and such  software and hardware is intended to operate  during each
time period without error relating to date data,  including  without  limitation
dates on and after  January 1, 2000.  At the request of the Bank,  the  Borrower
shall provide the Bank with assurance  reasonably  acceptable to the Bank of the
compliance by the Borrower and each of its  Subsidiaries  with the provisions of
this Section.

     VI. CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

     6.1 Initial  Conditions  Precedent.  The obligation of the Bank to make the
Term  Loan and to make an  Advance  under  the  Revolving  Note,  as of the date
hereof, is subject to the condition  precedent that the Bank shall have received
each and every one of the  following  on or before  the date  hereof in form and
substance satisfactory to the Bank:

     (a) An  originally  executed  copy of this  Agreement and each of the other
Loan  Documents  which  are  dated the date  hereof,  and all  other  documents,
instruments and certificates required hereunder and thereunder;

     (b) A copy of the certificate of  incorporation  and bylaws of the Borrower
and  each  of the  Borrower's  Subsidiaries,  certified  as a true  copy  by the
Secretary or an Assistant  Secretary  of the Borrower or such  Subsidiaries,  as
applicable;

     (c) A good standing  certificate issued as of a recent date with respect to
the Borrower and each of the Borrower's  Subsidiaries  by the secretary of state
of the state of each such  entity's  incorporation  and each  state  where  such
entity is qualified to do business;

     (d) A  certificate  of  the  Secretary  or an  Assistant  Secretary  of the
Borrower and each Existing Guarantor certifying the names and true signatures of
the officers of the Borrower and each Existing Guarantor authorized to sign each
of the Loan  Documents  to which the  Borrower or each  Existing  Guarantor is a
party;

     (e) A copy of the  resolutions  approved by the Board of  Directors  of the
Borrower and each Existing  Guarantor  authorizing  the execution,  delivery and
performance  by the  Borrower  and each  Existing  Guarantor of each of the Loan
Documents to which it is a party,  certified as a true copy by the  Secretary or
an Assistant Secretary of the Borrower or each Existing Guarantor;



                                      -29-
<PAGE>

     (f)  Written   opinions  of  counsel  to  the  Borrower  and  the  Existing
Guarantors;

     (g)  Written   opinions  of  local   counsel  to  each  of  the   Insurance
Subsidiaries;

     (h)  Evidence  reasonably  satisfactory  to  the  Bank  that  all  filings,
recordings  and  other  actions  that are  necessary  or  desirable  in order to
establish and perfect the Bank's security  interest in the collateral  described
in the  Pledge and  Security  Agreement,  as a valid  perfected  first  priority
security interest shall have been or shall be duly effected,  including, without
limitation, the filing of financing statements, and the filing or recordation of
such other documents as the Bank shall deem necessary or desirable,  all in form
and substance  satisfactory  to the Bank, and all fees,  taxes and other charges
relating to such filings and recordings shall have been paid by the Borrower;

     (i) A letter  from the  Borrower's  actuary,  plan  administrator  or other
qualified  representative  stating  that  all of  the  Borrower's  Plans  are in
compliance with ERISA;

     (j) Certified true copies of the financial statements of Old Lyme Insurance
Company,  Ltd., as filed with the Bermuda Monetary  Authority,  for fiscal years
1994, 1995 and 1996.

     (k) Such other  documents  and  information  as the Bank  shall  reasonably
request,  in form and substance  satisfactory to the Bank, and all legal matters
and documents with respect to the  transactions  contemplated  by this Agreement
shall be satisfactory to counsel for the Bank.

     6.2 Conditions  Precedent to Additional Advances and Acquisition  Advances.
The Bank shall have no obligation to make any additional  Advance or Acquisition
Advance  subsequent to the date hereof  unless each of the following  conditions
precedent has been either satisfied or waived prior to or concurrently  with the
making of such Advance or Acquisition Advance.

     (a) Each of the conditions of Section 6.1 has been satisfied or waived;

     (b) Each of the Loan Documents shall be in full force and effect;

     (c) The  representations  and  warranties  of the Borrower set forth herein
shall be true and correct as of the date of each Advance or Acquisition  Advance
as if made on and as of such date;

     (d) In the case of an  Acquisition  Advance,  the Borrower has executed and
delivered  to the  Bank  an  Acquisition  Note  and,  in  the  case  of a  stock
Acquisition,  the Borrower or the new  Subsidiary,  as applicable,  has complied
with the provisions of Section 5.19 hereof;

     (e) No Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing as of the
date of each Advance or Acquisition Advance;

     (f) There is and has been no material  adverse  change in the Borrower's or
any of the Borrower's  Subsidiaries' financial condition,  results of operations
or otherwise  which would,  in the judgment of the Bank,  impair the  Borrower's
ability to repay all or any portion of the Notes; and



                                      -30-
<PAGE>

     (g) No further action,  including any filing or recording of any agreement,
document or  instrument,  is necessary to establish  and perfect the Bank's Lien
and priority in the Collateral.

     Each request for an Advance or Acquisition Advance by the Borrower shall be
deemed a representation and warranty by the Borrower that each of the conditions
precedent  set forth in Sections  6.2(a),  (b), (c), (e), (f) and (g) hereof has
been satisfied, unless the Bank has waived satisfaction of any such condition in
writing prior to or concurrently with the making of such Advances or Acquisition
Advances, in which case the representation and warranty of the Borrower will not
be deemed to extend to that particular condition.

     VII. EVENTS OF DEFAULT

     7. Each of the following shall constitute an Event of Default, whatever the
reason for such event and whether it shall be  voluntary  or  involuntary  or be
effected by  operation  of law or pursuant to any judgment or order of any court
or any order, rule or regulation of any governmental body:

     7.1 The  Borrower  shall fail to make any payment of  principal or interest
under the Notes or hereunder on any date when due.

     7.2 If any warranty or representation  made by or on behalf of the Borrower
or any of its  Subsidiaries  contained herein or in any of the Loan Documents or
in any document furnished in compliance or connection with the Loan Documents is
false or incorrect in any material respect when made.

     7.3 The Borrower  shall  default in the  performance  or  observance of any
covenant or agreement  contained in this Agreement  (which is not the subject of
Section 7.1 or 7.2 hereof) and such default  shall  continue  unremedied  for 30
days after any officer of the Borrower shall have become aware of such default.

     7.4 If any  Event of  Default  shall  occur  under  any of the  other  Loan
Documents.

     7.5 The  Borrower  shall (i) default in any payment of the  principal of or
interest on any  Indebtedness  (other  than the  Indebtedness  evidenced  by the
Notes)  owing to the Bank,  (ii)  default in any payment of the  principal of or
interest on any Indebtedness,  which,  whether individually or together with all
such other  Indebtedness  as to which a default has occurred,  equals or exceeds
$250,000 (other than the Indebtedness evidenced by the Notes), beyond the period
of grace,  if any,  provided in the  instrument  or  agreement  under which such
Indebtedness  was created;  or (iii) default in the observance or performance of
any other agreement or condition  relating to any such Indebtedness or contained
in any instrument or agreement evidencing,  securing or relating thereto, or any
other event shall occur, the effect of which default or other event is to cause,
or to permit the holder or holders of such  Indebtedness  (or a trustee or agent
on behalf of such  holder or  holders)  to cause,  with the  giving of notice if
required,  such  Indebtedness  to become due prior to its stated maturity and as
the result of


                                      -31-
<PAGE>

such default or event such  Indebtedness has been accelerated and become due and
payable prior to its stated maturity.

     7.6 (i) The Borrower  shall  commence any case,  proceeding or other action
(A) under any existing or future law of any  jurisdiction,  domestic or foreign,
relating to bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or relief of debtors, seeking
to have an order for relief entered with respect to it, or seeking to adjudicate
it a bankrupt or insolvent, or seeking reorganization,  arrangement, adjustment,
winding-up, liquidation,  dissolution,  composition or other relief with respect
to it or its debts, or (B) seeking appointment of a receiver, trustee, custodian
or  other  similar  official  for it or for all or any  substantial  part of its
assets,  or the Borrower shall make a general  assignment for the benefit of its
creditors;  or (ii) there  shall be  commenced  against the  Borrower  any case,
proceeding or other action of a nature referred to in clause (i) above which (A)
results  in the  entry of an  order  for  relief  or any  such  adjudication  or
appointment or (B) remains undismissed, undischarged or unbonded for a period of
60 days;  or (iii)  there shall be  commenced  against  the  Borrower  any case,
proceeding  or  other  action  seeking  issuance  of a  warrant  of  attachment,
execution,  distraint or similar process against all or any substantial  part of
its assets,  which  results in the entry of an order for any such  relief  which
shall not have been  vacated,  discharged,  or stayed or bonded  pending  appeal
within 60 days from the  entry  thereof;  or (iv) the  Borrower  shall  take any
action  in  furtherance  of, or  indicating  its  consent  to,  approval  of, or
acquiescence in, any of the acts set forth in clauses (i), (ii) or (iii) above.

     7.7 A final judgment shall be entered against the Borrower by any court for
the  payment  of money  which,  together  with all other  outstanding  judgments
against the Borrower,  exceeds $250,000 in the aggregate,  which judgment is not
fully covered by  insurance,  or a warrant of attachment or execution or similar
process  shall be issued or  levied  against  property  of the  Borrower,  which
together  with other such  property  subject to other such  process,  exceeds in
value  $250,000  in the  aggregate  and,  if  within  60 days  (10  days if such
aggregate amount exceeds $400,000) after the entry, issue or levy thereof,  such
judgment,  warrant or process shall not have been  discharged or stayed  pending
appeal,  or,  if  within  60 days  (10  days if such  aggregate  amount  exceeds
$400,000)  after the  expiration  of any such stay,  such  judgment,  warrant or
process shall not have been discharged.

     7.8 (i) A  reportable  event (as defined in Section 4043 (b) of Title IV of
ERISA) shall have  occurred  with  respect to any  "employee  benefit  plan" (as
defined  in  Section  3  of  ERISA)   maintained  by  the  Borrower  or  to  any
multi-employer  plan in  which  the  Borrower  participates  (collectively,  the
"Benefit Plans") or any Benefit Plan of the Borrower shall have been voluntarily
terminated  as  provided  in  Section  4041(a)  of  ERISA  and  the  guaranteed,
nonfunded, nonforfeitable benefits (as such terms are defined in Section 4022 of
ERISA) of any such Benefit  Plan that has been  voluntarily  terminated  or with
respect to which a reportable event has occurred, when included in the financial
statements of the Borrower on a pro forma basis as a current  liability and as a
deduction from net worth, would cause the Borrower to have a negative net worth;
(ii) A  trustee  shall  be  appointed  by a  United  States  District  Court  to
administer any Benefit Plan; or (iii) the Pension Benefit  Guaranty  Corporation
shall institute proceedings to terminate any Benefit Plan.

     7.9 If the  Borrower  shall  cease to own and  control  100% of the capital
stock of each of its Subsidiaries,  or if the Borrower shall commence any action
or step with  respect  to, or shall


                                      -32-
<PAGE>

approve any plan of, any  liquidation  or  dissolution of the Borrower or any of
its Subsidiaries,  unless provision is otherwise made for the payment in full of
the Obligations.

     7.10  If  any  Guarantor  shall  terminate  or  attempt  to  terminate  its
obligations under the Guaranty Agreement.

     VIII. REMEDIES

     8.1 Upon the  occurrence  of an Event of Default set forth in Section  7.6,
the Bank shall have no  obligation  to make any further  Advance or  Acquisition
Advance,  and all amounts  outstanding  (with accrued interest  thereon) and all
other  amounts  owing  under  the  Notes  and the  other  Loan  Documents  shall
immediately  become due and  payable  without  presentment,  demand,  protest or
notice of any kind, all of which are hereby expressly waived by the Borrower.

     8.2 Upon the occurrence of any other Event of Default,  the Bank shall have
no obligation to make any further  Advance or  Acquisition  Advance and the Bank
may declare all amounts  outstanding  (with  accrued  interest  thereon) and all
other amounts owing to it under the Notes and the other Loan Documents to be due
and  payable  forthwith,  whereupon  the same shall  immediately  become due and
payable without presentment, demand, protest or other notice of any kind, all of
which are hereby expressly waived by the Borrower.

     8.3 Upon the occurrence of any Event of Default:

     (i) All payments  received by the Borrower under or in connection  with any
of the Collateral  shall be held by the Borrower in trust for the Bank, shall be
segregated  from other funds of the Borrower and shall forthwith upon receipt by
the  Borrower  be turned  over to the Bank,  in the same form as received by the
Borrower (duly endorsed by the Borrower to the Bank, if required); and

     (ii) Any and all such  payments so received by the Bank  (whether  from the
Borrower or otherwise)  may, in the sole  discretion of the Bank, be held by the
Bank as collateral  security for, and/or then or at any time thereafter  applied
in whole or in part by the Bank against,  all or any part of the  Obligations in
such order as the Bank shall  determine in its sole  discretion.  Any balance of
such payments  held by the Bank and remaining  after payment in full of all such
Obligations  shall be paid over to the  Borrower  or, if the Bank has  knowledge
that  another  Person is lawfully  entitled  to receive the same,  to such other
Person.

     8.4 If any Event of Default shall occur, the Bank may exercise, in addition
to all other  rights and  remedies  granted to it in this  Agreement  and in any
other Loan Document,  all rights and remedies of a secured party under the Code.
Without  limiting the  generality of the  foregoing,  the Bank may,  without any
requirement  of notice,  setoff any and all amounts  owing by the Borrower to it
against any deposit account  maintained in the Bank by the Borrower or any other
property of the Borrower which may now or hereafter be in the Bank's  possession
or  control,  and such  right of setoff  shall be deemed to have been  exercised
immediately  upon such stated or  accelerated  maturity as aforesaid even though
such setoff is not noted on the records of the Bank until a later time.



                                      -33-
<PAGE>

     8.5 The Borrower also agrees to pay all Bank Costs incurred with respect to
the  collection  of any of the  Obligations  and the  enforcement  of any of the
Bank's rights hereunder.

     8.6 The Borrower  hereby  waives (i)  presentment,  demand,  protest or any
notice (to the extent  permitted by  applicable  law) of any kind in  connection
with this Agreement or any Collateral, except as otherwise provided herein, (ii)
all rights to seek from any court any bond or security  prior to the exercise by
the Bank of any remedy  described  herein,  (iii) the benefit of all  valuation,
appraisement  and  exemption  laws and (iv) all  rights to demand or to have any
marshaling  of assets  upon any power of sale  granted  herein  or  pursuant  to
judicial  proceedings  or  upon  any  foreclosure  or any  enforcement  of  this
Agreement.

     8.7  Without  limiting  the  generality  of any of the rights and  remedies
conferred upon the Bank in this Agreement, the Bank may, after the occurrence of
an Event of Default and to the full extent permitted by applicable law: (i) take
immediate  possession  of the  Collateral,  either  personally  or by means of a
receiver  appointed  by a court of  competent  jurisdiction;  (ii) at the Bank's
option,  use,  operate,  manage and control the Collateral in any lawful manner;
(iii)  collect and  receive all rents,  income,  revenue,  earnings,  issues and
profits  therefrom;  and (iv) maintain,  repair,  renovate,  alter or remove the
Collateral as the Bank may determine in its sole discretion.

     IX. INDEMNIFICATION

     9.1 Indemnification.  The Borrower agrees to pay, reimburse,  indemnify and
hold  harmless,  the  Bank,  its  directors,  officers,  employees,  agents  and
representatives  from  and  against  any  and  all  actions,   costs,   damages,
disbursements,  expenses  (including  reasonable  attorneys'  fees),  judgments,
liabilities,  losses,  obligations,  penalties  and  suits of any kind or nature
whatsoever with respect to:

     (i) (A) subject to the  provisions  of Sections  2.31 and 2.32 hereof,  the
development, preparation and execution of any of the Loan Documents, (B) subject
to the provisions of Section 2.31 hereof,  the performance and administration of
any of the Loan Documents and (C) the  enforcement,  interpretation,  amendment,
modification, waiver or consent of any of the Loan Documents;

     (ii)  the  exercise  of any  right  or  remedy  granted  in any of the Loan
Documents, the collection or enforcement of any of the Obligations and the proof
or allowability of any claim arising under any of the Loan Documents, whether in
any bankruptcy or receivership proceeding or otherwise;

     (iii) any claim of third parties,  and the prosecution or defense  thereof,
arising out of or in any way connected with any of the Loan Documents; and

     (iv) any and all search,  recording and filing fees and taxes,  and any and
all  liabilities  with respect  thereto,  or resulting  from any delay in paying
stamp and other taxes,  if any, which may be payable or determined to be payable
in connection with the Loan Documents.



                                      -34-
<PAGE>

     Notwithstanding  the  foregoing,  the Bank  shall  not be  entitled  to any
indemnification with respect to its own gross negligence or willful misconduct.

     X. MISCELLANEOUS

     10.1 Notice. All notices and other communications given to or made upon any
party  hereto in  connection  with this  Agreement  shall,  except as  otherwise
expressly herein provided,  be in writing and hand delivered,  sent by certified
mail,  return  receipt  requested or  reputable  overnight  courier  providing a
receipt  against  delivery  or faxed (so long as,  concurrently  with  sending a
notice by fax,  a party  also  sends the  notice  by any other  means  permitted
hereunder) to the respective parties, as follows:

         Bank:             Summit Bank
                           250 Moore Street
                           2nd Floor
                           Hackensack, New Jersey  07601
                           Attention:  Ms. Lisa Cohen
                           Telecopy:  (201) 488-6185

                              - with a copy to -

                           Wolff & Samson
                           5 Becker Farm Road
                           Roseland, New Jersey 07068
                           Attention:  Laurence M. Smith, Esq.
                           Telecopy:  (973) 740-1407

         Borrower:         Kaye Group Inc.
                           122 East 42nd Street
                           New York, New York  10168
                           Attention:  Michael P. Sabanos
                           Telecopy:  (212) 867-0368

                              - with a copy to -

                           Kaye Group Inc.
                           122 East 42nd Street
                           New York, New York  10168
                           Attention:  Ivy Fischer, Esq.
                           Telecopy:  (212) 856-9458

or to such changed address as may be fixed by notice. All such notices and other
communications   shall,  except  as  otherwise  expressly  herein  provided,  be
effective  when  received by the party to whom


                                      -35-
<PAGE>

properly  addressed,  the  written  receipt  by any  employee  of any such party
constituting sufficient evidence of such receipt.

     10.2 No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies. No failure to exercise and no delay in
exercising,  on the part of the Bank, any right,  power or privilege  hereunder,
shall operate as a waiver thereof;  nor shall any single or partial  exercise of
any right,  power or privilege  hereunder preclude any other or further exercise
thereof or the exercise of any other right,  power or privilege.  The rights and
remedies  herein  provided  are  cumulative  and not  exclusive of any rights or
remedies provided by law.

     10.3 Survival of Agreements. All agreements, representations and warranties
made herein, and in any certificates  delivered  pursuant hereto,  shall survive
the  execution  and delivery of this  Agreement and the Notes and the making the
Term Loan and of any Advances and Acquisition Advances.

     10.4 Amendment.  No  modification,  amendment or waiver of any provision of
this Agreement or the Notes,  nor consent to any departure by the Borrower shall
in any event be effective  unless the same shall be in writing and signed by the
party granting such  modification,  amendment or waiver, and then such waiver or
consent shall be effective only in the specific instance and for the purpose for
which given.

     10.5 Successors and Assigns. This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure
to the benefit of the Borrower,  the Bank,  all future  holders of the Notes and
their respective successors and assigns, except that the Borrower may not assign
or transfer any of its rights under this Agreement,  the Notes or the other Loan
Documents without the prior written consent of the Bank, which may be granted or
withheld by the Bank in its sole and absolute  discretion.  This Agreement,  the
Notes and the other Loan  Documents may be endorsed,  assigned or transferred in
whole or in part by the Bank,  and any such holder or assignee of the same shall
succeed  to and be  possessed  of the rights and powers of the Bank under all of
the  same  to  the  extent   transferred  and  assigned.   The  Bank  may  grant
participations  in all or  any  portion  of  its  interest  in the  indebtedness
evidenced by the Notes,  and in such event the Borrower  shall  continue to make
payments  due  under  the  Notes to the Bank  and the Bank  shall  have the sole
responsibility  of allocating  and forwarding  such payments in the  appropriate
manner and amounts.

     10.6 Severability.  In case any one or more of the provisions  contained in
this Agreement or the Notes should be invalid,  illegal or  unenforceable in any
respect,  the validity,  legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions
contained  herein  and  therein  shall not in any way be  affected  or  impaired
thereby.

     10.7 Counterparts.  This Agreement may be executed by the parties hereto in
any number of separate  counterparts  and all such  counterparts  taken together
shall constitute one and the same original instrument.

     10.8 Governing Law; No Third Party Rights.  This  Agreement,  the Notes and
the other Loan Documents and the rights and obligations of the parties hereunder
and thereunder  shall be governed by and construed and interpreted in accordance
with the law of the  State of New  Jersey.


                                      -36-
<PAGE>

This  Agreement  is solely  for the  benefit  of the  parties  hereto  and their
respective  successors  and  assigns,  and no other person shall have any right,
benefit,  priority or interest  in, under or because of the  existence  of, this
Agreement.

     10.9 WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL; CONSENT TO JURISDICTION. AFTER CONSULTATION WITH
COUNSEL,  THE  BORROWER AND THE BANK HEREBY WAIVE THEIR RIGHT TO A TRIAL BY JURY
IN CONNECTION  WITH ANY AND ALL LITIGATION  INVOLVING THE SUBJECT MATTER OF THIS
AGREEMENT OR ANY OF THE OTHER LOAN  DOCUMENTS.  THE BORROWER AND THE BANK HEREBY
CONSENT TO THE  NON-EXCLUSIVE  JURISDICTION OF THE NEW JERSEY SUPERIOR COURT AND
THE  UNITED  STATES  DISTRICT  COURT  FOR  THE  DISTRICT  OF NEW  JERSEY  IN ANY
LITIGATION  ARISING  HEREUNDER.  THE BORROWER  HEREBY  IRREVOCABLY  APPOINTS IVY
FISCHER,  ESQ.  (WHOSE  ADDRESS IS 30 FAIRFIELD  STREET,  MONTCLAIR,  NEW JERSEY
07042) AS ITS AGENT FOR  PURPOSES  OF  RECEIVING  SERVICE OF PROCESS IN ANY SUCH
LITIGATION  AND FURTHER AGREES THAT SERVICE OF ANY SUCH PROCESS MAY BE EFFECTED,
IN ADDITION TO ANY OTHER MEANS  PERMITTED BY THE APPLICABLE  RULES OF COURT,  BY
MAILING SUCH PROCESS  CERTIFIED MAIL,  RETURN RECEIPT  REQUESTED OR BY REPUTABLE
OVERNIGHT  COURIER  PROVIDING A RECEIPT AGAINST DELIVERY TO SUCH AGENT OR TO THE
BORROWER.

     IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the parties  hereto have caused this  Agreement to be
duly executed and delivered by their proper and duly  authorized  officers as of
the day and year first above written.

                                 KAYE GROUP INC.



                                 By:
                                     --------------------------------
                                     Michael P. Sabanos
                                     Senior Vice President
                                     & Chief Financial Officer


                                 SUMMIT BANK



                                 By:
                                     --------------------------------
                                     Lisa Cohen, Vice President





                                      -37-
<PAGE>




 .

                              Schedules and Exhibit

                                       to

                                 Loan Agreement

                                 by and between

                                 Kaye Group Inc.

                                       and

                                   Summit Bank

                          -----------------------------

                                    Schedules
                                    ---------


Schedule I        -        Permitted Indebtedness

Schedule II       -        Permitted Liens

Schedule III      -        Pending or Threatened Litigation

Schedule IV       -        Subsidiaries

Schedule V        -        Real Property

Schedule VI       -        Employee Stock Option Plan





                                     Exhibit
                                     -------

Exhibit A         -        Form of Acquisition Note


<PAGE>

                                    EXHIBIT A

                            FORM OF ACQUISITION NOTE

$
 -----------------                                          --------------------
                                                                          [Date]


     FOR  VALUE  RECEIVED,   the  undersigned,   KAYE  GROUP  INC.,  a  Delaware
corporation  (the  "Borrower"),  hereby  unconditionally  promises  to pay on or
before  _______________________  (the "Maturity  Date"),  to the order of SUMMIT
BANK,  a banking  institution  of the State of New Jersey (the  "Bank"),  at the
office of the Bank located at 250 Moore Street, Hackensack, New Jersey 07601, or
at such other  location  as the Bank  shall  designate,  in lawful  money of the
United  States of America and in  immediately  available  funds,  the  principal
amount of $___________________. This Note is being executed and delivered by the
Borrower to the Bank  pursuant to Section 2.11 of that  certain  Loan  Agreement
dated June 24, 1998 between the Borrower and the Bank (the  "Agreement").  Terms
defined in the Agreement shall have the same meanings when used herein.

     The Borrower further agrees to pay interest in like money at such office on
the  unpaid  principal  amount  hereof  from time to time at a rate or rates per
annum as provided in the Agreement.

     The  principal  of and interest on this Note shall be payable at the times,
and in the manner, provided in the Agreement.

     The Borrower  shall pay to the Bank a late charge (the "Late Charge") in an
amount  equal to five  percent  (5%) of any payment  which is more than ten (10)
days in arrears  to cover the extra  expense  involved  in  handling  delinquent
payments,  but in no event  shall any Late  Charge be less than $25 or more than
$2,500. The term "payments" shall be construed to include  principal,  interest,
fees and any other  amount  due under the terms of this Note or any of the other
Loan  Documents.  Acceptance by the Bank of payment of a Late Charge shall in no
way be  construed  to be an election of remedies or waiver by the Bank of any of
its rights at law or under the terms of any of the Loan Documents.

     Subject to Section  2.25 of the  Agreement,  this Note may be  prepaid,  in
whole or in part, at one time or from time to time,  without  premium or penalty
in accordance with the provisions of the Agreement.

     This Note is secured by the  Collateral  described  in the  Agreement,  the
Pledge and Security Agreement and the other Loan Documents, and is guaranteed by
the Guarantors pursuant to the Guaranty Agreement.

     The Bank may declare this Note to be immediately  due and payable if any of
the following events shall have occurred and be continuing:



                                      A-1
<PAGE>

     (1) Failure by the  Borrower to make any payment of  principal  or interest
under this Note on any date when due; or

     (2) An Event of Default shall have  occurred  under the Agreement or any of
the other Loan Documents.

     Upon the  occurrence of any Event of Default,  the Bank may, in addition to
such other and  further  rights and  remedies as provided by law or under any of
the Loan Documents, (i) collect interest on such overdue amount from the date of
such  maturity  until paid at a rate per annum  equal to three  (3%)  percent in
excess of the Base Rate,  (ii) setoff such  amount  against any deposit  account
maintained in the Bank by the Borrower, and such right of setoff shall be deemed
to have been exercised immediately upon such stated or accelerated maturity even
though  such  setoff is not noted on the  records of the Bank until a later time
and (iii) hold as security any property  heretofore or hereafter  delivered into
the custody, control or possession of the Bank or any entity acting as agent for
the Bank by any person liable for the payment of this Note.

     This Note may not be changed  orally,  but only by an agreement in writing,
signed by the party against whom enforcement of any waiver, change, modification
or discharge is sought.

     Should  the  indebtedness  represented  by this Note or any part  hereof be
collected  at law or in equity,  or in  bankruptcy,  receivership,  or any other
court  proceeding,  or should this Note be placed in the hands of attorneys  for
collection  upon  default,  the  Borrower  agrees  to pay,  in  addition  to the
principal  and  interest  due  and  payable  hereon,  all  reasonable  costs  of
collecting or attempting to collect this Note, including  reasonable  attorneys'
fees and expenses.

     This Note  shall be and  remain  in full  force  and  effect  and in no way
impaired  until the  actual  payment  thereof  to the Bank,  its  successors  or
assigns.

     Anything  herein to the contrary  notwithstanding,  the  obligations of the
Borrower  under this Note shall be subject to the  limitation  that  payments of
interest shall not be required to the extent that receipt of any such payment by
the Bank would be contrary to provisions of law  applicable to the Bank limiting
the maximum rate of interest which may be charged or collected by the Bank.

     The Borrower and all  endorsers  and  guarantors  of this Note hereby waive
presentment, demand for payment, protest and notice of dishonor of this Note.

     This Note is binding upon the Borrower and its  successors  and assigns and
shall inure to the benefit of the Bank and its successors and assigns.



                                      A-2
<PAGE>

     This Note and the rights and  obligations  of the parties  hereto  shall be
subject to and governed by the laws of the State of New Jersey.

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF,  the undersigned has caused this Acquisition Note to be
duly executed by its authorized officers as of the day and year above written.


                                 KAYE GROUP INC.


                                 By:
                                     --------------------------------
                                      Name:
                                      Title:






















                                      A-3
<PAGE>



STATE OF                   :
                                  ss.
COUNTY OF                  :

     I CERTIFY that on _______________________,  ___________________  personally
appeared  before  me  and  that  this  person  acknowledged  under  oath,  to my
satisfaction, that:

     (a)  this person is the _______________ of KAYE GROUP INC., the corporation
          named in the attached document;

     (b)  this  person  executed  and  delivered  the  attached  document as the
          voluntary act and deed of the corporation; and

     (c)  this  person  was   authorized  by  the  board  of  directors  of  the
          corporation to execute and deliver the attached  document on behalf of
          the corporation.



                                  ------------------------------
                                  Notary Public


                                      A-4
<PAGE>


                               GUARANTY AGREEMENT


     THIS GUARANTY AGREEMENT is made June 24, 1998 by KAYE INSURANCE ASSOCIATES,
INC.,  a Delaware  corporation,  KAYE  CORPORATION  OF  CONNECTICUT,  a Delaware
corporation,  KAYE ADMINISTRATORS CORP., a Delaware  corporation,  KAYE SERVICES
CORP., a Delaware corporation,  KAYE-WESTERN INSURANCE & RISK SERVICES,  INC., a
Delaware corporation and PROGRAM BROKERAGE CORPORATION,  a Delaware corporation,
each having an address c/o Kaye Group Inc., 122 East 42nd Street,  New York, New
York 10168  (collectively,  the  "Guarantors"),  in favor of SUMMIT  BANK, a New
Jersey banking institute having an address at 250 Moore Street,  Hackensack, New
Jersey 07601 (the "Bank").

                                    RECITALS

     A. Concurrently herewith, the Bank and Kaye Group Inc. (the "Borrower") are
entering into a Loan Agreement (the "Loan Agreement") pursuant to which the Bank
is making  available  to the  Borrower,  on the terms and  conditions  contained
therein,  (i) a revolving  loan in the principal  amount of up to $4,500,000 and
(ii) a term  loan in the  principal  amount  of  $5,000,000  (collectively,  the
"Loans").

     B.  Pursuant  to the Loan  Agreement,  and to evidence  the Loans,  (i) the
Borrower  is  concurrently  herewith  executing  and  delivering  to the  Bank a
Revolving Note in the maximum principal amount of $4,500,000,  (ii) the Borrower
is concurrently herewith executing and delivering to the Bank a Term Note in the
original principal amount of $5,000,000 and (iii) the Borrower may in the future
execute  and  deliver  to the Bank  one or more  Acquisition  Notes to  evidence
Acquisition  Advances  made or to be made  under the Loan  Agreement  (the notes
referred  to in (i),  (ii) and  (iii)  above,  together  with all  modifications
thereto or substitutions  therefor, are hereinafter  collectively referred to as
the "Notes").

     C. As a condition to entering into the Loan  Agreement and making the Loans
to the  Borrower  pursuant  thereto,  the Bank  has  required  that  each of the
Guarantors  guarantee to the Bank the payment and performance of the obligations
of the Borrower  under the Loan  Agreement,  the Loans,  the Notes and the other
Loan Documents.

     D. Each Guarantor is a wholly owned subsidiary of the Borrower, which shall
loan a portion of the proceeds of the Loans to the Guarantors,  and as such each
Guarantor will derive direct and immediate benefits from the making of the Loans
by the Bank to the Borrower.

     NOW,  THEREFORE,  in  order  to  induce  the  Bank to  enter  into the Loan
Agreement  and make the  Loans as  aforesaid,  and for other  good and  valuable
consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the
Guarantors do hereby agree for the benefit of the Bank as follows:


                                    ARTICLE I

     1.1 Definitions. Terms used herein and not otherwise defined shall have the
meanings ascribed to them in the Loan Agreement.

     1.2 Joint and  Several  Liability.  Any  agreement,  promise,  undertaking,
representation  or warranty of the  Guarantors set forth in this Guaranty and in
any document or  certification  executed  and


<PAGE>

delivered by the Guarantors in connection  with this Guaranty shall be deemed to
have been made and given  jointly and severally by each of the  Guarantors,  and
each  reference  herein to the  Guarantors  shall be deemed to be a reference to
each Guarantor  individually  and/or  collectively,  as may be necessary for the
Bank to obtain  the full  benefit  of this  Guaranty  and the  rights and powers
herein granted.

     1.3  Guaranty.   The  Guarantors  hereby  irrevocably  and  unconditionally
guarantee to the Bank the prompt and complete  payment and performance  when due
(whether  at  stated  maturity,  by  acceleration  or  otherwise)  of all of the
Obligations,  including, without limitation, all principal,  interest (including
post-petition interest in the event the Borrower files or has filed against it a
petition in  bankruptcy)  and other amounts  payable under the Loan Agreement or
the Notes.

     1.4 Guaranty Unconditional. The obligations of the Guarantors hereunder are
irrevocable,   absolute,   and   unconditional,   irrespective   of  the  value,
genuineness, validity, regularity, or enforceability of any Loan Document or any
term or provision  thereof or of any other document  relating to the Obligations
or any other circumstance which might otherwise  constitute a legal or equitable
discharge or defense of a surety or guarantor.

     1.5 Consent. The Guarantors hereby consent that any or all of the following
actions may be taken or things done without notice to the Guarantors and without
affecting the liability of the Guarantors under this Guaranty:

     (a) The time for  performance of or compliance  with any of the Obligations
may be accelerated  or extended or such  performance or compliance may be waived
by  the  Bank   (including,   without   limitation,   the  renewal,   extension,
acceleration,  or other  change  in time of  payment,  or other  terms  of,  the
Obligations such as an increase or decrease in the rate of interest thereon);

     (b) Any of the acts  referred to in the terms of the Loan  Documents may be
performed,  including without limitation,  the making of Advances or Acquisition
Advances from time to time;

     (c) The terms of any of the  Obligations  or any term or  condition  in any
Loan  Document  may be amended by the  Borrower  and the Bank for the purpose of
adding any  provisions  thereto or changing in any manner the rights of the Bank
or of the Borrower thereunder;

     (d) Any  collateral  which has been granted or may  hereafter be granted by
the Borrower to the Bank to secure all or any part of the Obligations, including
without  limitation,  the  collateral  described in the Loan Agreement or in the
Pledge  and  Security  Agreement  (the  "Bank  Collateral"),  may be  exchanged,
surrendered,  or otherwise dealt with, and the Bank's interest thereunder may be
released and may or may not be perfected, all as the Bank in its sole discretion
may determine;

     (e)  The  Bank  may  apply  any of the  aforesaid  Bank  Collateral  to the
Obligations and direct the order or manner of sale thereof,  including,  without
limitation, a nonjudicial sale, as the Bank may in its sole discretion determine
(in accordance with the terms and conditions of the relevant Loan Documents with
respect  thereto),   all  without  affecting  the  liability  of  the  Guarantor
hereunder; and

     (f) The Bank may take any action or permit or waive any action or  inaction
on the part of any party with respect to the Obligations and any Bank Collateral
or other security  granted in connection  therewith,  all without  affecting the
liability of the Guarantor hereunder.



                                      -2-
<PAGE>

     1.6 The Bank Collateral.  The Guarantors acknowledge that their obligations
hereunder  will not be affected by (i) the Bank's  failure to properly  create a
lien on or security interest in the Bank Collateral,  (ii) the Bank's failure to
create or maintain a priority with respect to the lien on, or security  interest
purported to be created in, the Bank  Collateral or (iii) any act or omission of
the Bank (whether  negligent or otherwise)  which  adversely  affects the Bank's
purported  security  interest  in the Bank  Collateral  or lien  thereon  or the
priority of such security interest or lien.

     1.7  Tolling of  Statute  of  Limitations.  The  Guarantors  agree that any
payment of any of the  Obligations or other acts which shall toll any statute of
limitations  applicable  to the  Obligations  shall  also  toll the  statute  of
limitations applicable to the Guarantors' liability hereunder.

     1.8 Waiver.  The Guarantors hereby expressly waive diligence,  presentment,
demand for payment, protest, the benefit of any statute of limitations affecting
the  Borrower's  liability  under any Loan Document or the  enforcement  of this
Guaranty,  the  benefit of any act or  omission  by the Bank which  directly  or
indirectly  results  in or aids  the  discharge  of the  Borrower  or any of the
Obligations by operation of law or otherwise, all notices whatsoever, including,
without limitation,  notice of acceptance of this Guaranty, the incurring of the
Obligations  or  notice  of any  Default  or Event  of  Default  under  the Loan
Documents, and any requirement that the Bank exhaust or enforce any right, power
or remedy or proceed  against the  Borrower,  the Bank  Collateral  or any other
security  for, or any other  guarantor of, or any other party liable for, any of
the Obligations. The Guarantors specifically agree that it will not be necessary
or required,  and the Guarantors shall not be entitled to require, that the Bank
file suit or proceed to assert or obtain a claim for personal  judgment  against
the  Borrower  for the  Obligations  or to make  any  effort  at  collection  or
enforcement of the Obligations from the Borrower or foreclose against or seek to
realize upon the Bank Collateral or any other security now or hereafter existing
for the Obligations or this Guaranty or file suit or proceed to obtain or assert
a claim for the  Obligations or make any effort at collection of the Obligations
from any such party or exercise or assert any other right or remedy to which the
Bank is or may be entitled in connection with the Obligations or any security or
guarantee  relating  thereto or assert or file any claims  against the assets of
the Borrower or other person  liable for the  Obligations,  or any part thereof,
before or as a condition of enforcing the liability of the Guarantors hereunder.

     1.9 Certain Rights.  The Bank may pursue its rights and remedies under this
Guaranty  and shall be entitled  to payment  hereunder  notwithstanding  (i) any
other guarantee by any other party of all or any part of the  Obligations,  (ii)
any action taken by the Bank to enforce any of its rights or remedies under such
other guarantee or any security  agreement,  mortgage or deed of trust, or (iii)
any payment  received  under such other  guarantee  or any  security  agreement,
mortgage or deed of trust.  In pursuing  its rights  under this  Guaranty or any
other Loan  Document,  the Bank need not join the Guarantors in any suit against
the  Borrower or join the Borrower or any other  guarantors  in any suit against
the Guarantor. The Guarantors waive any right to require the Bank to give notice
of terms,  time, and place of any public or private sale of any Bank  Collateral
or any other security  granted in connection  with the  Obligations or to comply
with any other provisions of Section 9-504 of the Uniform Commercial Code.

     1.10 Continuing Guaranty.  This Guaranty shall be a continuing guaranty and
any other  guarantor or guarantors of all or a portion of the Obligations may be
released without affecting the liability of the Guarantors hereunder.

     1.11  Subrogation.  Unless  and  until the  Obligations  have been paid and
performed in full, (a) no payment  hereunder by the Guarantors shall entitle the
Guarantors by  subrogation  to the rights of the


                                      -3-
<PAGE>

Bank or any  other  guarantor  of any of the  Obligations  or  otherwise  to any
payment by the Borrower or out of the Borrower's property and (b) the Guarantors
waive  any right to  enforce  any  remedy of the Bank  which the Bank now or may
hereafter have against the Borrower, any other guarantor or any other person and
waive any benefit of, or any right to participation in, any security  whatsoever
now or hereafter held by or granted to the Bank, including,  but not limited to,
any rights which the  Guarantors  may have by reason of any rights,  powers,  or
remedies of the Borrower in connection with any  anti-deficiency or similar laws
limiting or qualifying the Obligations.

     1.12  Compromise  and  Settlement.  No  compromise,   settlement,  release,
renewal, extension, indulgence, change in, waiver, or modification of any of the
Obligations or the release or discharge of the Borrower from the  performance of
any of the  Obligations  shall  release or discharge  the  Guarantors  from this
Guaranty.

     1.13  Insolvency.  The voluntary or involuntary  liquidation,  dissolution,
sale  or  other   disposition  of  all  or  substantially  all  the  assets  and
liabilities, or receivership, insolvency, bankruptcy, assignment for the benefit
of creditors,  reorganization, or other proceeding affecting the Borrower or the
disaffirmance  of any Loan Document in any such proceeding  shall not release or
discharge the Guarantors from this Guaranty.

     1.14 Further Payments. The Guarantors further agree to pay forthwith,  upon
demand, all costs and expenses (including  reasonable  attorneys' fees) incurred
or expended by the Bank in  connection  with this  Guaranty and the  enforcement
thereof.


                                   ARTICLE II

     2.1  Representations  and Warranties.  In order to induce the Bank to enter
into  the Loan  Agreement  and to make the  Loans to the  Borrower  contemplated
thereby,  each of the Guarantors  hereby  represents and warrants to the Bank as
follows:

     (a) To the extent  same relate to or concern  the  Guarantors,  each of the
representations  and  warranties  contained  in the Loan  Agreement  are  hereby
incorporated  herein  by  reference,   and  each  Guarantor  hereby  makes  such
representations  and  warranties  to and for the  benefit of the Bank as if such
representations and warranties were set forth at length herein.

     (b) Without  limiting  the  generality  of the  foregoing,  each  Guarantor
represents and warrants that (i) such Guarantor has the full power and authority
to execute,  deliver and perform any action  which may be necessary or advisable
to carry out the terms of this  Guaranty,  and (ii) this  Guaranty has been duly
executed and  delivered by such  Guarantor  and is the legal,  valid and binding
obligation of such Guarantor,  enforceable  against such Guarantor in accordance
with its terms.

     2.2  Covenants.  Each  Guarantor  covenants  and agrees  that until all the
Obligations  have been  satisfied  and paid in full and the Bank has no  further
obligation  to extend  credit to the  Borrower  under  the Loan  Agreement,  the
Guarantors will comply with the following covenants:

     (a) The  Guarantors  shall pay dividends to the Borrower and otherwise take
such  actions  within  their power to enable the  Borrower to fully  perform and
observe all of the covenants,  agreements and  obligations of the Borrower under
each of the Loan Documents to which the Borrower is a party.



                                      -4-
<PAGE>

     (b) For as long as any of the  Obligations  are  outstanding,  no Guarantor
shall transfer,  assign or otherwise dispose of any material asset other than in
a bona fide, arm's length transaction.


                                   ARTICLE III

     3. Event of Default.  The occurrence of any Event of Default under the Loan
Agreement,  the Notes or any of the other Loan  Documents  shall  constitute  an
Event of Default hereunder.


                                   ARTICLE IV

     4.  Remedies.  Upon the  occurrence  of an Event of Default or in the event
that any portion of the  Obligations  shall have been  declared  due and payable
(whether at the stated maturity, by acceleration or otherwise), the Bank may, in
addition  to all other  rights and  remedies  as may be  available  at law or in
equity or under the terms of any of the Loan  Documents  and  without  demand of
performance or other demand,  advertisement  or notice of any kind,  immediately
set off any or all of the  Obligations  against any  property of the  Guarantors
which may now or  hereafter  be in the Bank's  possession  or control,  and such
right of setoff  shall be deemed to have  been  exercised  immediately  upon the
occurrence  of such Event of Default even though such setoff is not noted on the
records  of the Bank or the Bank until a later  time.  The  Guarantors  shall be
liable for the  deficiency if the proceeds of any sale or other  disposition  of
any Bank  Collateral  are  insufficient  to pay all amounts to which the Bank is
entitled hereunder,  including the fees of any attorneys employed by the Bank to
collect such deficiency.


                                    ARTICLE V

     5.1 No Waiver;  Cumulative Remedies. No failure to exercise and no delay in
exercising,  on the part of the Bank, any right,  power or privilege  hereunder,
shall operate as a waiver thereof;  nor shall any single or partial  exercise of
any right,  power or privilege  hereunder preclude any other or further exercise
thereof or the exercise  thereof or the  exercise of any other  right,  power or
privilege.  The rights and  remedies  herein  provided  are  cumulative  and not
exclusive of any rights or remedies provided by law.

     5.2  Amendment.  No  modification,  amendment or waiver of any provision of
this Guaranty shall be effective  unless the same shall be in writing and signed
by the Bank and then any such waiver or consent  shall be effective  only in the
specific instance and for the purpose for which given.

     5.3 Successors  and Assigns.  This Guaranty shall be binding upon and inure
to the benefit of the parties hereto,  all future holders of the Obligations and
their respective successors and assigns.

     5.4  Severability.  In case any one or more of the provisions  contained in
this Guaranty should be invalid,  illegal or unenforceable  in any respect,  the
validity,  legality and  enforceability  of the remaining  provisions  contained
herein shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.

     5.5 Governing Law; No Third Party Rights.  This Guaranty and the rights and
obligations  of the parties  hereunder  shall be governed by and  construed  and
interpreted  in  accordance  with the  laws of the  State  of New  Jersey.  This
Guaranty is solely for the benefit of the Bank and its  successors


                                      -5-
<PAGE>

and  assigns,  and no other person  shall have any right,  benefit,  priority or
interest in, under or because of the existence of, this Guaranty.

     5.6  Counterparts.  This Guaranty may be executed by the parties  hereto in
any number of counterparts,  each of which shall be an original and all of which
shall constitute one and the same instrument.

     5.7 Subordination of Loans. Any loans now existing or hereafter made by the
Guarantors to the Borrower are hereby  subordinated  to the repayment in full of
all of the  Obligations.  The  provisions  of this Section 5.7 shall survive the
termination of this Guaranty.

     5.8 Waiver of Jury Trial; Consent to Jurisdiction.  AFTER CONSULTATION WITH
COUNSEL,  EACH  GUARANTOR,  IN CONNECTION  WITH ANY LITIGATION  RELATING TO THIS
GUARANTY  OR THE LOANS,  HEREBY  IRREVOCABLY  (i) WAIVES ITS RIGHT TO A TRIAL BY
JURY, (ii) CONSENTS TO THE  NON-EXCLUSIVE  JURISDICTION OF THE STATE AND FEDERAL
COURTS OF THE STATE OF NEW JERSEY, (iii) WAIVES ALL DEFENSES,  INCLUDING WITHOUT
LIMITATION,  FORUM NON CONVENIENS,  TO EITHER OF THE AFORESAID  COURTS ASSERTING
PERSONAL  JURISDICTION  OVER SUCH GUARANTOR AND (iv) APPOINTS IVY FISCHER,  ESQ.
(WHOSE ADDRESS IS 30 FAIRFIELD STREET, MONTCLAIR, NEW JERSEY 07042) AS ITS AGENT
FOR PURPOSES OF RECEIVING SERVICE OF PROCESS IN ANY SUCH LITIGATION. In any such
litigation, each Guarantor hereby agrees that service of process may be effected
by  mailing  such  process  to its  agent,  at such  agent's  address or to such
Guarantor  at the  address  set forth on page 1 of this  Guaranty  or such other
address as such Guarantor shall have provided the Bank in writing,  by reputable
overnight  courier  providing a receipt  against  delivery or by certified mail,
return receipt requested.

     IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the Guarantors  have duly executed and delivered this
Guaranty as of the day and year first above written.


                                          KAYE INSURANCE ASSOCIATES, INC.


                                          By:
                                               -------------------------------
                                               Michael P. Sabanos
                                               Senior Vice President
                                               & Chief Financial Officer











                       [Signatures continued on next page]




                                      -6-
<PAGE>



                  [Signatures continued from previous page]



                                          KAYE CORPORATION OF
                                          CONNECTICUT


                                          By:
                                               -------------------------------
                                               Michael P. Sabanos
                                               Senior Vice President
                                               & Chief Financial Officer

                                          KAYE ADMINISTRATORS CORP.


                                          By:
                                               -------------------------------
                                               Michael P. Sabanos
                                               Senior Vice President
                                               & Chief Financial Officer

                                          KAYE SERVICES CORP.


                                          By:
                                               -------------------------------
                                               Michael P. Sabanos
                                               Senior Vice President
                                               & Chief Financial Officer

                                          KAYE-WESTERN INSURANCE &
                                          RISK SERVICES, INC.


                                          By:
                                               -------------------------------
                                               Michael P. Sabanos
                                               Senior Vice President
                                               & Chief Financial Officer


                                          PROGRAM BROKERAGE
                                          CORPORATION


                                          By:
                                               -------------------------------
                                               Michael P. Sabanos
                                               Senior Vice President
                                               & Chief Financial Officer



                                      -7-
<PAGE>

                          PLEDGE AND SECURITY AGREEMENT


     THIS  PLEDGE AND  SECURITY  AGREEMENT  is dated June 24, 1998 by KAYE GROUP
INC.,  a Delaware  corporation  having an address of 122 East 42nd  Street,  New
York,  New York  10168  (the  "Borrower")  in favor of  SUMMIT  BANK,  a banking
institution  of the State of New Jersey  having an address at 250 Moore  Street,
Hackensack New Jersey 07601 (the "Bank").

                                    RECITALS

     A. The Borrower is the record and beneficial owner of (i) all of the issued
and outstanding  shares of capital stock of Old Lyme Insurance  Company of Rhode
Island,  Inc., a Rhode Island corporation  ("OLRI"),  (ii) all of the issued and
outstanding  shares of capital  stock of Old Lyme  Insurance  Company,  Ltd.,  a
Bermuda  corporation  ("OLB") and (iii) all of the issued and outstanding shares
of capital stock of Claims  Administration  Corporation,  a Delaware corporation
("CAC").

     B.  Concurrently  herewith,  the Borrower and the Bank are entering  into a
Loan  Agreement  (the  "Loan  Agreement")  pursuant  to which the Bank is making
available to the Borrower,  on the terms and conditions contained therein, (i) a
revolving loan in the principal  amount of up to $4,500,000 and (ii) a term loan
in the principal amount of $5,000,000 (collectively, the "Loans").

     C.  Pursuant  to the Loan  Agreement,  and to evidence  the Loans,  (i) the
Borrower  is  concurrently  herewith  executing  and  delivering  to the  Bank a
Revolving Note in the maximum principal amount of $4,500,000,  (ii) the Borrower
is concurrently herewith executing and delivering to the Bank a Term Note in the
original principal amount of $5,000,000 and (iii) the Borrower may in the future
execute  and  deliver  to the Bank  one or more  Acquisition  Notes to  evidence
Acquisition  Advances  made or to be made  under the Loan  Agreement  (the notes
referred  to in (i),  (ii) and  (iii)  above,  together  with all  modifications
thereto or substitutions  therefor, are hereinafter  collectively referred to as
the "Notes").

     D. As a condition to entering into the Loan  Agreement and making the Loans
to the Borrower pursuant thereto,  and in order to secure the Obligations of the
Borrower to the Bank under the Loan Agreement,  the Loans,  the Notes, the other
Loan  Documents or otherwise,  the Bank has required that the Borrower  grant to
the Bank a pledge  of and  security  interest  in all of the  Pledged  Stock (as
hereinafter defined), all on the terms and conditions set forth herein.

     NOW,  THEREFORE,  in  consideration of the foregoing and for other good and
valuable consideration, the receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties
hereto agree as follows:

     1. Defined Terms.  Unless  otherwise  defined herein,  terms defined in the
Loan Agreement shall have such defined meanings when used herein.

     2. Pledge. As collateral  security for the prompt and complete payment when
due of the Obligations, together with any and all expenses which may be incurred
by the Bank in collecting any or all of the  Obligations or enforcing any of its
rights under this Agreement, the Borrower hereby pledges, assigns,  hypothecates
and  transfers  to the Bank,  and grants  the Bank a first lien on and  security
interest in, (a) the stock representing all of the issued and outstanding shares
of OLRI, together with all proceeds of the foregoing, (b) the stock representing
all of the issued and outstanding  shares of OLB,  together with all proceeds of
the foregoing and (c) the stock representing all of the issued and

                                      -1-
<PAGE>


outstanding  shares of CAC,  together with all proceeds of the foregoing (all of
the stock  described  in the  foregoing  clauses  (a),  (b) and (c) being herein
collectively  referred to as the "Pledged Stock").  Concurrently  herewith,  the
Borrower is delivering to the Bank certificates  representing all of the Pledged
Stock, together with appropriate undated stock powers duly executed in blank.

     3. Stock  Dividends,  Distributions,  etc. If,  while this  Agreement is in
effect, the Borrower shall become entitled to receive or shall receive any stock
certificate (including, without limitation, any certificate representing a stock
dividend or a distribution in connection with any reclassification,  increase or
reduction  of  capital,  or  issued in  connection  with any  reorganization  or
formation of a new Subsidiary),  option or rights, whether as an addition to, in
substitution  of,  or in  exchange  for any  shares  of any  Pledged  Stock,  or
otherwise, the Borrower shall accept the same as the Bank's agent, hold the same
in trust on  behalf  of and for the  benefit  of the Bank and  deliver  the same
forthwith to the Bank in the exact form  received,  with the  indorsement of the
Borrower when necessary and/or appropriate undated stock powers duly executed in
blank,  to be held by the Bank,  subject  to the  terms  hereof,  as  additional
collateral security for the Obligations. Any sums paid upon or in respect of the
Pledged Stock upon the liquidation or dissolution of the issuer thereof shall be
paid  over to the  Bank to be held as  additional  collateral  security  for the
Obligations;  and in case any  distribution  of  capital  shall be made on or in
respect of the Pledged Stock or any property shall be  distributed  upon or with
respect   to  the   Pledged   Stock   pursuant   to  the   recapitalization   or
reclassification  of the  capital  of the  issuer  thereof  or  pursuant  to the
reorganization  thereof,  the property so distributed  shall be delivered to the
Bank to be held by it as additional collateral security for the Obligations. All
sums of money and  property  so paid or  distributed  in respect of the  Pledged
Stock which are received by the Borrower  shall,  until paid or delivered to the
Bank, be held by the Borrower in trust as additional collateral security for the
Obligations.

     4. Collateral. All property at any time pledged with the Bank hereunder and
all income  therefrom  (other  than the cash  dividends  permitted  pursuant  to
Section 5 below) and proceeds thereof,  including without limitation the Pledged
Stock, are herein collectively sometimes called the "Collateral".

     5. Cash Dividends;  Voting Rights.  Unless a Default or an Event of Default
under the Loan Agreement shall have occurred and be continuing and to the extent
permitted under the terms of the Loan Agreement,  the Borrower shall be entitled
to receive all cash dividends paid in respect of the Pledged Stock,  to vote the
Pledged Stock and to give consents,  waivers and ratifications in respect of the
Pledged Stock; provided,  however, that no vote shall be cast or consent, waiver
or  ratification  given or action taken which would impair the Collateral or the
value  thereof  or be  inconsistent  with  or  violate  any  provision  of  this
Agreement,  the Loan  Agreement  or any of the  other  Loan  Documents.  After a
Default or an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Bank shall be
entitled to receive all cash dividends and distributions and to vote the Pledged
Stock.

     6. Rights of the Bank.  The Bank shall not be liable for failure to collect
or  realize  upon  the  Obligations  or any  collateral  security  or  guarantee
therefor,  or any part thereof, or for any delay in so doing, nor shall the Bank
be under any obligation to take any action  whatsoever with regard thereto.  Any
or all shares of the Pledged Stock held by the Bank  hereunder  may, if an Event
of Default has occurred and is continuing,  without prior notice,  be registered
in the  name  of the  Bank or its  nominee,  and the  Bank  or its  nominee  may
thereafter,  without prior notice,  exercise all voting and corporate  rights at
any meeting of any corporation issuing any of the shares included in the Pledged
Stock and exercise any and all rights of conversion,  exchange,  subscription or
any other rights,  privileges or options pertaining to any shares of the Pledged
Stock as if the Bank or its nominee were the absolute owner thereof,  including,
without limitation,  the right to exchange at its discretion, any and all of the



                                      -2-
<PAGE>

Pledged Stock upon the merger, consolidation,  reorganization,  recapitalization
or other readjustment of any corporation  issuing any of such shares or upon the
exercise  by any such  issuer  or the Bank of any  right,  privilege  or  option
pertaining to any shares of the Pledged Stock, and in connection  therewith,  to
deposit  and  deliver  any and all of the  Pledged  Stock  with  any  committee,
depository, transfer agent, registrar or other designated agency upon such terms
and conditions as it may determine,  all without liability except to account for
property actually received by it. Notwithstanding the foregoing,  the Bank shall
have no duty to exercise any of the aforesaid rights,  privileges or options and
shall not be responsible for any failure to do so or delay in so doing.

     7. Remedies.  In the event that the  Obligations  shall be declared due and
payable  (whether at the stated  maturity,  by acceleration  or otherwise),  the
Bank, without demand of performance or other demand,  advertisement or notice of
any kind  (except  the  notice  specified  below of time and  place of public or
private sale) to or upon the Borrower or any other Person (all and each of which
demands,  advertisements  and/or  notices  are  hereby  expressly  waived),  may
forthwith collect, receive,  appropriate and realize upon the Collateral, or any
part  thereof,  and/or may  forthwith  sell,  assign,  give option or options to
purchase,  contract to sell or otherwise dispose of and deliver said Collateral,
or any part thereof,  in one or more parcels at public or private sale or sales,
at any  exchange,  broker's  board or at any of the Bank's  offices or elsewhere
upon such terms and conditions as it may deem advisable and at such prices as it
may deem best, for cash or on credit or for future delivery  without  assumption
of any  credit  risk,  with the  right of the Bank  upon any such sale or sales,
public or private, to purchase the whole or any part of said Collateral so sold,
free of any right or equity of redemption in the Borrower, which right or equity
is hereby expressly waived or released. After deducting all reasonable costs and
expenses of every kind incurred in  connection  with any  collection,  recovery,
receipt,  appropriation,   realization  or  sale  (collectively,  a  "Sale")  or
incidental  to  the  care,  safekeeping  or  otherwise  of  any  and  all of the
Collateral or in any way relating to the rights of the Bank hereunder, including
reasonable  attorneys' fees and expenses,  the Bank shall apply the net proceeds
of such Sale to the payment in full of the Obligations, and only after so paying
over such net  proceeds  and after the  payment by the Bank of any other  amount
required by any provision of law need the Bank account for the surplus,  if any,
to the Borrower.  The Borrower  agrees that the Bank need not give more than ten
(10) days'  notice of the time and place of any public sale or of the time after
which a private  sale or other  intended  disposition  is to take place and that
such  notice is  reasonable  notification  of such  matters.  In addition to the
rights and remedies  granted to it in this Agreement and in any other instrument
or agreement  securing,  evidencing or relating to any of the  Obligations,  the
Bank shall have all the rights and  remedies of a secured  party under the Code.
The Borrower  shall be liable for the  deficiency if the proceeds of any sale or
other  disposition of the Collateral are insufficient to pay the Obligations and
all expenses,  including,  without limitation,  attorneys' fees and costs, which
may be  incurred by the Bank in  collecting  any or all of the  Obligations  and
enforcing its rights hereunder.

     8. Representations,  Warranties and Covenants of the Borrower. The Borrower
represents  and warrants  that: (a) the Borrower owns one hundred (100%) percent
of the Pledged Stock;  (b) the Borrower is legal record and beneficial owner of,
and has good and  marketable  title to, the Pledged  Stock,  subject to no Lien,
except the Lien  created by this  Agreement;  (c) all the shares of the  Pledged
Stock have been duly and validly issued, are fully paid and non-assessable;  (d)
there  are no  outstanding  subscriptions,  options,  warrants,  rights,  calls,
contracts,  commitments,  understandings  or agreements to purchase or otherwise
acquire or relating to the issuance of any shares or other  securities  of OLRI,
OLB or CAC;  (e) the  pledge,  assignment  and  delivery  of the  Pledged  Stock
pursuant to this Agreement  creates a valid first lien on and a first  perfected
security interest in such shares of the Pledged Stock, and the proceeds thereof,
subject to no prior Lien or to any  agreement  purporting  to grant to any third
party a Lien on the property or assets of the Borrower  which would  include the
Pledged  Stock;  and (f) the  Pledged  Stock is  evidenced  by the  certificates
described  on Exhibit A, and


                                      -3-
<PAGE>

there are no other Stock  Certificates  outstanding  for any other shares of the
capital  stock of OLRI,  OLB or CAC. The Borrower  covenants and agrees that the
Borrower will defend the Bank's right, title and security interest in and to the
Pledged  Stock and the  proceeds  thereof  against the claims and demands of all
Persons  whomsoever;  and  covenants and agrees that the Borrower will have like
title to and right to pledge any other property at any time hereafter pledged to
the Bank as  Collateral  hereunder  and will  likewise  defend the Bank's  right
thereto and security interest therein.

     9. No  Disposition,  etc. The Borrower  shall not sell,  assign,  transfer,
exchange,  or  otherwise  dispose of, or grant any option  with  respect to, the
Collateral, nor will the Borrower create, incur or permit to exist any Lien with
respect to any of the  Collateral,  or any  interest  therein,  or any  proceeds
thereof, except for the Lien provided for by this Agreement.  The Borrower shall
not vote to enable any issuer to, and will not  otherwise  permit any issuer to,
issue any stock or other  securities of any nature in addition to or in exchange
or substitution for the Pledged Stock.

     10.  Registration.  (a) The Borrower recognizes that the Bank may be unable
to effect a public  sale of any or all the  Pledged  Stock by reason of  certain
prohibitions   contained  in  the  Securities  Act  of  1933,  as  amended  (the
"Securities Act"), and applicable state securities laws, but may be compelled to
resort to one or more private sales thereof to a restricted  group of purchasers
who will be obliged to agree, among other things, to acquire such securities for
their own  account for  investment  and not with a view to the  distribution  or
resale thereof. The Borrower  acknowledges and agrees that any such private sale
may result in prices and other terms less  favorable  to the seller than if such
sale were a public sale.  The Bank shall be under no  obligation to delay a sale
of any of the  Pledged  Stock for the  period of time  necessary  to permit  any
issuer of such  securities to register such securities for public sale under the
Securities Act, or under  applicable  state securities laws, even if such issuer
would agree to do so.

     (b) The  Borrower  further  agrees to do or cause to be done all such other
reasonable acts and things as may be necessary to make such sale or sales of any
portion or all of the Pledged Stock valid and binding and in compliance with any
and all applicable laws,  regulations,  order,  writs,  injunctions,  decrees or
awards of any and all courts,  arbitrators  or  governmental  instrumentalities,
domestic or foreign, having jurisdiction over any such sale or sales, all at the
Borrower's  expense,  but excluding  registration of the Pledged Stock under the
Securities  Act.  The  Borrower  further  agrees  that  a  breach  of any of the
covenants  contained  in this  Section 10 will cause  irreparable  injury to the
Bank, and the Bank has no adequate  remedy at law in respect of such breach and,
as a consequence,  agree that each and every covenant  contained in this Section
10 shall be  specifically  enforceable  against the  Borrower,  and the Borrower
hereby  waives  and  agrees  not to assert  any  defenses  against an action for
specific  performance  of such  covenants  except for a defense that no Event of
Default has occurred and is continuing under the Loan Agreement.

     11. Further Assurances.  At any time and from time to time upon the written
request of the Bank,  the  Borrower  shall  execute  and  deliver  such  further
documents and do such further acts and things as the Bank may reasonably request
in order to effect the purposes of this Agreement.

     12.  Severability.  Any provision of this Agreement  which is prohibited or
unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to such jurisdiction, be ineffective
to the extent of such prohibition or unenforceability  without  invalidating the
remaining provisions hereof, and any such prohibition or unenforceability in any
jurisdiction shall not invalidate or render  unenforceable such provision in any
other jurisdiction.



                                      -4-
<PAGE>

     13. No Waiver;  Cumulative Remedies.  The Bank shall not by any act, delay,
omission  or  otherwise  be deemed to have  waived any of its rights or remedies
hereunder,  and no  waiver  shall be valid  unless  executed  and  delivered  in
accordance with the provisions of Section 15 hereof, and then only to the extent
therein set forth. A waiver by the Bank of any right or remedy  hereunder on any
one  occasion  shall not be  construed as a bar to any right or remedy which the
Bank would otherwise have on any future occasion. No failure to exercise nor any
delay in  exercising  on the part of the Bank,  any  right,  power or  privilege
hereunder,  shall operate as a waiver  thereof;  nor shall any single or partial
exercise  of any  right,  power or  privilege  hereunder  preclude  any other or
further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power or privilege.
The rights and  remedies  herein  provided are  cumulative  and may be exercised
singly or concurrently, and are not exclusive of any rights or remedies provided
by law.

     14.  Notices.  All  notices,  demands,  requests  and other  communications
provided for or permitted  under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be
delivered to the parties hereto by certified  mail,  return  receipt  requested,
overnight courier or hand delivery to the addresses set forth above and shall be
deemed effective upon receipt.

     15. Waivers, Amendments; Successors and Assigns; Governing Law. None of the
terms  or  provisions  of  this  Agreement  may be  waived,  altered,  modified,
terminated or amended  except by an instrument in writing,  duly executed by the
Bank.  This  Agreement and all  obligations of the Borrower  hereunder  shall be
binding upon the Borrower and its successors and assigns, and shall inure to the
benefit of the Bank and its  successors  and assigns.  This  Agreement  shall be
governed by, and be construed and  interpreted  in accordance  with, the laws of
the State of New Jersey.

     IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the  Borrower  has caused this  Agreement  to be duly
executed and delivered on the day and year first above written.


                                          KAYE GROUP INC.


                                          By:
                                               ----------------------------
                                               Michael P. Sabanos
                                               Senior Vice President
                                               & Chief Financial Officer




                                      -5-
<PAGE>



                                    EXHIBIT A

                                 PLEDGED STOCK:

                                     Type and No.               Certificate
          Company                     of Shares                     No.
          -------                     ---------                     ---

          OLRI                100,000 Shares Class A Preferred       13

          OLRI                200,000 Shares Common                  12

          OLB                 100,000 Shares Common                  69

          CAC                 100 Shares Common                       4


                                      A-1
<PAGE>


                                    TERM NOTE


$5,000,000                                                         June 24, 1998


     FOR  VALUE  RECEIVED,   the  undersigned,   KAYE  GROUP  INC.,  a  Delaware
corporation  (the  "Borrower"),  hereby  unconditionally  promises  to pay on or
before June 24,  2002 (the "Term Loan  Maturity  Date"),  to the order of SUMMIT
BANK,  a banking  institution  of the State of New Jersey (the  "Bank"),  at the
office of the Bank located at 250 Moore Street,  Hackensack,  New Jersey,  or at
such other location as the Bank shall  designate,  in lawful money of the United
States of America and in immediately  available  funds,  the principal amount of
$5,000,000.  This Note is being  executed  and  delivered by the Borrower to the
Bank  pursuant to Section  2.16 of that certain  Loan  Agreement  dated the date
hereof between the Borrower and the Bank (the "Agreement"). Terms defined in the
Agreement shall have the same meanings when used herein.

     The Borrower further agrees to pay interest in like money at such office on
the  unpaid  principal  amount  hereof  from time to time at a rate or rates per
annum as provided in the Agreement.

     The  principal  of and interest on this Note shall be payable at the times,
and in the manner, provided in the Agreement.

     The Borrower  shall pay to the Bank a late charge (the "Late Charge") in an
amount  equal to five  percent  (5%) of any payment  which is more than ten (10)
days in arrears  to cover the extra  expense  involved  in  handling  delinquent
payments,  but in no event  shall any Late  Charge be less than $25 or more than
$2,500. The term "payments" shall be construed to include  principal,  interest,
fees and any other  amount  due under the terms of this Note or any of the other
Loan  Documents.  Acceptance by the Bank of payment of a Late Charge shall in no
way be  construed  to be an election of remedies or waiver by the Bank of any of
its rights at law or under the terms of any of the Loan Documents.

     Subject to the provisions of Section 2.25 of the  Agreement,  this Note may
be  prepaid,  in  whole or in part,  at one time or from  time to time,  without
premium or penalty in accordance with the provisions of the Agreement.

     This Note is secured by the  Collateral  described  in the  Agreement,  the
Pledge and Security Agreement and the other Loan Documents, and is guaranteed by
the Guarantors pursuant to the Guaranty Agreement.

     The Bank may declare this Note to be immediately  due and payable if any of
the following events shall have occurred and be continuing:

     (1) Failure by the  Borrower to make any payment of  principal  or interest
under this Note on any date when due; or

     (2) An Event of Default shall have  occurred  under the Agreement or any of
the other Loan Documents.

     Upon the  occurrence of any Event of Default,  the Bank may, in addition to
such other and  further  rights and  remedies as provided by law or under any of
the Loan Documents, (i) collect


<PAGE>

interest on such overdue  amount from the date of such maturity  until paid at a
rate per annum  equal to three (3%)  percent  in excess of the Base  Rate,  (ii)
setoff such amount  against any deposit  account  maintained  in the Bank by the
Borrower,  and such  right of setoff  shall be  deemed  to have  been  exercised
immediately upon such stated or accelerated  maturity even though such setoff is
not  noted on the  records  of the Bank  until a later  time and  (iii)  hold as
security  any  property  heretofore  or  hereafter  delivered  into the custody,
control or  possession of the Bank or any entity acting as agent for the Bank by
any person liable for the payment of this Note.

     This Note may not be changed  orally,  but only by an agreement in writing,
signed by the party against whom enforcement of any waiver, change, modification
or discharge is sought.

     Should  the  indebtedness  represented  by this Note or any part  hereof be
collected  at law or in equity,  or in  bankruptcy,  receivership,  or any other
court  proceeding,  or should this Note be placed in the hands of attorneys  for
collection  upon  default,  the  Borrower  agrees  to pay,  in  addition  to the
principal  and  interest  due  and  payable  hereon,  all  reasonable  costs  of
collecting or attempting to collect this Note, including  reasonable  attorneys'
fees and expenses.

     This Note  shall be and  remain  in full  force  and  effect  and in no way
impaired  until the  actual  payment  thereof  to the Bank,  its  successors  or
assigns.

     Anything  herein to the contrary  notwithstanding,  the  obligations of the
Borrower  under this Note shall be subject to the  limitation  that  payments of
interest shall not be required to the extent that receipt of any such payment by
the Bank would be contrary to provisions of law  applicable to the Bank limiting
the maximum rate of interest which may be charged or collected by the Bank.

     The Borrower and all  endorsers  and  guarantors  of this Note hereby waive
presentment, demand for payment, protest and notice of dishonor of this Note.

     This Note is binding upon the Borrower and its  successors  and assigns and
shall inure to the benefit of the Bank and its successors and assigns.

     This Note and the rights and  obligations  of the parties  hereto  shall be
subject to and governed by the laws of the State of New Jersey.

     IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the  undersigned has caused this Term Note to be duly
executed by its authorized officers as of the day and year above written.


                                      KAYE GROUP INC.


                                      By:  /s/ Michael P. Sabanos
                                           ------------------------------
                                           Michael P. Sabanos
                                           Senior Vice President
                                           & Chief Financial Officer




                                      -2-
<PAGE>
                                 REVOLVING NOTE


$4,500,000                                                         June 24, 1998


     FOR  VALUE  RECEIVED,   the  undersigned,   KAYE  GROUP  INC.,  a  Delaware
corporation  (the  "Borrower"),  hereby  unconditionally  promises  to pay on or
before July 31, 1999 (the "Revolving Loan  Termination  Date"),  to the order of
SUMMIT BANK, a banking  institution of the State of New Jersey (the "Bank"),  at
the office of the Bank located at 250 Moore Street,  Hackensack,  New Jersey, or
at such other  location  as the Bank  shall  designate,  in lawful  money of the
United  States of America and in  immediately  available  funds,  the  principal
amount of the  lesser of (i)  $4,500,000  or (ii) so much  thereof as shall have
been  advanced  (the  "Advances")  by the Bank to the Borrower  pursuant to that
certain Loan  Agreement  dated the date hereof between the Borrower and the Bank
(the  "Agreement").  Terms defined in the Agreement shall have the same meanings
when used herein.

     The Borrower further agrees to pay interest in like money at such office on
the  unpaid  principal  amount  hereof  from time to time at a rate or rates per
annum and at such times as are provided in the Agreement.

     The Borrower  shall pay to the Bank a late charge (the "Late Charge") in an
amount  equal to five  percent  (5%) of any payment  which is more than ten (10)
days in arrears  to cover the extra  expense  involved  in  handling  delinquent
payments,  but in no event  shall any Late  Charge be less than $25 or more than
$2,500. The term "payments" shall be construed to include  principal,  interest,
fees and any other  amount  due under the terms of this Note or any of the other
Loan  Documents.  Acceptance by the Bank of payment of a Late Charge shall in no
way be  construed  to be an election of remedies or waiver by the Bank of any of
its rights at law or under the terms of any of the Loan Documents.

     Subject to the provisions of Section 2.25 of the  Agreement,  this Note may
be  prepaid,  in  whole or in part,  at one time or from  time to time,  without
premium or penalty in accordance with the provisions of the Agreement.

     All payments made hereunder  shall be applied:  first, to any fees or other
charges owing to the Bank hereunder; second, to accrued and unpaid interest; and
third,  to  the  outstanding  principal  balance  hereof.   Notwithstanding  the
foregoing,  upon  the  occurrence  of an Event of  Default,  the Bank may  apply
payments received hereunder in such manner as it shall determine in its sole and
absolute discretion.

     This Note is secured by the  Collateral  described  in the  Agreement,  the
Pledge and Security Agreement and the other Loan Documents, and is guaranteed by
the Guarantors pursuant to the Guaranty Agreement.

     The Bank may declare this Note to be immediately  due and payable if any of
the following events shall have occurred and be continuing:

     (1) Failure by the  Borrower to make any payment of  principal  or interest
under this Note on any date when due; or



<PAGE>

     (2) An Event of Default shall have  occurred  under the Agreement or any of
the other Loan Documents.

     Upon the  occurrence of any Event of Default,  the Bank may, in addition to
such other and  further  rights and  remedies  as  provided  by law or under the
Agreement  or any of the other Loan  Documents,  (i)  collect  interest  on such
overdue  amount  from the date of such  maturity  until paid at a rate per annum
equal to three (3%) percent in excess of the Base Rate,  (ii) setoff such amount
against any deposit  account  maintained in the Bank by the  Borrower,  and such
right of setoff  shall be deemed to have been  exercised  immediately  upon such
stated or  accelerated  maturity  even  though  such  setoff is not noted on the
records of the Bank until a later time and (iii) hold as security  any  property
heretofore or hereafter delivered into the custody, control or possession of the
Bank or any  entity  acting as agent for the Bank by any  person  liable for the
payment of this Note.

     This Note may not be changed  orally,  but only by an agreement in writing,
signed by the party against whom enforcement of any waiver, change, modification
or discharge is sought.

     Should  the  indebtedness  represented  by this Note or any part  hereof be
collected  at law or in equity,  or in  bankruptcy,  receivership,  or any other
court  proceeding,  or should this Note be placed in the hands of attorneys  for
collection  upon  default,  the  Borrower  agrees  to pay,  in  addition  to the
principal  and  interest  due  and  payable  hereon,  all  reasonable  costs  of
collecting or attempting to collect this Note, including  reasonable  attorneys'
fees and expenses.

     This Note  shall be and  remain  in full  force  and  effect  and in no way
impaired  until the  actual  payment  thereof to the Bank or its  successors  or
assigns.

     Anything  herein to the contrary  notwithstanding,  the  obligations of the
Borrower  under this Note shall be subject to the  limitation  that  payments of
interest shall not be required to the extent that receipt of any such payment by
the Bank would be contrary to provisions of law  applicable to the Bank limiting
the maximum rate of interest which may be charged or collected by the Bank.

     The Borrower and all  endorsers  and  guarantors  of this Note hereby waive
presentment, demand for payment, protest and notice of dishonor of this Note.

     This Note is binding upon the Borrower and its  successors  and assigns and
shall inure to the benefit of the Bank and its successors and assigns.

     This Note and the rights and  obligations  of the parties  hereto  shall be
subject to and governed by the laws of the State of New Jersey.

     IN WITNESS  WHEREOF,  the  undersigned has caused this Revolving Note to be
duly executed by its authorized officers as of the day and year above written.

                                          KAYE GROUP INC.


                                          By:  /s/ Michael P. Sabanos
                                               -----------------------------
                                               Michael P. Sabanos
                                               Senior Vice President
                                               & Chief Financial Officer



                                      -2-




                        AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

     AMENDMENT dated as of March 18, 1998, by and between Kaye Group Inc., a
Delaware corporation ("Employer"), and Michael P. Sabanos ("Employee").

     WHEREAS, Employer and Employee entered into an Employment Agreement
("Agreement"), made effective May 15, 1996, which is incorporated herein in its
entirety; and

     WHEREAS, Employer and Employee desire to effect certain amendments to the
Agreement, all as more fully set forth herein;

     NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual promises and covenants
hereinafter set forth and for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and
sufficiency of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereby agree as
follows:

1. Defined Terms. Capitalized terms not otherwise defined herein shall have the
meaning ascribed to them in the Agreement.

2. Section 3.1.1 of the Agreement is hereby amended in its entirety and replaced
with the following:

          _______An annual salary of $250,000, payable bi-weekly or at such
     other interval as Employer may establish for its usual payroll payment and
     subject to required withholding of taxes, social security, benefit
     payments, etc.

3. Section 4.1 and 4.2 of the Agreement are hereby amended in their entirety and
replaced with the following:

          Employer and Employee acknowledge that Employee is an "employee at
     will." The employment of Employee hereunder and the Term of this Agreement
     (the "Term") shall commence on June 1, 1998, and shall continue thereafter
     unless and until notice of termination is given in writing by either party
     at least sixty (60) days prior to the termination date.

4. Section 5.5 of the Agreement is hereby amended in its entirety and replaced
with the following:

          Restrictive Covenant

     In the event that Employee ceases to be an employee of Employer for any
     reason ("Withdrawal from the Company"), Employee may conduct business in
     competition with Employer. However, for the two year period immediately
     following the Withdrawal from the Company, Employee may not:

          (i) solicit, join, provide services to, advise, give assistance to, or
          contact any person or entity who


2


<PAGE>


          was a client of Employer, or any employee of such client, with respect
          to the provision of insurance or insurance-related services;

          (ii) solicit any persons or entities who, to the knowledge of
          Employee, are or were identified through leads developed while
          Employee was employed by Employer;

          (iii) solicit professional relationships introduced to such Employee
          by any employee or client of Employer while Employee was an employee
          of Employer;

          (iv) offer employment to or employ any person who is then, or had been
          within 6 months of such offer, an employee of Employer; or

          (v) solicit any employee of Employer to terminate his or her
          employment.

Employee acknowledges that a material part of his/her current and future
compensation, including salary increases and/or bonuses, is being paid in
consideration for Employee's promises to honor the restrictive covenants and
confidentiality aspects of this Employment Agreement. The Employee agrees that
the restrictive covenants and confidentiality provisions set forth in this
Employment Agreement are both reasonable and necessary to protect the vital
interests of Employer and to promote an open and productive working relationship
between Employer and Employee, from which Employee will benefit.

4. Section 6.11 of the Agreement is hereby amended to add the following
sentence.

Employee acknowledges that, in connection with this Agreement, Employee has been
advised to seek the advise of counsel and is now so advised.

5. Section 7a.i.(B) of the Agreement is hereby amended as follows:

     The words "12 months" shall replace the words "18 months" in both places in
     which such words appear.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this Amendment as of the date
above written.

MICHAEL P. SABANOS                  KAYE  GROUP INC.


______________________________      By:___________________________________
                                        Bruce D. Guthart, President & CEO


3




- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------






                           ASSET PURCHASE AGREEMENT

                                    among

                       KAYE INSURANCE ASSOCIATES, INC.
                                 as the Buyer

                                     and

         SEAMAN, ROSS & WIENER, INC., AMSCO COVERAGE CORP. and D.S.I.
                               ASSOCIATES, INC.

                                as the Sellers

                                     and

                     Douglas Schenendorf and Alex Seaman
                              as Shareholders of
                                 the Sellers



                         Dated as of January 1, 1999





- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------


<PAGE>


                          TABLE OF CONTENTS (Cont'd.)

                              TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                           PAGE

1.    Sale and Purchase of Assets............................................1
            1.1   Sale and Purchase..........................................1
            1.2   Excluded Assets............................................3
            1.3   Consents...................................................4

2.    Non-Assumption of Any Liabilities......................................4
            2.1   Non-Assumption.............................................4

3.    Purchase Price, Payment, Etc...........................................6
            3.1   Purchase Price.............................................6
            3.2   Payment of Purchase Price and 
                    Payment of Interest Installments.........................6
            3.3   Effect of Termination of Employment........................8
            3.4   Transfer Taxes.............................................8
            3.5   Allocation of Purchase Price...............................9

4.    Time and Place of Closing; Effective Date..............................9

5.    Representations and Warranties of the Sellers and the Shareholders.....9
            5.1   Organization..............................................10
            5.2   Capitalization............................................10
            5.3   Authorization; Validity of Agreement......................10
            5.4   No Violations; Consents and Approvals.....................11
            5.5   Financial Statements......................................11
            5.6   No Material Adverse Change................................12
            5.7   No Undisclosed Liabilities................................12
            5.8   Litigation; Compliance with Law; Licenses and Permits.....12
            5.9   [Intentionally Omitted.]..................................13
            5.10  Real Property. ...........................................13
            5.11  Accounts, Intellectual Property; Computer Software........14
            5.12  Title to Acquired Assets.  ...............................15
            5.13  Material Contracts........................................15
            5.14  Taxes.....................................................16
            5.15  Affiliated Party Transactions.............................18
            5.16  [Intentionally Omitted.]..................................18
            5.17  [Intentionally Omitted.]..................................18
            5.18  Receivables...............................................18
            5.19  Assets Utilized in the Business...........................18
            5.20  Insurance.................................................18
            5.21  [Intentionally Omitted.]..................................19
            5.22  Commissions...............................................19


                                     -i-

<PAGE>


                          TABLE OF CONTENTS (Cont'd.)

                                                                           PAGE


            5.23  [Intentionally Omitted.]..................................19
            5.24  [Intentionally Omitted.]..................................19
            5.25  Directors, Officers and Certain Employees.................19
            5.26  Year 2000.................................................19
            5.27  No Misstatements or Omissions.............................20
            5.28  Investment Undertaking....................................20
            5.29  Absence of Sensitive Payments.............................20
            5.30  [Intentionally Omitted.]..................................20

6.    Representations and Warranties of the Buyer...........................20
            6.1   Organization..............................................21
            6.2   Authorization; Validity of Agreement......................21
            6.3   No Violations; Consents and Approvals.....................21
            6.4   Shares of Capital Stock...................................22

7.    Other Agreements of the Parties.......................................22
            7.1   Tax Returns; Taxes........................................22
            7.2   Tax Indemnity.............................................23
            7.3   Public Statements.........................................23
            7.4   Other Actions.............................................23
            7.5   Cooperation on Taxes......................................23
            7.6   Employees.................................................23
            7.7   Consents; Releases........................................25
            7.8   [Intentionally Omitted.]..................................25
            7.9   Exclusivity...............................................25
            7.10  Prior Acts Insurance......................................25
            7.11  Equipment, Intellectual Property and Other Assets.  ......25
            7.12  Non-Solicitation.  .......................................26
            7.13  Post Closing Adjustment...................................27
            7.14  Refund of Security Deposit................................27

8.    Conditions Precedent to the Closing...................................27
            8.1   Conditions Precedent to the Buyer's Obligations to Close..27
            8.2   Conditions Precedent to the Sellers' Obligations to Close.29

9.    [Intentionally Omitted]...............................................31

10.   Survival of Representations and Warranties, Rights and 
        Obligations Subsequent to Closing...................................31

                                     -ii-

<PAGE>


                          TABLE OF CONTENTS (Cont'd.)

                                                                           PAGE

            10.1  Survival of Representations and Warranties 
                  of the Sellers and the Shareholders.......................31
            10.2  Survival of Representations and Warranties of the Buyer...32
            10.3  Collection of Assets......................................32
            10.4  Payment of Debts..........................................32
            10.5  Collection of Accounts Receivable.........................32
            10.6  Letters to Customers......................................33

11.   Indemnification.......................................................33
            11.1  Indemnification by the Sellers and the Shareholders.......33
            11.2  Indemnification by the Buyer..............................34
            11.3  Indemnification Procedures................................34

12.   Miscellaneous.........................................................36
            12.1  Transaction Fees and Expenses.............................36
            12.2  Notices...................................................36
            12.3  Amendment.................................................37
            12.4  Waiver....................................................37
            12.5  Governing Law.............................................37
            12.6  Jurisdiction..............................................37
            12.7  Remedies..................................................38
            12.8  Severability..............................................38
            12.9  Further Assurances........................................38
            12.10 Assignment................................................38
            12.11 Binding Effect............................................38
            12.12 No Third Party Beneficiaries..............................38
            12.13 Entire Agreement..........................................38
            12.14 Presumptions..............................................39
            12.15 Headings..................................................39
            12.16 Counterparts..............................................39

SIGNATURES..................................................................43

                                    -iii-

<PAGE>



                                   Schedules
                                   ---------

Schedule 1.2(d)         Office Furniture
Schedule 2.1            Assumed Liabilities
Schedule 3.1            Purchase Price Percentages
Schedule 3.5            Allocation
Schedule 5.1(a)         Foreign Qualification
Schedule 5.1(b)         Foreign Qualification for Insurance Brokerage
Schedule 5.2            Capitalization
Schedule 5.4(b)         Governmental Consents and Approvals
Schedule 5.4(c)         Non-Governmental Consents and Approvals
Schedule 5.5            Financial Statements
Schedule 5.6            Material Adverse Changes
Schedule 5.7(b)         Undisclosed Liabilities
Schedule 5.8(a)         Litigation
Schedule 5.8(c)         Licenses and Permits
Schedule 5.10(b)        Leases
Schedule 5.11(a)        Accounts
Schedule 5.11(b)        Intellectual Property; Rights of Ownership
Schedule 5.12(a)        Liens
Schedule 5.12(b)        Fixed Assets Ledger
Schedule 5.13(a)        Material Contracts
Schedule 5.13(b)        Defaults or Events of Default
Schedule 5.13(c)        Contracts of More than $10,000 Per Year
Schedule 5.14(a)        Subchapter S elections
Schedule 5.14(b)        Taxes
Schedule 5.18           Assets Utilized in the Business
Schedule 5.20           Insurance Policies
Schedule 5.22           Commissions
Schedule 5.25           Directors, Officers, Certain Employees
Schedule 7.6(a)         Employees


                                     -iv-

<PAGE>



                                   Exhibits
                                   --------


Exhibit 8.1(h)          Form of Bill of Sale
Exhibit 8.1(i)(A)       Form of AS Employment Agreement
Exhibit 8.1(i)(B)       Form of DS Employment Agreement
Exhibit 8.1(i)(C)       Form of Employment Agreements of MaryJeanne Egleston and
                        Christopher Brady
Exhibit  8.1(j)         Form of Letter to the  Customers of each of the 
                          Sellers  Exhibit
8.1(k)                  Form of Lease Assignment






                                     -v-

<PAGE>


                            ASSET PURCHASE AGREEMENT

                           Dated as of January 1, 1999

     The parties to this Asset Purchase Agreement (this "Agreement") are Kaye
Insurance Associates, Inc., a Delaware corporation, (the "Buyer"), Seaman, Ross
& Wiener, Inc., a New York corporation ("SRW"), AMSCO Coverage Corp., a New York
corporation ("AMSCO"), D.S.I. Associates, Inc., a New York corporation
("D.S.I.") (SRW, AMSCO and D.S.I. are referred to herein collectively as the
"Sellers"), Douglas Schenendorf ("DS") and Alex Seaman ("AS") (DS and AS are
referred to herein collectively as the "Shareholders").

                                    RECITALS

     A. The Sellers are in the business of insurance brokerage, insurance claims
adjusting and processing and related services (collectively, the "Business").

     B. The Buyer desires to purchase from the Sellers, and the Sellers desire
to sell to the Buyer, all of the Sellers' assets and properties relating to the
Business in consideration for the payment of cash and common stock on the terms
and subject to the conditions set forth herein.

                                    AGREEMENT

     It is agreed as follows:


1.   Sale and Purchase of Assets.

     1.1 Sale and Purchase. Upon the terms and subject to the conditions
contained in this Agreement, at the Closing (as defined in Section 4), each of
the Sellers shall sell, assign, transfer and deliver to the Buyer, and the Buyer
shall purchase and accept from each of the Sellers, all of the assets and rights
of every nature, kind and description, tangible and intangible, wherever
located, that are owned, used or held for use by each of the Sellers in or for
the Business, as the same shall exist on the Closing Date (as defined in Section
4) (collectively, the "Acquired Assets"), free and clear of any and all liens,
charges, claims, pledges, security interests or other encumbrances ("Liens")
including, without limitation, the following:

          (a) vehicles, computers and other data processing hardware (and all
     software related thereto or used therewith) and other tangible personal
     property of similar nature, including but not limited to all items set
     forth on Schedule 5.12(b) (collectively, the "Machinery and Equipment") and
     office furniture, office equipment, fixtures and other tangible personal
     property of similar nature (collectively, the "Furniture and Fixtures");

          (b) interests to the extent owned by any of the Sellers in any patent,
     copyright, trademark, trade name, brand name, service mark, service name,
     assumed name, logo, symbol, trade dress, design or representation or
     expression of any thereof, or registration or application


<PAGE>



     for registration thereof, or any other invention, trade secret, market
     study, process required for or incident to the Business, business
     opportunity, technical information, know-how, processes, proprietary right
     or intellectual property, technologies, methods, designs, drawings,
     software (including documentation and source code listings), processes and
     other confidential or proprietary properties or information (collectively,
     the "Intellectual Property");

          (c) real property interests described in Schedule 5.10(b) to this
     Agreement together with all buildings, facilities and other improvements
     thereon and all licenses, leases, security deposits, rights, privileges and
     appurtenances thereto including, without limitation, all leases, agreements
     and other rights to use, occupy or possess, or otherwise with respect to,
     real property or machinery, equipment, vehicles, and other tangible
     personal property of similar nature to which the Sellers are a party, and
     all rights arising under or pursuant to such leases, agreements and rights;

          (d) all accounts and customer and client lists which are held, owned
     or standing in the name of any of the Sellers or either of the Shareholders
     or any director, officer, employee, agent, or any entity in which DS and/or
     AS is a significant owner (holds more than 5% of the outstanding capital)
     or any entity through which DS and/or AS engage in the Business,
     irrespective of the legal title to any such property (the "Accounts");

          (e) all expirations, renewal rights, claims and commissions which are
     held, owned or standing in the name of any of the Sellers or either of the
     Shareholders or any director, officer, employee, agent, or any entity in
     which DS and/or AS is a significant owner (holds more than 5% of the
     outstanding capital) or any entity through which DS and/or AS engage in the
     Business, irrespective of the legal title to any such property.

          (f) subject to Section 1.3, any contracts, agreements, options,
     commitments, understandings, covenants, licenses, leases, and other
     instruments (collectively, the "Contracts") pertaining to the Business
     (including the Material Contracts as listed on Schedule 5.13); and in the
     case of any of the foregoing, which are held, owned or standing in the name
     of any of the Sellers or either of the Shareholders or any director,
     officer, employee, agent, or any entity in which DS and/or AS is a
     significant owner (holds more than 5% of the outstanding capital) or any
     entity through which DS and/or AS engage in the Business, irrespective of
     the legal title to any such property;

          (g) the sole right to collect from customers on or after the Effective
     Date and to retain all insurance commissions (including gross retained
     commissions realized from premiums collected), and all service fees due to
     any of the Sellers for any services rendered in connection with the
     operation of the Business on or after the Effective Date (as defined in
     Section 4), and all other commissions, fees or other compensation paid or
     payable to any of the Sellers earned on or after the Effective Date;


                                       -2-

<PAGE>



          (h) the sole right to collect from insurance companies and retain (A)
     those commissions overrides and persistency bonuses and other referral fees
     (including public adjuster fees) selected and assigned by the Sellers to
     the Buyer which have been received by or on behalf of any of the Sellers or
     the Buyer on or after the Effective Date from insurance underwriters in
     connection with contracts or other arrangements earned in 1998 and paid on
     or after the Effective Date to the Sellers, which commissions, overrides,
     bonuses and other fees shall be selected and assigned by the Sellers to the
     Buyer, and (B) all return premiums or other payments (return or otherwise)
     due to any of the Sellers from insurance companies on or after the
     Effective Date (but not on transactions occurring or items billed prior to
     the Effective Date);

          (i) other books, records, files, contracts, plans, notebooks,
     brochures and handbooks, production and sales data catalogs, and other data
     of any of the Sellers relating to the Business, whether or not in tangible
     form or in the form of intangible computer storage media such as optical
     disks, magnetic disks, tapes and all similar storage media;

          (j) the names "Seaman, Ross & Wiener, Inc.", "AMSCO Coverage Corp.",
     and "D.S.I. Associates, Inc." and all variations thereof and all similar
     names and the goodwill associated therewith, together with all trademarks,
     service marks and trade names of any of the Sellers related to the
     Business, if any;

          (k) rights related to any portion of the Business or the Acquired
     Assets, including third party warranties and guarantees and other similar
     contractual rights, as to third parties held by or in favor of any of the
     Sellers or the Shareholders, and arising out of, resulting from or relating
     to the Business or the Acquired Assets;

          (l) rights to insurance and condemnation proceeds relating to any
     damage, destruction, taking or other similar impairment of any of the
     Acquired Assets; and

          (m) all goodwill associated with any of the foregoing.

     1.2 Excluded Assets. The only assets of the Sellers that the Buyer is not
acquiring hereby (the "Excluded Assets") are:

          (a) the consideration to be delivered to the Sellers pursuant to this
     Agreement for the Acquired Assets to be sold to the Buyer hereunder and the
     rights of any of the Sellers hereunder;

          (b) the certificate of incorporation, corporate seals, minute books,
     stock books, Tax Returns (as defined in Section 5.14(d)) and supporting
     data prepared expressly in connection therewith, and other records prepared
     directly in connection with the corporate organization and capitalization
     of each of the Sellers and/or its operation as a corporation under
     applicable Laws (as defined in Section 5.8(b)); and


                                       -3-

<PAGE>



          (c) cash, cash equivalents and prepaid expenses;

          (d) the office furniture and artwork described in Schedule 1.2(d)
     hereof;

          (e) shares of the capital stock of each of the Sellers; and

          (f) the sole right to collect from customers on or after the Effective
     Date and to retain all of the Sellers' accounts receivable that existed as
     of December 31, 1998.

     1.3 Consents. To the extent that the assignment of any Contract shall
require the Consent (as defined in Section 5.4(b)) of the other parties thereto
or of any third parties, this Agreement shall not constitute an agreement to
assign the same if an attempted assignment would constitute a breach thereof or
of other obligations or commitments of any of the Sellers. Each of the Sellers
shall take any and all action necessary to obtain all such Consents prior to the
Closing Date. If any such Consent is not obtained, and the Buyer waives the
obtaining of such Consent as a condition precedent hereunder, then each of the
Sellers shall continue such efforts after the Closing Date and until such
Consent is obtained and shall cooperate with the Buyer in any arrangement
requested by the Buyer intended to provide for the Buyer all of each of the
benefits of the Sellers under such Contract.

2.   Non-Assumption of Any Liabilities.

     2.1 Non-Assumption. Upon the sale and purchase of the Acquired Assets, the
Buyer shall not assume nor agree to pay or discharge when due any debt,
obligation, responsibility, claim or liability of any of the Sellers, whether
known or unknown, contingent or absolute or otherwise except those set forth in
Schedule 2.1 hereof. The Buyer shall not be assuming, and the Sellers shall
remain responsible for and shall promptly pay, perform and discharge, all of
their respective liabilities and obligations such that the Buyer will incur no
liability in connection therewith, and each of the Sellers and the Shareholders
shall indemnify the Buyer with respect to and shall hold the Buyer harmless from
and against all such liabilities and obligations, including but not limited to
the following:

          (a) any obligation or liability of any of the Sellers arising from a
     breach of a representation or warranty herein on its part or its failure to
     fully, faithfully and promptly perform any agreement or covenant on its
     part contained herein;

          (b) any obligation or liability related to any present or former
     officer, director, shareholder, employee or agent of any of the Sellers or
     any person or organization controlled by, controlling, or under common
     control with any of them;

          (c) all other liabilities, obligations, contracts and commitments
     arising out of the ownership and operation of the business of each of the
     Sellers prior to the Effective Date, including without limitation, any
     liability for errors and omissions whether asserted before, on or

                                     -4-

<PAGE>



     after the Effective Date which arises out of the operation of the business
     of any of the Sellers prior to the Effective Date (in connection with such
     liability, each of the Sellers and both of the Shareholders acknowledge
     that they have been advised by Buyer to maintain its own insurance
     coverages with respect thereto);

          (d) all liabilities incurred by any of the Sellers or either of the
     Shareholders of any kind whatsoever before, on or after the Effective Date
     (except to the extent that such liabilities were incurred in furtherance of
     the Shareholder's duties as an employee of the Buyer);

          (e) any obligation or liability of any of the Sellers to the extent
     the same arose prior to the Closing Date out of or resulting from
     noncompliance with any federal, state or local Laws, whether relating to
     the environment, the health and safety standards applicable to employees,
     employee benefit plans, wage and hour Laws or other labor related matters
     or otherwise;

          (f) any obligation or liability of any of the Sellers to the extent
     that the Sellers shall be indemnified by an insurer;

          (g) any expenses of any of the Sellers incurred in connection with the
     transactions contemplated hereunder (including but not limited to fees and
     expenses of finders, investment bankers, business brokers, attorneys and
     accountants), it being understood that all such expenses shall be paid by
     the Sellers out of the Excluded Assets or the consideration to be delivered
     to the Sellers pursuant to this Agreement, and not out of any of the
     Acquired Assets;

          (h) any obligations relating to an Excluded Asset;

          (i) any liability for Taxes (as hereinafter defined);

          (j) any indebtedness for borrowed money or any guaranty thereof;

          (k) any amount due to any Shareholder or Affiliate (as defined in
     Section 5.15);

          (l) any liability arising under, or with respect to, any pension,
     profit-sharing or workmen's compensation or other employee benefit or post
     retirement plan and any other employment-related liability or obligation
     existing on or prior to the Effective Date (including those liabilities
     triggered as a result of the transactions contemplated hereby);

          (m) any liability or obligation as a result of any injury to persons
     or property; and


                                       -5-

<PAGE>



          (n) all claims of employees arising out of events, conditions and
     circumstances existing or occurring on or prior to the Effective Date,
     including, but not limited to, medical and health claims and disability
     claims.

          (o) Intentionally omitted.

3.   Purchase Price, Payment, Etc.

     3.1 Purchase Price. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement,
in consideration of the sale, conveyance, assignment, transfer and delivery of
the Acquired Assets, the Buyer shall pay to the Sellers the following (the
"Purchase Price"):

          (a) (i) an aggregate of $2,136,224 (the "Closing Cash Purchase Price")
     shall be paid by delivery of bank or cashier's checks or by wire transfer
     of immediately available funds to the Sellers, in each case to an account
     or accounts designated in writing by the Sellers, and (ii) delivery to the
     Sellers of an aggregate number of shares of common stock, $.01 par value
     per share, of Kaye Group Inc. (the "Common Stock") equal to $500,000
     divided by the Market Value (as defined below) of the Common Stock computed
     as of the Effective Date (the "Closing Stock Purchase Price");

          (b) an aggregate amount of stock and cash, if any (the "Earn-Out
     Amount"), payable in accordance with Section 3.2(b); and

          (c) a sum equal to the interest due on the unpaid portion of the
     Purchase Price, payable in accordance with Section 3.2(c).

Each of the Sellers and the Buyer agree that the Purchase Price (including
without limitation, the Closing Cash Purchase Price and each Earn Out
Installment and each Interest Installment (as hereinafter defined)) shall be
payable to the Sellers in accordance with the percentages set forth on Schedule
3.1.

     3.2 Payment of Purchase Price and Payment of Interest Installments.

          (a) On the Closing Date, the Buyer shall deliver to the Sellers (i)
     the Closing Cash Purchase Price, and (ii) 69,686 shares of Common Stock
     allocated in accordance with Schedule 3.1.

          (b) The Buyer shall pay to the Sellers an amount equal to 81.49% of
     the Net Revenue (as defined below) earned during each of the 12 consecutive
     calendar quarters following the Effective Date (each payment shall be
     referred to as an "Earn Out Installment"). The first 11 Earn Out
     Installments shall be paid within 45 days after the end of the first 11
     consecutive calendar quarters following the Effective Date, and the 12th
     Earn Out Installment shall be paid within 120 days after the end of the
     12th calendar quarter following the Effective Date. (Each

                                       -6-

<PAGE>



     such date for payment shall be referred to as the "Due Date.") Up to the
     first $41,667 of each Earn Out Installment, if any, shall be paid in shares
     of Common Stock equal to the whole number quotient, excluding any
     fractional remainder, of $41,667 divided by the Market Value of the Common
     Stock computed as of the last business day of each calendar quarter. Buyer
     shall also deliver via wire transfer to the Sellers in an amount
     representing the difference, if any, between such Earn Out Installment and
     the portion of Earn Out Installment paid to the Sellers in Common Stock
     pursuant to the immediately preceding sentence. As used herein, "Net
     Revenue" shall mean gross cash receipts received by the Buyer during the
     immediately preceding` calendar quarter (including contingent commissions
     earned by the Sellers in 1998 but collected in 1999) and Life/Health
     overrides and persistency bonuses and other referral bonuses (such as
     public adjuster fees with respect to Accounts and New Business (as
     hereinafter defined)) from (i) Accounts (for sake of clarity, as they exist
     on the Effective Date) and (ii) other accounts produced by DS or AS after
     the Effective Date as well as new policies written by DS and AS after the
     Effective Date for new and existing Accounts (the "New Business") less: (i)
     the commission or fee portion of an amount which the Buyer is required to
     pay to an insured account, customer or client in connection with or as a
     part of a return premium; and (ii) any commission or fee which the Buyer is
     obligated to pay to an independent contractor, sub-broker, sub-agent or
     external producer. For purposes of the definition of Net Revenue: (i) any
     revenues from the Accounts or New Business received by Buyer within the 90
     day period following the third anniversary of the Effective Date shall be
     deemed to have been included in Net Revenue; and (ii) any revenues not
     collected by the Buyer within 90 days following the third anniversary of
     the Effective Date shall not be included in Net Revenue for purposes of
     calculating the final Earn Out Installment. For purposes of this Agreement,
     Market Value shall mean the last sales price for the Common Stock on the
     Nasdaq National Market averaged over a period of 20 consecutive trading
     days prior to the last business day of each calendar quarter, provided
     however, that if such determination results in Market Value being more than
     115% (the "Cap") or less than 85% (the "Floor") of the market value of the
     Common Stock on the Effective Date, then the Market Value shall be, in the
     case of an average exceeding the Cap, 115% of the Market Value determined
     as of the Effective Date, and, in the case of an average less than the
     Floor, 85% of the Market Value determined as of the Effective Date.

          For purposes of calculating the Earn Out Amount, the Buyer shall code
     to DS and AS (as they shall direct) all Accounts and New Business generated
     by DS, AS and the Sellers' employees and independent contractors disclosed
     in the Schedules annexed to this Agreement.

          The Buyer shall deliver a written schedule to the Sellers on or before
     each Due Date reflecting the calculation of the Earn Out Installment to be
     paid each quarter and the calculation of the Market Value of the Common
     Stock used for the Earn Out Installment paid on each Due Date.

          (c) In addition to each Earn Out Installment and each Due Date in
     connection therewith, the Buyer shall remit to the Sellers via wire
     transfer during the Earn Out Period the Interest Amount (as hereinafter
     defined) payable in twelve (12) quarterly installments (each, an

                                     -7-

<PAGE>



     "Interest Installment") on the Due Date corresponding thereto. The
     "Interest Amount" shall mean interest calculated at the "prime rate" as
     published by The Wall Street Journal (as of the last date of the calendar
     quarter immediately preceding the Due Date) for the period beginning on the
     immediately preceding Due Date to the Due Date corresponding to such Earn
     Out Installment and Interest Installment on the excess, if any, of the
     Adjusted Purchase Price (as hereinafter defined) less all payments made
     under Section 3.2(b) prior to such Due Date.

          For purposes of this Section 3.2(c), "Adjusted Purchase Price" shall
     mean, as of a Due Date, an amount equal to the sum of $10,136,000 as
     adjusted either upward or downward based on year-to-date actual Net
     Revenues as compared to comparable pro forma amounts for such period, as
     determined by the accountant of the Buyer (the "Buyer's Accountants").
     Except for the Earn Out Installments computed and paid during the first
     four consecutive quarters following the Effective Date, contingent
     commissions shall not be included in the comparable proforma amounts in any
     subsequent periods. The Buyer shall deliver a written schedule to the
     Sellers on or before each Due Date reflecting the calculation of the
     Interest Installment to be paid each quarter.

     3.3 Effect of Termination of Employment. The Buyer and each of the Sellers
and each of the Shareholders acknowledge the significance of the employment of
DS and AS in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement. In
connection therewith, it is a condition to the obligation of the Buyer to
consummate the transaction contemplated hereby that, among other things, each of
DS and AS sign and deliver to Buyer the employment agreements set forth as
Exhibits 8.1(i). If DS terminates his employment with the Buyer during the
three-year period following the Effective Date for any reason other than his
death or disability (as disability is defined in the Employment Agreement with
the Buyer to which he is a party), then the Buyer may require DS and D.S.I., at
the Buyer's option (which shall be given by written notice as provided in
Section 12.2 within 10 days after the voluntary termination of DS' employment),
to purchase back from the Buyer 70% of the Acquired Assets for the amount of the
consideration previously paid to D.S.I. pursuant to this Agreement. If AS
terminates his employment with the Buyer during the three-year period following
the Effective Date for any reason other than his death or disability (as
disability is defined in the Employment Agreement with the Buyer to which he is
a party), then the Buyer may require AS and AMSCO, at the Buyer's option (which
shall be given by written notice as provided in Section 12.2 within 10 days
after the voluntary termination of AS' employment), to purchase back from the
Buyer 30% of the Acquired Assets for the amount of the consideration previously
paid to AMSCO pursuant to this Agreement. Under no circumstances shall the
Sellers or the Shareholders be required to purchase back the Acquired Assets if
termination of employment occurs after the three-year period following the
Effective Date or if termination of employment is not due to the voluntary
election of either AS or DS.

     3.4 Transfer Taxes. All sales, use, transfer, excise and similar taxes
imposed by any state, county, local or other governmental entity or Taxing
Authority (as defined in Section 5.14(d)) as a result of the transfer of the
Acquired Assets hereunder and the other transactions



                                       -8-

<PAGE>



contemplated hereby shall be duly and timely paid by the Buyer. The Buyer shall
duly and timely file all Tax Returns in connection with such Taxes.

     3.5 Allocation of Purchase Price.

          (a) Schedule 3.5(a) reflects the agreed upon allocation of the
     Purchase Price in accordance with the relative fair market value of the
     Acquired Assets. The Buyer, each of the Sellers and each of the
     Shareholders shall be bound for such allocation for all purposes, including
     determining any Tax (as defined in Section 5.14(d)), shall prepare and file
     all Tax Returns (as defined in Section 5.14(d)), including Forms 8594, in a
     manner consistent with such allocations, and shall not take any position
     inconsistent with such allocations in any Tax Return, any proceeding before
     any Taxing Authority (as defined in Section 5.14(d)) or otherwise. In the
     event that any allocation is questioned, audited or disputed by any Taxing
     Authority, the party receiving notice thereof shall promptly notify and
     consult with the other party concerning the strategy for the resolution
     thereof, and shall keep the other party apprised of the status of such
     question, audit or dispute and the resolution thereof.

          (b) The Buyer and each of the Sellers shall duly and timely file their
     respective Forms 8594, and with respect to each payment pursuant to this
     Agreement, in accordance with this Section 3.5. Each party shall furnish a
     copy of each Form 8594 filed by it to the other party promptly after
     filing. For purposes of the preparation of Form 8594, the name and address
     of the Buyer and each of the Sellers, respectively, is as set forth in
     Section 12.2.

4.   Time and Place of Closing; Effective Date.

          (a) Notwithstanding the date and time of the Closing, the transactions
     contemplated herein shall be effective for all purposes as of January 1,
     1999 at 12:01 A.M. (the "Effective Date"). The closing of the purchase and
     sale provided for in this Agreement (the "Closing") shall be held at the
     offices of the Sellers at 10:00 a.m., on February 24, 1999 or at such other
     place, date or time as may be fixed by mutual agreement of the parties (the
     "Closing Date").

          (b) The execution and/or delivery of each document to be executed
     and/or delivered at the Closing and each other action to be taken at the
     Closing shall be subject to the condition that every other document to be
     executed and/or delivered at the Closing is so executed and/or delivered
     and every other action to be taken at the Closing is so taken, and all such
     documents and actions shall be deemed to be executed and/or delivered or
     taken, as the case may be, simultaneously.


                                       -9-

<PAGE>



5.   Representations and Warranties of the Sellers and the Shareholders.

     Each of the Sellers and each of the Shareholders jointly and severally
represent and warrant to the Buyer as follows:

     5.1 Organization. Each of the Sellers is a corporation duly organized,
validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the jurisdiction of its
incorporation and has all requisite corporate power and authority to own, lease
and operate its properties and to carry on its business as it is now being
conducted. Each of the Sellers is duly qualified or licensed to do business and
in good standing as a foreign corporation in each of the jurisdictions listed in
Schedule 5.1(a). Each of the Sellers is duly qualified or licensed to do
business and in good standing as a non-resident insurance broker in each of the
jurisdictions listed in Schedule 5.1(b). The jurisdictions listed on Schedule
5.1(b) are all of the jurisdictions in which the nature of the business
conducted by any of the Sellers makes such qualification or licensing necessary.
Each of the Sellers has delivered to the Buyer true, correct and complete copies
of their respective certificate of incorporation and bylaws, as currently in
effect.

     5.2 Capitalization. The Shareholders are the only shareholders of the
Sellers and collectively own all of the issued and outstanding capital stock of
the Sellers of record and beneficially free and clear of all Liens. All of the
capital stock of the Sellers is validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.
Except as set forth on Schedule 5.2, there are no (a) outstanding warrants,
options or other rights granted by any of the Sellers to purchase or acquire, or
preemptive rights with respect to the issuance or sale of, the capital stock of
each of the Sellers; (b) other securities of any of the Sellers directly or
indirectly convertible into or exchangeable for shares of capital stock of any
of the Sellers; or (c) restrictions on the transfer of any of the Sellers'
capital stock. None of the Sellers own any shares of capital stock (or other
equity interests of entities other than corporations) of any partnership, joint
venture, trust, corporation, limited liability company or other entity.

     5.3 Authorization; Validity of Agreement. Each of the Sellers and each of
the Shareholders have the requisite capacity and authority to execute, deliver
and perform this Agreement and each of the other agreements, instruments,
documents and certificates to be executed and delivered pursuant to this
Agreement, including but not limited to, any item referred to in Section 8
(collectively, with this Agreement, the "Transaction Documents") to which it is
a party and to assume and perform its obligations hereunder and thereunder, and
to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby. Each of this
Agreement and the other Transaction Documents has been duly executed, authorized
and delivered by each of the Sellers and each of the Shareholders party thereto
and is a valid and binding obligation of each of the Sellers and the
Shareholders, enforceable against each of the Sellers and each of the
Shareholders in accordance with their respective terms, except as such
enforceability may be subject to or limited by applicable bankruptcy,
insolvency, reorganization or other similar laws affecting the enforcement of
creditors' rights generally.


                                      -10-

<PAGE>



      5.4   No Violations; Consents and Approvals.

          (a) The execution, delivery and performance of each of this Agreement
     and the other Transaction Documents by each of the Sellers and each of the
     Shareholders parties thereto does not, and the consummation by each of the
     Sellers and each of the Shareholders of the transactions contemplated
     hereby and thereby will not, (i) violate any provision of the certificate
     of incorporation or bylaws of any of the Sellers, (ii) result in a
     violation or breach of, or constitute (with or without due notice or lapse
     of time or both) a default (or give rise to any right of termination,
     amendment, cancellation or acceleration) under any of the terms, conditions
     or provisions of any Contract to which either the Sellers or either
     Shareholder are a party or by which any of the properties or assets of the
     Sellers or either Shareholder may be bound or otherwise subject or (iii)
     violate any order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree, law, statute, rule
     or regulation applicable to the Sellers or either Shareholder or any of
     their respective properties or assets.

          (b) To the best of the Sellers' knowledge after due inquiry, no filing
     or registration with, notification to, or authorization, consent or
     approval of, any foreign, provincial, United States federal, state, county,
     municipal or other local jurisdiction, political entity, body,
     organization, subdivision or branch, legislative or executive agency or
     department or other regulatory service, authority or agency (a
     "Governmental Entity") is required in connection with the execution,
     delivery and performance of this Agreement or any of the other Transaction
     Documents to which any of the Sellers or either Shareholder is a party or
     the consummation by any of the Sellers or either Shareholder of the
     transactions contemplated hereby and thereby, except for such filings,
     registrations, notifications, authorizations, consents and approvals as are
     set forth on Schedule 5.4(b) hereof.

          (c) To the best of the Sellers' knowledge after due inquiry, no filing
     or consent, approval, order, authorization, notification to, notice to,
     estoppel certificate, registration, ratification, declaration, waiver,
     exemption or variance (collectively, together with the filings,
     registrations, notifications, authorizations, consents and approvals of
     Governmental Entities set forth in Section 5.4(b), "Consents") of any
     individual or entity (a "Person") is required in connection with the
     execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement or any of the other
     Transaction Documents to which any of the Sellers or either Shareholder is
     a party or the consummation by each of the Sellers or either Shareholder of
     the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby, except for such Consents
     as are set forth on Schedule 5.4(b) or (c) hereof.

     5.5 Financial Statements. Attached as Schedule 5.5 is a proforma cash basis
statement of assets and stockholders' equity as of December 31, 1998 (the "Base
Balance Sheet"), together with the related proforma statement of operations for
the annual periods ended December 31, 1997 and December 31, 1998 (all of the
foregoing, the "Financial Statements"). The Financial Statements have been
derived from, and agree with, the books and records of the Sellers, are true and
correct and fairly present the financial position of the Sellers as of December

                                      -11-

<PAGE>



31, 1998 and the proforma results of operations of the Sellers for the years
ended December 31, 1997 and December 31, 1998.

     5.6 No Material Adverse Change. Except as set forth on Schedule 5.6, since
December 31, 1998, (a) no event, condition or circumstance has occurred that has
had a material adverse effect on the Business or the Acquired Assets, or on the
condition (financial or otherwise), results of operations or prospects of any of
the Sellers or the Business; and (b) the Business has been conducted in the
ordinary course and consistent with past practice. As amplification and not in
limitation of the foregoing, since the date of the Base Balance Sheet, none of
the Sellers has (i) made any material change in any method of accounting or
accounting practice, principle or policy used by the Sellers, (ii) incurred any
material indebtedness, obligation or liability or paid, satisfied or discharged
any material indebtedness, obligation or liability prior to the due date or
maturity thereof, except current indebtedness, obligations and liabilities in
the ordinary course of business, or (iii) made any change or modification in any
manner of the Sellers' (A) billing and collection policies, procedures and
practices with respect to accounts receivable or unbilled charges, (B) policies,
procedures and practices with respect to the provision of discounts, rebates or
allowances, or (C) payment policies, procedures and practices with respect to
accounts payable.

     5.7 No Undisclosed Liabilities.

          (a) Except as set forth in Schedule 2.1, none of the Sellers have, and
     as of the Closing none of the Sellers will have, any liabilities (whether
     accrued, contingent, known, or otherwise) other than those that (i) are
     required to be set forth or reserved against in the balance sheets referred
     to in Section 5.5; or (ii) were incurred since December 31, 1998 in the
     ordinary course of business, none of which, individually or in the
     aggregate, is material to the business, operations, condition or prospects
     of the Business.

          (b) To the best knowledge of the Sellers after due inquiry, there is
     no fact which materially adversely affects the business, properties, or
     operations of any of the Sellers, including the Business, that has not been
     specifically disclosed herein or in a Schedule furnished herewith.
     Furthermore, and without limiting the foregoing, the Shareholders have no
     knowledge of any claims of errors or omissions in the handling or
     administration of claims made or the performance of any agency or agency
     management functions performed prior to the Closing, except as set forth on
     Schedule 5.8(a).

     5.8 Litigation; Compliance with Law; Licenses and Permits.

          (a) Except as set forth on Schedule 5.8(a), there is no claim, suit,
     action or proceeding ("Proceeding") pending, nor, to the best knowledge of
     each of the Sellers and each of the Shareholders, is there any
     investigation or Proceeding threatened, that involves or affects any of the
     Sellers or the Business, by or before any Governmental Entity, court,
     arbitration panel or any other Person.


                                      -12-

<PAGE>




          (b) To the best of the Sellers' knowledge after due inquiry, each of
     the Sellers and the Business have, and on the Closing Date will have,
     complied with all applicable foreign, provincial, United States federal,
     state, county, municipal or other local criminal, civil or common laws,
     statutes, ordinances, orders, codes, rules, regulations, permits, policies,
     guidance documents, judgments, decrees, injunctions, or agreements of any
     Governmental Entity (collectively, "Laws"), including but not limited to
     Laws relating to zoning, building codes, antitrust, occupational safety and
     health, industrial hygiene, environmental protection, water, ground or air
     pollution, consumer product safety, product liability, hiring, wages,
     hours, employee benefit plans and programs, collective bargaining and the
     payment of withholding and social security taxes. Since January 1, 1996,
     none of the Sellers has received any notice of any violation of any Law.

          (c) To the best of the Sellers' knowledge after due inquiry, each of
     the Sellers, each of the Shareholders and the Business have every license,
     permit, certification, qualification or franchise issued by any
     Governmental Entity (each, a "License") and every approval, authorization,
     waiver, variance, exemption, consent or ratification by or on behalf of any
     Person that is not a party to this Agreement (each, a "Permit") required
     for them to conduct their business as presently conducted, including as
     insurance agents and brokers, or otherwise required in connection with the
     Business. Schedule 5.8(c) sets forth a list of such Licenses and Permits.
     All such Licenses and Permits are in full force and effect and neither the
     Sellers nor either Shareholder has received notice of any pending
     cancellation or suspension of any thereof nor, to the best knowledge of
     each of the Sellers and each of the Shareholders, is any cancellation or
     suspension thereof threatened. The applicability and validity of each such
     License and Consent will not be adversely affected by the consummation of
     the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

     5.9 [Intentionally Omitted.]

     5.10 Real Property.

          (a) None of the Sellers own any real property.

          (b) Schedule 5.10(b) sets forth a list and description of all of the
     real property lease and subleases under which any of the Sellers are tenant
     or subtenant (the "Leases"), including the date of the Lease, the premises
     demised thereunder, the name of the lessee and lessor, the commencement
     date and expiration date of the Lease and the annual rent payable by the
     lessee under the Lease. As used herein, the term "Leased Real Property"
     shall mean the real property demised by the Leases.

          (c) The Sellers have heretofore delivered to the Buyer true, correct
     and complete copies of the Leases. Each of the Leases is in full force and
     effect and is enforceable in accordance with its terms. Each of the Sellers
     is in possession of and quietly enjoys the Leased


                                      -13-

<PAGE>



     Real Property applicable to it and each of the Sellers has a valid and
     enforceable leasehold interest, subject to no Liens except such immaterial
     easements and rights-of-way, none of which interferes with the operation of
     the business. No event has occurred or failed to occur that, with the
     giving of notice or the passage of time or both, would constitute a default
     under any Lease. The Sellers have not entered into any assignment of any
     Lease, sublease of all or any portion of any Leased Real Property and no
     person has any right to occupy the Leased Real Property other than the
     Sellers.

          (d) Neither the Sellers nor either of the Shareholders has received
     notice from any insurance company or Board of Fire Underwriters (or
     organization exercising functions similar thereto) or from any mortgagee
     requesting the performance of any work or alteration in respect of any of
     the Leased Real Property, and, to the best knowledge of each of the Sellers
     and each of the Shareholders, there are no outstanding requirements or
     recommendations from any of the foregoing.

          (e) There has been no damage to any portion of the Leased Real
     Property within the last 24 months caused by fire or other casualty that
     has not been repaired.

     5.11 Accounts, Intellectual Property; Computer Software.

          (a) The names and addresses of each and every Account is listed,
     described or referenced in Schedule 5.11(a). Each of the Sellers owns or
     has the right to use, free and clear of claims or rights of others, all
     Accounts, and each of the Sellers has the right to transfer all Accounts.
     None of the Sellers or the Shareholders are using any confidential or
     proprietary information or trade secrets (including customer list and
     mailing lists) of any of the Shareholders' former employers or any of the
     Sellers' or the Shareholders' past or present employees. Copies of all
     forms of nondisclosure or confidentiality agreements utilized by any of the
     Sellers to protect the Accounts have been provided to Buyer and are listed
     in Schedule 5.11(a).

          (b) Schedule 5.11(b) lists all Intellectual Property that is owned by
     the Sellers or any other Person and used by the Sellers in the operations
     of the Business, and there are no pending or to the best of the Sellers'
     knowledge after due inquiry, threatened claims by any Person relating to
     the Sellers' use of any Intellectual Property. The Sellers have such rights
     of ownership (free and clear of all Liens) of, or such rights by license,
     lease or other agreement to use (free and clear of all Liens) the
     Intellectual Property as are necessary to permit the Sellers to conduct
     their business and the Sellers are not obligated to pay any royalty or
     similar fee to any Person in connection with their use or license of any of
     the Intellectual Property.

          (c) The Sellers have such rights of ownership (free and clear of all
     Liens) of, or such rights by license, lease or other agreement to use (free
     and clear of all Liens), the computer software programs including, without
     limitation, application software that are used by the Sellers and that are
     material to the conduct of its business as currently conducted, as are
     necessary to permit the conduct of its business as currently conducted.
     None of the Sellers'

                                      -14-

<PAGE>



     ownership rights or rights to use any of the computer programs referred to
     above will be adversely affected by any of the transactions contemplated
     hereby.

     5.12 Title to Acquired Assets.

          (a) The Sellers have good and marketable title to the Acquired Assets,
     including, without limitation, all assets shown on the Financial
     Statements, free and clear of all Liens, other than (i) Liens, if any, for
     personal property taxes and assessments not yet due and payable and (ii)
     Liens disclosed on Schedule 5.12(a). At the Closing, the Sellers will have
     caused each Lien referred to on Schedule 5.12(a) (other than Liens relating
     to leased equipment) to have been terminated, and the Buyer will obtain
     good and marketable title to all of the Acquired Assets free and clear of
     all Liens.

          (b) All items of tangible personal property owned or leased by the
     Sellers and used in the conduct of its business are listed in the detailed
     fixed assets ledger of the Sellers attached to Schedule 5.12(b)
     (collectively, the "Personal Property"). The Personal Property conforms in
     all material respects to all requirements of applicable Laws. All of the
     items included within the Personal Property are fully operational and
     operating in the ordinary course of the Sellers' business, as applicable,
     are in good operating condition and in a good state of maintenance and
     repair, are adequate for use in the conduct of the Sellers' business as
     previously conducted and are capable of operation in the Sellers' business
     on an efficient and profitable basis.

     5.13 Material Contracts.

          (a) Schedule 5.13(a) sets forth a true, complete and correct list of
     every Contract that (i) provides for aggregate future payments by any of
     the Sellers or to any of the Sellers of more than $10,000; (ii) was entered
     into by any of the Sellers with either Shareholder, or an officer, director
     or significant employee of any of the Sellers; (iii) is a collective
     bargaining or similar agreement; (iv) guarantees or indemnifies or
     otherwise causes any of the Sellers to be liable or otherwise responsible
     for the obligations or liabilities of another or provides for a charitable
     contribution by any of the Sellers; (v) involves an agreement with any
     bank, finance company or similar organization; (vi) restricts any of the
     Sellers or the Business from engaging in any business or activity anywhere
     in the world; (vii) is an employment agreement, consulting agreement or
     similar arrangement with any employee of any of the Sellers; (viii)
     involves an agreement or any other Contract providing for payments from the
     Sellers to any other Person, or by any Person to any of the Sellers, based
     on sales, purchases or profits, other than direct payments for goods; or
     (ix) any other Contract that is material to the rights, properties, assets,
     business or operations of any of the Sellers or the Business (the
     foregoing, collectively, "Material Contracts"). The Sellers have heretofore
     provided true, complete and correct copies of all Material Contracts to the
     Buyer.


                                      -15-

<PAGE>



          (b) Except as set forth in Schedule 5.13(b), (i) there is not, and to
     the best knowledge of any of the Sellers and the Shareholders there has not
     been claimed or alleged by any Person with respect to any Material
     Contract, any existing default, or event that with notice or lapse of time
     or both would constitute a default or event of default, on the part of the
     Sellers or, to the best knowledge of any of the Sellers and the
     Shareholders, on the part of any other party thereto and (ii) no consent,
     approval, authorization or waiver from, or notice to, any Governmental
     Entity or other Person is required in order to maintain in full force and
     effect any of the Material Contracts, other than such consents and waivers
     that have been obtained and are unconditional and in full force and effect
     and such notices that have been duly given and copies of such consents,
     waivers and notices have been delivered to the Buyer.

     5.14 Taxes.

          (a) Each of the Sellers has elected to be treated as an "S"
     corporation for federal income Tax purposes at all times since its date of
     incorporation except that D.S.I. has been an S Corporation since July 1,
     1987, and such election is effective for each year thereafter up to and
     including the Effective Date. Schedule 5.14(a) hereto sets forth each other
     jurisdiction for which each Seller has made an "S" election (or similar
     election), or for which an "S" election (or similar election) is effective,
     including the date of the election, its effective date, the date of any
     termination of such election, if any, and the cause of such termination.
     Except as set forth on Schedule 5.14(a), such election is effective for
     each year from its effective date up to and including the Closing Date.

          (b) Except as set forth in Schedule 5.14(b):

               (i) the Sellers have duly and timely filed or caused to be filed
          with the Internal Revenue Service or other applicable Governmental
          Entity (collectively, "Taxing Authorities") all Tax Returns (as
          defined below) that are required to be filed by or on behalf of any of
          the Sellers or that include or relate to the Acquired Assets or the
          Business, which Tax Returns are true, correct and complete, and (B)
          duly and timely paid in full or caused to be paid in full, or recorded
          a provision for such payment on the books and records of the Sellers
          for the payment of, all Taxes that are due and payable that could
          result in a Lien on any Acquired Asset or the Business and has
          recorded a provision for such payment on the books and records of the
          Sellers for the payment of all Taxes that are not due and payable;

               (ii) the Sellers have duly and timely complied with all
          applicable Laws relating to the collection or withholding of Taxes,
          and the reporting and remittance thereof to the applicable Taxing
          Authorities;

               (iii) no audit, examination, investigation, reassessment or other
          administrative or court proceeding (collectively, a "Tax Proceeding")
          is pending or proposed with regard to any Tax or Tax Return referred
          to in clause (i) above;


                                      -16-

<PAGE>



               (iv) there is no Lien for any Tax upon any of the Acquired Assets
          or the Business;

               (v) the Buyer is not a transferee of any of the Sellers within
          the meaning of Section 6901 of the Code or any similar provision of
          applicable law;

               (vi) there is no outstanding request for a ruling from any Taxing
          Authority, closing agreement, (within the meaning of Section 7121 of
          the Code or any analogous provision of applicable Law) relating to any
          Tax for which any of the Sellers is or may be liable or with respect
          to any of the Sellers' income, assets or business, power of attorney
          or adjustment related to, or in connection with, any Tax that could
          result in a Lien on any Acquired Asset or the Business;

               (vii) none of the Acquired Assets is "tax-exempt bond financed
          property" or "tax-exempt use property" within the meaning of Section
          168(g) or (h), respectively, of the Code or any similar provision of
          applicable Law;

               (viii)none of the Acquired Assets is required to be treated as
          being owned by any other person pursuant to the "safe harbor" leasing
          provisions of Section 168(f)(8) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954
          as in effect prior to the repeal of those "safe harbor" leasing
          provisions or any similar provision of applicable Law;

               (ix) none of the Sellers are, nor have they been, a "United
          States real property holding corporation" within the meaning of
          Section 897(c)(2) of the Code at any time during the applicable period
          referred to in Section 897(c)(1)(A)(ii) of the Code; and

               (x) no claim has ever been made by a Taxing Authority in a
          jurisdiction where any of the Sellers has not paid any Tax or filed
          Tax Returns relating to the Business or any Acquired Asset asserting
          that any of the Sellers is or may be subject to Tax in such
          jurisdiction.

          (c) The Sellers have provided to the Buyer true, complete and correct
     copies of (i) all Tax Returns relating to, and (ii) all audit reports
     relating to, each proposed adjustment, if any, made by any Taxing Authority
     with respect to any taxable period ending after December 31, 1993 any and
     all Taxes with respect to which a Lien may be imposed on any Acquired Asset
     or the Business.

          (d) As used herein, (i) "Tax Return" means any return, declaration,
     report, information return or statement, and any amendment thereto,
     including without limitation any consolidated, combined or unitary return
     or other document (including any related or supporting information), filed
     or required to be filed with any Taxing Authority in connection with the
     determination, assessment, collection, payment, refund or credit of any
     federal, state, local or foreign Tax or the administration of any Laws
     relating to any Tax or ERISA, and (ii) "Tax" or

                                      -17-

<PAGE>



     "Taxes" means any and all taxes, charges, fees, levies, deficiencies or
     other assessments of whatever kind or nature including, without limitation,
     all net income, gross income, profits, gross receipts, excise, real or
     personal property, sales, ad valorem, withholding, social security,
     retirement, excise, employment, unemployment, minimum, estimated,
     severance, stamp, property, occupation, environmental, windfall profits,
     use, service, net worth, payroll, franchise, license, gains, customs,
     transfer, recording and other taxes, customs duty, fees assessments or
     charges of any kind whatsoever, imposed by any Taxing Authority, including
     any liability therefor as a transferee (including without limitation under
     Section 6901 of the Code or any similar provision of applicable Law), as a
     result of Treasury Regulation ss.1.1502-6 or any similar provision of
     applicable Law, or as a result of any Tax sharing or similar agreement,
     together with any interest, penalties or additions to tax relating thereto.

     5.15 Affiliated Party Transactions. Except for obligations arising under
this Agreement, as of the Closing Date the Sellers will not have, directly or
indirectly, any obligation to or claim against the Business and no Shareholder
or any Affiliate of such Shareholder will have, directly or indirectly, any
obligation to or cause of action or claim against any of the Sellers. For
purposes of this Agreement, the term Affiliate shall mean, with respect to any
Person, a member of such Person's immediate family or Persons controlled by or
are under common control with such Shareholders or such Shareholder's immediate
family.

     5.16 [Intentionally Omitted.]

     5.17 [Intentionally Omitted.]

     5.18 Receivables. All accounts receivable of the Sellers have arisen, and
as of the Closing Date will have arisen, from bona fide transactions in the
ordinary course of the Sellers' business consistent with past practice and
established in the ordinary course of the Sellers' business consistent with past
practice.

     5.19 Assets Utilized in the Business. Except as set forth in Schedule 5.19,
the assets, properties and rights owned, leased or licensed by the Sellers or
used in connection with the Business and that will be owned, leased or licensed
by the Sellers as of the Closing Date, and all the agreements to which any of
the Sellers is a party, constitute all of the properties, assets and agreements
necessary to the Sellers in connection with the operation and conduct by the
Sellers of the Business as presently conducted. Included in Schedule 5.19 are
all services provided by each Shareholder to the Sellers and all other
arrangements involving each Shareholder and the Sellers that are not included in
the Acquired Assets.

     5.20 Insurance. Schedule 5.20 contains a complete and correct list of all
policies of insurance of any kind or nature covering any of the Sellers,
including policies of fire, theft, casualty, product liability, workmen's
compensation, business interruption, employee fidelity and other casualty and
liability insurance, indicating the type of coverage, name of insured, the
insurer, the expiration date of each policy, the amount of coverage and whether
on an

                                      -18-

<PAGE>



"occurrence" or "claims made" basis. All such policies (i) are in full force and
effect; (ii) are sufficient for compliance with all material requirements of law
and of all applicable material agreements; and (iii) are valid, outstanding and
enforceable policies. Complete and correct copies of such policies or the
declaration pages have been furnished to the Buyer. All such insurance policies
or comparable coverage shall be continued in full force and effect through the
Closing Date. Since December 31, 1995, the Sellers have not been denied any
insurance coverage which they have requested.

     5.21 [Intentionally Omitted.]

     5.22 Commissions. The aggregate gross revenue received by the Sellers
attributable to the Business during calendar year 1998 is listed in Schedule
5.22 hereto. Except as described in Schedule 5.22, all insurance brokerage or
agency business placed by all employees, brokers, sub-brokers or agents of the
Sellers have been placed by them through and in the name of the Sellers and all
commissions on such business have been paid to and are the property of the
Sellers. To the best of the Sellers' knowledge after due inquiry, none of the
insurance sales agents, brokers, sub-brokers or employees of the Sellers have
indicated a desire to terminate their relationship with the Sellers.

     5.23 [Intentionally Omitted.]

     5.24 [Intentionally Omitted.]

     5.25 Directors, Officers and Certain Employees. Schedule 5.25 sets forth a
complete and correct list of the names, current annual salary, bonus and title,
for each director and officer and each other employee of the Sellers who is a
party to an employment agreement with any of the Sellers or who received annual
compensation during the Sellers' most recently ended fiscal year, or who is
entitled to receive compensation, on an annualized basis, whether or not paid to
date, in excess of $50,000. Neither the Sellers nor either Shareholder is aware
of any employee in the Sellers' senior management who intends to terminate his
or her employment relationship with the Business, either as a result of the
transactions contemplated hereby or otherwise. The persons identified on
Schedule 5.25 are the Sellers' only key employees.

     5.26 Year 2000. To the best knowledge of the Sellers after due inquiry, all
of the Sellers' systems, software, data and databases (other than data provided
to it by its customers) (collectively, the "Systems") are Year 2000 Compliant
(as hereinafter defined). For purposes of this Agreement, "Year 2000 Compliant"
shall mean: (i) the occurrence in or use by the Systems of dates before, on or
after January 1, 2000 will not adversely affect the performance of the Systems
with respect to date-dependent data, computations, output or other functions,
including, without limitation, calculating, comparing and sequencing; (ii) the
Systems will not abnormally end or provide invalid or incorrect results as a
result of date-dependant data; and (iii) the Systems can accurately recognize,
manage, accommodate and manipulate date-dependant data, including, without
limitation, single century formulas and leap years.


                                      -19-

<PAGE>



     5.27 No Misstatements or Omissions. No representation or warranty by the
Sellers or either Shareholder contained in this Agreement and no statement
contained in any certificate, list, Schedule, Exhibit or other instrument
specified or referred to in this Agreement, whether heretofore furnished to the
Buyer or hereafter furnished to the Buyer pursuant to this Agreement, contains
or will contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omits or will omit
any material fact necessary to make the statements contained therein, in light
of the circumstances under which it was made, not misleading.

     5.28 Investment Undertaking. (a) Each Shareholder and each of the Sellers
acknowledge that the Sellers confirm that the shares of Common Stock to be
issued to the Sellers pursuant to this agreement will be "restricted securities"
within the meaning of Rule 144 of the General Rules and Regulations under the
Securities Act of 1933 ("Rule 144"). Each Shareholder and each of the Sellers
acknowledge that the Sellers are acquiring such shares for the Sellers' own
account and not with a view to their distribution within the meaning of Section
2(11) of the Securities Act of 1933. Each Shareholder and each of the Sellers
acknowledge that the Sellers understand that Rule 144 requires that such shares
issued hereunder may not be disposed of for a period of at least one year. Each
Shareholder and the Sellers acknowledge that the Sellers understand that it must
bear the economic risk of the investment indefinitely because such shares may
not be sold, hypothecated or otherwise disposed of unless subsequently
registered under the Securities Act of 1933 and applicable state securities laws
or an exemption from registration is available.

     5.29 Absence of Sensitive Payments. None of the Sellers, none of the
Shareholders and none of the Sellers' directors, officers, brokers, sub-brokers,
agents, or employees, on behalf of any of the Sellers:

          (a) has made or has agreed to make any contributions, payments or
     gifts of funds or property to any governmental official, employee or agent
     where either the payment or the purpose of such contribution, payment or
     gift was or is illegal under the laws of the United States, any state
     thereof, or any jurisdiction (foreign or domestic); or

          (b) has made or agreed to make any contribution or expenditure, or has
     reimbursed any political gift or contribution or expenditure made by any
     other person to candidates for public office, whether federal, state or
     local (foreign or domestic) where such contributions were or would be a
     violation of applicable law.

     5.30 [Intentionally Omitted.]

6. Representations and Warranties of the Buyer. The Buyer represents and
warrants to the Sellers and the Shareholders as follows:


                                     -20-

<PAGE>



     6.1 Organization. The Buyer is a corporation duly organized, validly
existing and in good standing under the laws of Delaware and has all requisite
power and authority to own, lease and operate its properties and to carry on its
business as it is now being conducted. The Buyer is duly qualified or licensed
to do business as a corporation and is in good standing in each jurisdiction in
which the nature of the business conducted by it makes such qualification or
licensing necessary. The Buyer has heretofore delivered to the Sellers true,
complete and correct copies of its certificate of incorporation and bylaws as
currently in effect.

     6.2 Authorization; Validity of Agreement. The Buyer has the requisite
corporate power and authority to execute, deliver and perform this Agreement and
each other agreement executed or to be executed by it pursuant to the terms of
this Agreement (collectively, the "Buyer Agreements") and to consummate the
transactions contemplated hereby and thereby. The execution, delivery and
performance by the Buyer of this Agreement and the other Buyer Agreements to
which it is a party and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby
and thereby have been duly and validly authorized by the Buyer, and no other
proceedings on the part of the Buyer are necessary to authorize the execution,
delivery and performance of this Agreement and the other Buyer Agreements to
which the Buyer is a party and the consummation of the transactions contemplated
hereby and thereby. This Agreement and each other Buyer Agreement to which the
Buyer is a party has been duly executed and delivered by the Buyer and is a
valid and binding obligation of the Buyer, enforceable against the Buyer in
accordance with their respective terms, except as such enforceability may be
subject to or limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, or
other similar laws, now or hereafter in effect, affecting the enforcement of
creditors' rights generally.

     6.3 No Violations; Consents and Approvals.

          (a) The execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement and the
     Buyer Agreements by the Buyer, do not, and the consummation by the Buyer of
     the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby will not, (i) violate any
     provision of the certificate of incorporation or Bylaws of the Buyer, (ii)
     result in a violation or breach of, or constitute (with or without due
     notice or lapse of time or both) a default (or give rise to any right of
     termination, cancellation or acceleration) under, any of the terms,
     conditions or provisions of any material note, bond, mortgage, indenture,
     guarantee, other evidence of indebtedness, license, contract, agreement or
     other instrument to which the Buyer is a party or by which the Buyer or any
     of its properties or assets may be bound or otherwise subject or (iii)
     violate any order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree, law, statute, rule
     or regulation applicable to the Buyer or any of its respective properties
     or assets.

          (b) No filing or registration with, notification to, or authorization,
     consent or approval of, any Governmental Entity is required in connection
     with the execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement or the other
     Buyer Agreements by the Buyer or the consummation by the Buyer of the
     transactions contemplated hereby and thereby, except filings

                                      -21-

<PAGE>



     as may be required under state and federal securities laws to give effect
     to the issuance of the Common Stock pursuant to this Agreement.

     6.4 Shares of Capital Stock. All shares of Common Stock issued to the
Sellers pursuant to this Agreement will be duly authorized and validly issued
and shall, upon issuance, be fully paid and nonassessable.


7. Other Agreements of the Parties.

     7.1  Tax Returns; Taxes.

          (a) To the extent permitted under applicable Law, the parties shall
     cause or elect to treat any Tax period including the Effective Date as
     ending at the close of business on the Closing Date. The Sellers and the
     Shareholders (i) shall (A) duly and timely file or cause to be filed with
     the applicable Taxing Authorities all Tax Returns with respect to any Tax
     period ending on or before the Closing Date and that include or relate to
     any Acquired Asset or the Business, which such Tax Returns shall be true,
     correct and complete, and (B) duly and timely pay in full or cause to be
     paid in full all Taxes that are due and payable on or before the Closing
     Date; and (ii) have recorded a provision on the books and records of the
     Sellers for the payment of all such Taxes that are not due and payable on
     or before the Closing Date. The Sellers shall, and the Shareholders shall
     cause the Sellers to, provide to the Buyer true, complete and correct
     copies of such Tax Returns and all correspondence, reports and documents
     relating to any Tax Proceeding with respect thereto. The Sellers shall, and
     the Shareholders shall cause the Sellers to, duly and timely comply with
     all applicable Laws relating to the collection or withholding of Taxes and
     the reporting and remittance thereof to the applicable Taxing Authorities.

          (b) (i) The Buyer shall file all Tax Returns for any Tax period that
     includes but does not end on the Closing Date. The Buyer shall allocate any
     Taxes for a period which includes but does not end on the Closing Date
     between the period before the Closing Date and the balance of the period on
     the basis of an interim closing of the books at the close of the Closing
     Date, except that exemptions, allocations and deductions calculated on an
     annual basis shall be apportioned on the basis of the relative number of
     days in the period on or before the Closing Date and in the balance of the
     period. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any real estate or personal property
     Taxes shall be allocated on the basis of the relative number of days in the
     period on or before the Effective Date and in the balance of the applicable
     period.

               (ii) Within five (5) days of receiving notification of the amount
          of Tax allocated to the period ending prior to the Effective Date, the
          Sellers and the Shareholders shall pay, on a net after-tax basis, the
          amount of such Tax allocated to the portion of the period ending on or
          prior to the Effective Date.


                                      -22-

<PAGE>



     7.2 Tax Indemnity.

          (a) The Sellers and the Shareholders shall indemnify the Buyer and its
     Affiliates (collectively, the "Taxpayer"), and hold the Taxpayer harmless,
     on an after-tax basis, from and against any (i) Taxes assessed against or
     imposed on the Sellers, the Shareholders or with respect to the Business or
     any Acquired Asset for any period (or portion of any period) ending on or
     before the Effective Date and (ii) fees and expenses (including, without
     limitation, attorneys' fees) incurred by the Buyer or its Affiliates in
     enforcing its rights or collecting any amounts due hereunder. This
     indemnity shall apply notwithstanding any investigation made by the Buyer
     in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or, its
     receipt, examination, filing of or commenting on any Tax Return, and shall
     be separate and independent of any other indemnity between the parties
     hereto.

          (b) The procedure for any indemnification claim made under this
     Section 7.2 shall be the same as the procedure set forth in Section 12.3
     hereof.

     7.3 Public Statements. No press releases or any public disclosure, either
written or oral, of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement shall be
made without the prior written notice and written consent of the Buyer.

     7.4 Other Actions. Each of the parties hereto shall use all reasonable
efforts to (i) take, or cause to be taken, all actions, (ii) do, or cause to be
done, all things, and (iii) execute and deliver all such documents, instruments
and other papers, as in each case may be necessary, proper or advisable under
applicable Laws, or reasonably required in order to carry out the terms and
provisions of this Agreement and to consummate and make effective the
transactions contemplated hereby.

     7.5 Cooperation on Taxes. Each of the Sellers and the Buyer shall cooperate
with each other by executing or causing to be executed any required documents
and by making available to the other, all books and records relating to the
Acquired Assets or the Business (including work papers, records and notes of any
kind) at all reasonable times, for the purpose of allowing the appropriate party
to complete its Tax Returns, respond to defend or prosecute any Tax Proceeding,
make any determination required under this Agreement (including, but not limited
to, determinations as to which period any asserted Tax liability is
attributable) and verify issues.

     7.6 Employees.

          (a) The Buyer and the Sellers have prepared a mutually agreeable list
     of employees of the Sellers and independent contractors who render services
     for the Sellers to be attached to this Agreement as Schedule 7.6(a). The
     Buyer shall offer employment effective as of the Closing to all employees
     of the Sellers listed on Schedule 7.6(a) to this Agreement (all such
     employees who accept such offer of employment being the "Transferred
     Employees"). The

                                      -23-

<PAGE>



     Sellers shall obtain, and provide the Buyer with the written agreement of
     each Transferred Employee applicable to it to the Buyer's review of the
     personnel file of such Transferred Employee, prior to the Buyer's review of
     such personnel file. In addition to the obligation of the Sellers set forth
     below, all responsibility for employees of the Sellers, other than
     Transferred Employees, including, without limitation, claims arising out of
     the decision not to include such employees on Schedule 7.6(a), shall be
     liabilities of the Sellers.

          (b) Subject to the terms and conditions of this Section 7.6, from and
     after the Closing, the Buyer shall provide the Transferred Employees with
     terms and conditions of employment including, without limitation, salaries,
     hourly wages, employee benefits and other perquisites, that have been
     reviewed and discussed with the Sellers and are reasonably agreeable to the
     Buyer and to the Sellers. The Buyer shall establish insurance or other
     arrangements through which the employee benefits and other perquisites to
     be provided by the Buyer to Transferred Employees may be provided
     commencing as of the Closing Date, and the Shareholders and the Sellers
     shall lend such cooperation as the Buyer may reasonably request in
     connection with such efforts.

          (c) The Buyer shall not be responsible for any payments, expenses and
     costs paid or required to be paid in connection with the employment or
     termination of employment of any employees of the Sellers who are not
     listed on Schedule 7.6(a) to this Agreement, or who are listed on Schedule
     7.6(a) and do not accept the Buyer's offer of employment with the Buyer.

          (d) Except to the extent expressly provided in the other subsections
     of this Section 7.6, the Sellers shall remain responsible for (i) payment
     of any and all wages, accrued vacation pay, bereavement pay, jury duty pay,
     disability income, supplemental unemployment benefits, fringe benefits or
     other perquisites of employment, termination indemnities or similar
     benefits (whether arising under any plan, program, policy or arrangement of
     the Sellers or under applicable local law), payroll taxes and other payroll
     related expenses and (ii) payments to or under employee benefit plans
     (within the meaning of Section 3(3) of ERISA) maintained or contributed to
     by the Sellers, in either case arising out of or relating to the employment
     of any of the Transferred Employees by the Sellers prior to the Effective
     Date.

          (e) The Sellers shall retain responsibility and liability for all
     workers' compensation claims of the Transferred Employees to the extent
     relating to events, conditions or circumstances that occur or exist prior
     to the Effective Date. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Buyer may, at its
     election, assume responsibility for the supervision, defense or settlement
     of any such workers' compensation claims at the Sellers' cost and expense,
     provided that such costs and expenses are reasonable. The Buyer shall keep
     the Sellers reasonably apprised of the status of such workers' compensation
     claims. The Sellers may, at its own expense, participate in the
     supervision, defense or settlement of any such workers' compensation
     claims, and shall cooperate in the supervision, defense or settlement of
     any such workers' compensation claims if requested to do so by the Buyer.
     The Buyer shall have sole responsibility and liability for any workers'

                                      -24-

<PAGE>



     compensation claims of Transferred Employees to the extent relating to any
     event, condition or circumstance that occurs after the Effective Date.

          (f) In respect of grievances or EEOC Claims of Transferred Employees
     to the extent relating to their employment by the Sellers including,
     without limitation, any such grievances or EEOC Claims filed before state
     or local authorities for which payment has not been made prior to the
     Closing, the Sellers shall retain responsibility and liability for all
     amounts due with respect thereto including, without limitation, the payment
     of any amounts in the nature of back pay or employee compensation, and any
     state or federal taxes in connection with such back pay or employee
     compensation. Handling of such grievances and EEOC Claims shall be at the
     Sellers' cost and expense. The Buyer shall have sole responsibility and
     liability for any EEOC Claims of Transferred Employees that relate to their
     employment with Buyer.

          (g) Nothing in this Section 7.6 shall limit the at will nature of the
     employment of the Transferred Employees or the right of the Buyer to alter
     or terminate any employee benefit plan.

     7.7 Consents. The Sellers and the Shareholders shall cause the Sellers to
receive all Consents on or prior to the Closing Date, each of which Consents is
set forth on Schedule 5.4(b) attached hereto. At or prior to the Closing, the
Shareholders and the Sellers shall cause the Acquired Assets to be released from
all liabilities, liens or other obligations.

     7.8 [Intentionally Omitted.]

     7.9 Exclusivity. From and after the date hereof and unless and until this
Agreement is terminated as provided in Section 9, neither the Sellers nor either
Shareholder shall, and neither shall knowingly permit the Sellers or any of
their respective Affiliates, officers, directors, employees, agents or
representatives, directly or indirectly, to encourage, solicit, initiate or
participate in discussions or negotiations with, provide any information to,
receive any proposals or offers from, or enter into any agreement with, any
third party, in each case other than the Buyer, that involves the sale, joint
venture or the other disposition of all or any portion of the Sellers, the
Acquired Assets or the Business or any merger, consolidation, recapitalization
or other business combination of any kind involving the Sellers. If the Sellers
or either Shareholder receives or becomes aware of any such offer or proposed
offer, the Sellers or such Shareholder, as the case may be, shall promptly
notify the Buyer.

     7.10 Prior Acts Insurance. The Sellers shall maintain their current errors
and omissions policies through their expiration dates of January 1, 2000,
following which the Sellers shall purchase tail coverage for a period of one
year.

     7.11 Equipment, Intellectual Property and Other Assets. Prior to the
Closing Date, the Shareholders shall take all steps necessary to contribute all
equipment, intellectual property and

                                      -25-

<PAGE>



other assets owned by either Shareholder or any Affiliate of any Shareholder
that is used in connection with the Business in consideration solely for shares
of Common Stock of the Sellers.

     7.12 Non-Solicitation.

          (a) In view of the personal identification of customers and sources
     with brokerage employees, the potential exists for appropriation by
     employees and/or other persons or entities of the benefits of the
     relationships developed with the foregoing, despite the Buyer's investment
     in the development of those relationships on its behalf. Accordingly, since
     the parties hereto recognize that the Buyer would suffer irreparable harm
     if any Seller or either Shareholder should solicit customers or any other
     employee of the Buyer to terminate its/his/her relationship with the Buyer,
     it is reasonable to protect the Buyer against such activities for the
     limited period of time necessary for the Buyer to establish, renew and/or
     restore its business relationship with the foregoing individual and
     commercial customers and sources, without unduly restricting any Seller or
     either Shareholder from competing with the Buyer. For the above reasons,
     the Buyer and each Seller and Shareholder agree that in order to protect
     the Buyer in the event that either Shareholder ceases to be an employee of
     the Buyer for any reason ("Withdrawal from the Buyer"), during the term of
     each Shareholder's employment with the Buyer and for the three (3) year
     period immediately following any Withdrawal from the Buyer, each Seller and
     Shareholder agrees not to, directly or indirectly:

               (i) solicit, join, provide services to, advise, give assistance
          to, or contact any person or entity who was a client of the Buyer
          (including Accounts and New Business) or any employee of such client,
          with respect to the provision of insurance or insurance-related
          services;

               (ii) accept any business from any customer of the Buyer
          (including Accounts and New Business) or any of its affiliates, or
          solicit or encourage any such person to terminate or adversely alter
          in any material respect any relationship such person may have with the
          Buyer or any of its affiliates;

               (iii) develop or provide assistance to another person/entity who
          or which is developing a program of insurance competitive with a
          program of insurance sold or marketed by the Buyer or any of its
          affiliates;

               (iv) solicit any persons or entities who, to the knowledge of any
          Seller or Shareholder, are or were identified through leads developed
          while either Shareholder was employed by the Buyer;

               (v) solicit professional relationships introduced to any
          Shareholder by any employee or client of the Buyer while such
          Shareholder was an employee of the Buyer;


                                      -26-

<PAGE>



               (vi) offer employment to or employ any person who is then, or had
          been within six (6) months prior to such offer, an employee of the
          Buyer; and

               (vii) solicit or attempt to solicit, induce or otherwise cause
          any employee of the Buyer or any of its affiliates to terminate his or
          her employment thereunder.

          (b) Each Seller and Shareholder hereby acknowledges that the covenant
     contained in Sections 7.12(a) is reasonable and necessary for the
     protection of the Buyer and is an essential inducement to the Buyer's
     entering into this Agreement. Accordingly, each Seller and Shareholder
     shall be bound by the provisions hereof to the maximum extent permitted by
     law, it being the intent and spirit of the parties that the foregoing shall
     be fully enforceable. However, the parties further agree that, if any of
     the provisions hereof shall for any reason be held to be excessively broad
     as to duration, geographical scope, property or subject matter, such
     provision shall be construed by limiting and reducing it so as to be
     enforceable to the extent compatible with the applicable law as it shall
     herein pertain.

          (c) Each Seller and Shareholder acknowledges that any violation of the
     covenant contained in Section 7.12(a) shall constitute an undue burden to
     the Buyer, and accordingly, in addition to any other rights and remedies
     available under this Agreement or otherwise, the parties hereby expressly
     agree that the Buyer shall be entitled to an injunction or specific
     enforcement (without the necessity of any bond) restricting any Seller or
     either Shareholder from committing or continuing any such violation.

          (d) Anything contained herein to the contrary notwithstanding, the
     foregoing provisions contained in Sections 7.12(a), (b) and (c) shall be
     unenforceable and of no force and effect in the event that the Buyer
     breaches a material obligation contained in this Agreement (which shall
     include the failure to pay any Earn Out Installment or any Interest
     Installment on the Due Date) and fails to cure such breach within 30 days
     after a Shareholder provides the Buyer with written notice detailing the
     breach or in the event that the Buyer elects to avail itself of the
     buy-back provision contained in Section 3.3.

     7.13 Post Closing Adjustment.

     Within a reasonable time following the Closing (not to exceed 45 days), the
parties and their accountants shall confer in good faith in order to compute the
amount, if any, of the post closing adjustment payment to which either party may
be entitled (the "Post Closing Adjustment Payment"). In calculating the Post
Closing Adjustment Payment, the parties and their accountants shall calculate
the following during the period between the Effective Date and the Closing: (i)
income collected by the Sellers where the Sellers shall be entitled to income
from accounts billed prior to the Effective Date for policies with effective
dates prior to the Effective Date; (ii) expenses for the office and employees at
130 Crossways Park Drive, Woodbury, New York (the "Long Island Office") which
were paid by Sellers (and the Sellers shall be responsible for expenses accrued
prior to the Effective Date and paid thereafter); and (iii) payments in

                                      -27-

<PAGE>



accordance with the employment agreements referred to in Section 8.1 of this
Agreement in excess of the amount in subparagraph (ii) of this Section 7.13.

     7.14 Refund of Security Deposit. At the Closing, the Buyer shall pay the
sum of $5,871.01 to D.S.I. and the sum of $2,516.15 to AMSCO representing their
respective shares of the security deposit under the Lease (as allocated pursuant
to Schedule 3.1).

8. Conditions Precedent to the Closing

     8.1 Conditions Precedent to the Buyer's Obligations to Close. The
obligation of the Buyer to enter into this Agreement and to consummate the
transactions contemplated hereby is subject to the satisfaction prior to or on
the Closing Date of each of the following conditions; provided, however, that
the Buyer shall have the right to waive all or any part of each such condition
and to close the transactions contemplated hereby without, however, releasing
the Sellers or either Shareholder from any covenant, obligation, agreement or
condition contained herein or from any liability for any loss or damage
sustained by the Buyer by reason of the breach by the Sellers or either
Shareholder of any covenant, obligation, agreement or condition contained herein
or by reason of any misrepresentation made by the Sellers or either Shareholder;
and provided further, however, that the Buyer's participation in the Closing
shall not in any way be deemed to be a waiver of any claim it may have hereunder
for any breach of any representation, warranty, covenant or agreement:

          (a) The representations and warranties of the Sellers and the
     Shareholders contained in this Agreement shall be true and correct as of
     the Closing Date, except for such representations and warranties as are
     made as of a specific date, which shall be true and correct in all material
     respects as of such date.

          (b) The covenants and agreements of the Sellers and the Shareholders
     contained in this Agreement and required to be complied with or performed
     on or prior to the Closing Date shall have been complied with or performed
     in all respects.

          (c) The Buyer shall have received (i) a certificate dated the Closing
     Date and executed by an executive officer of each of the Sellers, and (ii)
     a certificate dated the Closing Date and executed by each of the
     Shareholders, in each case certifying the satisfaction of the conditions
     referred to in Sections 8.1(a) and (b).

          (d) The Buyer shall have received, each in form and substance
     reasonably satisfactory to the Buyer, all Consents of, and estoppel
     certificates and releases from, and shall have delivered all notices to,
     any Governmental Entity or other Person that is required for the
     consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby and for the Buyer to
     conduct and operate the Business, which Consents, notices and estoppel
     certificates are listed in Schedule 5.4(b) attached hereto.


                                      -28-

<PAGE>



          (e) No event or events shall have occurred between the date hereof and
     the Closing Date which, individually or in the aggregate, have, or are
     reasonably likely to have, a material adverse effect on the Acquired Assets
     or the Business.

          (f) The Buyer shall have received a certificate of each of the Sellers
     (the "Sellers Secretary's Certificate") certifying the resolutions duly and
     validly adopted by the Board of Directors and the Shareholders of the
     Sellers, its authorization of the execution and delivery of this Agreement
     and the other Transaction Documents to which the Sellers are a party and
     the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby, and
     the names and signatures of the officers of each of the Sellers authorized
     to sign this Agreement and the other Transaction Documents.

          (g) [Intentionally Omitted.]

          (h) The Buyer shall have received a Bill of Sale, in the form of
     Exhibit 8.1(h) (the "Bill of Sale") attached hereto, duly executed by each
     of the Sellers.

          (i) DS shall have executed and delivered to the Buyer an employment
     agreement in the form of Exhibit 8.1(i)(A), AS shall have executed and
     delivered to the Buyer an employment agreement in the form of Exhibit
     8.1(i)(B) and MaryJeanne Egleston and Christopher Brady shall have executed
     and delivered to the Buyer an employment agreement in the form of Exhibit
     8.1(i)(C).

          (j) Each of the Sellers shall have signed and delivered to the Buyer a
     letter addressed to the customers of each of the Sellers in the form of
     Exhibit 8.1(j) hereto advising such customers of the sale by the Sellers to
     the Buyer of the Business.

          (k) Each of the Sellers shall have signed and delivered to the Buyer
     an assignment of each of the Leases, with the appropriate consent of
     landlord attached thereto, in the form of Exhibit 8.1(k).

          (l) There shall be no order, decree or injunction of a court of
     competent jurisdiction or other Governmental Entity that prevents the
     consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or
     Proceeding that threatens to prevent such transactions.

          (m) The Sellers and Shareholders shall produce evidence satisfactory
     to Buyer that Section 7.10 has been complied with.

          (n) The Sellers shall have filed, or caused to be filed, with the New
     York Secretary of State and the New York Superintendent of Insurance (as
     well as with the Secretary of State and Commissioner or Superintendent of
     Insurance of such jurisdictions in which any of the Sellers are qualified
     or are operating as a foreign corporation) an amendment to the Certificate
     of Incorporation or equivalent document of each of the Sellers changing
     each of the

                                      -29-

<PAGE>



     Sellers' names to a name which does not include the words "Seaman", "Ross",
     "Wiener", "AMSCO", "Coverage" or "D.S.I.". The Sellers also deliver to the
     Buyer consent letters, consenting to the Buyer's use of the names "Seaman,
     Ross & Wiener, Inc.", "SRW", "AMSCO Coverage Corp." and "D.S.I. Associates,
     Inc.".

     8.2 Conditions Precedent to the Sellers' Obligations to Close. The
obligation of the Sellers to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby is
subject to the satisfaction prior to or on the Closing Date of each of the
following conditions; provided, however, that the Sellers shall have the right
to waive all or any part of each such condition, and to close the transactions
contemplated hereby without, however, releasing the Buyer from any covenant,
obligation, agreement or condition contained herein or from any liability for
any loss or damage sustained by the Sellers by reason of the breach by the Buyer
of any covenant, obligation, agreement or condition contained herein, by reason
of any misrepresentation made by the Buyer; and provided further, however, that
the Sellers' participation in the Closing shall not in any way be deemed to be a
waiver of any claim it may have hereunder for any breach of any representation,
warranty, covenant or agreement:

          (a) The representations and warranties of the Buyer contained in this
     Agreement shall have been true and correct when made and shall be true and
     correct as of the Closing Date, with the same force and effect as if made
     as of the Closing Date, other than such representations and warranties as
     are made as of a specific date, which shall be true and correct in all
     material respects as of such date.

          (b) The covenants and agreements contained in this Agreement to be
     complied with by the Buyer on or before the Closing Date shall have been
     complied with or performed in all respects.

          (c) The Sellers shall have received a certificate dated the Closing
     Date and executed by an officer of the Buyer, certifying to the
     satisfaction of the conditions referred to in Sections 8.2(a) and (b).

          (d) The Sellers shall have received a certificate of the Secretary of
     the Buyer (the "Buyer Secretary's Certificate") certifying the resolutions
     duly and validly adopted by the Buyer evidencing its authorization of the
     execution and delivery of this Agreement and the other Transaction
     Documents to which the Buyer is a party and the consummation of the
     transactions contemplated hereby and thereby, and the names and signatures
     of the officers of the Buyer authorized to sign this Agreement and the
     other Transaction Documents to be delivered hereunder.

          (e) [Intentionally Omitted.]


                                      -30-

<PAGE>



          (f) The form and substance of all certificates, opinions, consents,
     instruments and other documents delivered to the Sellers under this
     Agreement shall be satisfactory in all reasonable respects to the Sellers
     and its counsel.

          (g) There shall be no order, decree or injunction of a court of
     competent jurisdiction or other Governmental Entity that prevents the
     consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or
     Proceeding that threatens to prevent such transactions.

          (h) The Sellers shall have received a check in the amount of
     $1,495,356.80 made payable to the order of D.S.I. for its share of the
     Purchase Price.

          (i) The Sellers shall have received a check in the amount of
     $640,867.20 made payable to the order of AMSCO for its share of the
     Purchase Price.

          (j) The Sellers shall have received 48,780 shares of Common Stock
     issued to D.S.I. for its share of the Purchase Price.

          (k) The Sellers shall have received 20,906 shares of Common Stock
     issued to AMSCO for its share of the Purchase Price.

          (l) The Sellers shall have received a check in the amount of $5,871.01
     made payable to the order of D.S.I. for its share of the security deposit.

          (m) The Sellers shall have received a check in the amount of $2,516.15
     made payable to the order of AMSCO for its share of the security deposit.

          (n) The Sellers and the Shareholders shall have received executed
     employment agreements for each of DS, AS, MaryJeanne Egleston and
     Christopher Brady.

          (o) The Sellers and the Shareholders shall have received payment to
     DS, AS, MaryJeanne Egleston and Christopher Brady of the consideration for
     the restrictive covenants in their respective employment agreements.

9. [Intentionally Omitted].

10. Survival of Representations and Warranties, Rights and Obligations
Subsequent to Closing.

     10.1 Survival of Representations and Warranties of the Sellers and the
Shareholders. Notwithstanding any right of the Buyer fully to investigate the
affairs of the Sellers and the Shareholders and notwithstanding any knowledge of
facts determined or determinable by the Buyer pursuant to such investigation or
right of investigation, the Buyer has the right to rely fully upon the
representations and warranties of the Sellers contained in this Agreement or in
any other

                                      -31-

<PAGE>



Transaction Document. All such representations and warranties shall survive the
execution and delivery of this Agreement and the Closing hereunder and shall
thereafter continue in full force and effect until the third anniversary of the
Closing Date, and the Sellers' and the Shareholders' liability in respect of any
breach of any such representation or warranty shall terminate on the third
anniversary of the Closing Date, except for liability with respect to which
notice shall have been given on or prior to such date to the party against which
such claim is asserted pursuant to Section 11.3, which such liability shall
remain an obligation of the party against whom such claim is asserted. The
foregoing notwithstanding, the representations and warranties contained in
Sections 5.3, 5.12 and 5.14 shall survive the Closing and the Sellers' and the
Shareholders' liability in respect of any breach thereof shall continue until 60
days after all liability relating thereto is barred by all applicable statutes
of limitation, except for liability with respect to which notice shall have been
given on or prior to such date to the party against which such claim is asserted
pursuant to Section 11.3, which such liability shall remain an obligation of the
party against whom such claim is asserted.

     10.2 Survival of Representations and Warranties of the Buyer. The Sellers
and the Shareholders have the right to rely fully upon the representations and
warranties of the Buyer contained in this Agreement or in any other Transaction
Document. All such representations and warranties shall survive the execution
and delivery of this Agreement and the Closing hereunder and shall thereafter
continue in full force and effect until the third anniversary of the Closing
Date, and Buyer's liability in respect of any breach of any such representation
or warranty shall terminate on the third anniversary of the Closing Date, except
for liability with respect to which notice shall have been given on or prior to
such date to the party against which such claim is asserted pursuant to Section
11.3, which such liability shall remain an obligation of the party against whom
such claim is asserted. The foregoing notwithstanding, the representations and
warranties contained in Section 6.2 shall survive the Closing and the Buyer's
liability in respect of any breach thereof shall continue until 60 days after
all liability relating thereto is barred by all applicable statutes of
limitation, except for liability with respect to which notice shall have been
given on or prior to such date to the party against which such claim is asserted
pursuant to Section 11.3, which such liability shall remain an obligation of the
party against whom such claim is asserted.

     10.3 Collection of Assets. Subsequent to the Closing, the Buyer shall have
the right and authority to collect all items transferred to it by the Sellers,
and each of the Sellers agrees that it will promptly transfer or deliver to the
Buyer from time to time, any cash or other property that any of the Sellers may
receive with respect to any claims, contracts, licenses, leases, commitments,
sales orders, purchase orders, or any other item required to be transferred to
the Buyer pursuant to this Agreement.

     10.4 Payment of Debts. The Sellers shall, after the Closing, pay all debts
and obligations of each of the Sellers to any brokers in the ordinary course of
business consistent with past practice.


                                      -32-

<PAGE>



     10.5 Collection of Accounts Receivable.

          (a) Accounts receivable arising out of services performed by any of
     the Sellers prior to the Effective Date ("Sellers' Receivables") shall
     remain the sole and exclusive property of the Sellers. Without limiting the
     generality of the foregoing, the Sellers shall have the right to settle or
     compromise Sellers' Receivables subject to approval of the Buyer, which
     shall not be unreasonably withheld; provided, however, that no suit or
     other action by the Sellers with respect to Sellers' Receivables may be
     taken without the Buyer's approval, which it may withhold in its sole and
     absolute discretion.

          (b) The Buyer agrees to deliver to the Sellers at such addresses or in
     such bank depositaries as the Sellers may designate from time to time (at
     the close of business on the last business day of each week during the one
     hundred eighty (180) day period following the Closing and thereafter
     monthly on the last business day of each month) all cash, checks, money
     orders and other instruments received by the Buyer representing payment of
     Sellers' Receivables. If the Buyer shall determine, in good faith, that any
     portion of such instruments so remitted represents amounts due to the Buyer
     for services rendered to the remitting customers on or after the Effective
     Date, the Buyer shall deliver to the Sellers a memorandum setting forth
     such allocation. The Buyer agrees, except to the extent any customers shall
     otherwise specifically identify a payment in writing, to credit all
     payments to the oldest balances outstanding from such customers.

          (c) In the event of non-payment by a customer of a receivable which is
     in part a Sellers' Receivable and in part a receivable of the Buyer, the
     parties will cooperate in good faith with respect to the settlement,
     compromise or collection thereof, and should the parties determine jointly
     to commence a suit or other legal proceeding to enforce the same, any
     resulting judgment or settlement, and any related court costs, attorneys'
     fees and other costs of collection to the extent not collected from the
     defendant shall be paid to and borne by the Sellers and the Buyer pro rata
     in proportion to the respective unpaid amount payable to each.

     10.6 Letters to Customers. In addition to the letters to the customers of
each of the Sellers advising such customers of the sale of the Business by the
Sellers to the Buyer, which letters each of the Sellers are required to sign and
deliver to the Buyer on or prior to the Closing Date, pursuant to Section
8.1(j), each of the Sellers agrees to cooperate fully with the Buyer at no cost
to the Sellers after the Closing in the drafting, signing, delivering and
sending out of follow-up letters to the customers of each of the Sellers.

11. Indemnification.

     11.1 Indemnification by the Sellers and the Shareholders. Subject to the
limitations contained in Section 10, the Sellers and the Shareholders shall
jointly and severally indemnify and defend the Buyer and each of its officers,
directors, employees, shareholders, agents, advisors or representatives (each, a
"Buyer Indemnitee") against, and hold each Buyer Indemnitee

                                      -33-

<PAGE>



harmless from, any loss, liability, obligation, deficiency, damage or expense
including, without limitation, interest, penalties, reasonable attorneys' fees
and disbursements (collectively, "Damages"), that any Buyer Indemnitee may
suffer or incur in any action or proceeding commenced in connection with the
following (whether or not in connection with any third party claim):

          (a) any breach of any representation or warranty made by the Sellers
     or any Shareholder contained in this Agreement or in any other Transaction
     Document;

          (b) either the Sellers' or any Shareholder's failure to perform or to
     comply with any covenant or condition required to be performed or complied
     with by the Sellers or the Shareholders contained in this Agreement or in
     any other Transaction Document; or

          (c) the ownership or operation of the Business or Acquired Assets
     prior to the Closing Date, including payment of liabilities in accordance
     with Section 2.1.

     11.2 Indemnification by the Buyer. Subject to the limitations contained in
Section 10, the Buyer shall indemnify and defend the Sellers and the
Shareholders and each of the Sellers' officers, directors, employees,
shareholders, agents, advisors or representatives (each, a "Sellers Indemnitee")
against, and hold each Sellers Indemnitee harmless from, any Damages that such
Sellers Indemnitee may suffer or incur in any action or proceeding commenced in
connection with the following (whether or not in connection with any third party
claim):

          (a) any breach of any representation or warranty made by the Buyer
     contained in this Agreement or in any other Transaction Document;

          (b) the Buyer's failure to perform or to comply with any covenant or
     condition required to be performed or complied with by the Buyer contained
     in this Agreement or in any other Transaction Document; or

          (c) the ownership or operation of the Business or Acquired Assets
     after the Closing Date.

     11.3 Indemnification Procedures.

          (a) Promptly after notice to an indemnified party of any claim or the
     commencement of any Proceeding, including any Proceeding by a third party,
     involving any Damage referred to in Sections 11.1 or 11.2, such indemnified
     party shall, if a claim for indemnification in respect thereof is to be
     made against an indemnifying party pursuant to this Section 11, give
     written notice to the latter of the notice of such claim or the
     commencement of such Proceeding, setting forth in reasonable detail the
     nature thereof and the basis upon which such party seeks indemnification
     hereunder; provided, however, that the failure of any indemnified party to
     give such notice shall not relieve the indemnifying party of its
     obligations

                                      -34-

<PAGE>



     under such Section, except to the extent that the indemnifying party is
     actually prejudiced by the failure to give such notice.

          (b) (i) In the case of any Proceeding by a third party against an
     indemnified party, if the indemnifying party acknowledges in writing its
     obligation to indemnify the indemnified party therefor, the indemnifying
     party will be entitled to assume the defense thereof (at the expense of the
     indemnifying party), with counsel reasonably satisfactory to the
     indemnified party, and, after notice from the indemnifying party to the
     indemnified party of its acknowledgment of liability and assumption of the
     defense thereof, the indemnifying party shall not be liable to such
     indemnified party for any legal or other expenses subsequently incurred by
     the indemnified party in connection with the defense thereof (but the
     indemnified party shall have the right, but not the obligation, to
     participate at its own cost and expense in such defense by counsel of its
     own choice) or for any amounts paid or foregone by the indemnified party as
     a result of any settlement or compromise thereof that is effected by the
     indemnified party (without the written consent of the indemnifying party),
     except as provided in Section 11.3(b)(ii) below.


          (c) Each of the indemnifying and indemnified party shall cooperate
     fully with the other in the defense of any Proceeding hereunder, including
     without limitation, appearing and giving testimony, producing documents and
     other tangible evidence, allowing the other party access to the books and
     records of such party and otherwise assisting the other party in conducting
     such defense. No indemnifying party shall, without the consent of the
     indemnified party, consent to entry of any judgment or enter into any
     settlement or compromise which does not include as an unconditional term
     thereof the giving by the claimant or plaintiff to such indemnified party
     of a release from all liability in respect of such claim or Proceeding.
     Provided that proper notice is duly given, if the indemnifying party shall
     fail promptly and diligently to properly assume the defense thereof, then
     the indemnified party may respond to, contest and defend against such
     Proceeding and may make in good faith any compromise or settlement with
     respect thereto, and recover from the indemnifying party the entire cost
     and expense thereof including, without limitation, reasonable attorneys'
     fees and disbursements and all amounts paid or foregone as a result of such
     Proceeding, or the settlement or compromise thereof. The indemnification
     required hereunder shall be made by periodic payments of the amount thereof
     during the course of the investigation or defense, as and when bills or
     invoices are received or loss, liability, obligation, damage or expense is
     actually suffered or incurred.

          (d) Any notice of a claim hereunder which does not involve a third
     party shall include a statement in prominent and conspicuous type, that if
     the indemnifying party does not dispute its liability to the indemnified
     party with respect to such claim by notice to the indemnified party prior
     to the expiration of a 45 calendar day period following the indemnifying
     party's receipt of notice of such claim, the claim will be conclusively
     deemed a liability of the indemnifying party. If the indemnifying party
     does not notify the indemnified party prior to the expiration of a 45
     calendar day period following its receipt of such notice that the
     indemnifying party disputes its liability to the indemnified party under
     this Agreement, such claim specified by

                                      -35-

<PAGE>



     the indemnified party in such notice will be conclusively deemed a
     liability of the indemnifying party under this Agreement and the
     indemnifying party shall pay the amount of such liability to the
     indemnified party on demand or, in the case of any notice in which the
     amount of the claim (or any portion thereof) is estimated, on such later
     date when the amount is determined. If the indemnifying party has timely
     disputed its liability with respect to such claim, as provided above, the
     indemnifying party and the indemnified party will proceed in good faith to
     negotiate a resolution of such dispute and, if not resolved through
     negotiation by the 90th day after notice of such claim was given to the
     indemnifying party, such dispute will be resolved: (i) by arbitration to be
     conducted by a single arbitrator pursuant to the Rules of the American
     Arbitration Association, which arbitration shall be conducted in New York,
     New York, or (ii) by such other methods or procedures as the indemnifying
     party and the indemnified party mutually agree. If arbitration is used, the
     parties will complete all submissions to the arbitrator within 45 days of
     choosing the arbitrator, and the arbitrator will provide a final ruling on
     each dispute within 30 days of the final submission by the parties. The
     arbitrator shall award to the party that obtains substantially the relief
     sought that party's costs and fees, including reasonable attorneys' fees.

     12. Miscellaneous.

     12.1 Transaction Fees and Expenses. Each party hereto shall bear such
costs, fees and expenses as may be incurred by it in connection with this
Agreement and the transactions contemplated hereby.

     12.2 Notices. Any notice, demand, request or other communication which is
required, called for or contemplated to be given or made hereunder to or upon
any party hereto shall be deemed to have been duly given or made for all
purposes if (a) in writing and sent by (i) messenger or a recognized national
overnight courier service for next day delivery with receipt therefor, or (ii)
certified or registered mail, postage paid, return receipt requested, or (b)
sent by facsimile transmission with a written copy thereof sent on the same day
by postage paid first-class mail or (c) by personal delivery to such party at
the following address:


      To the Buyer:

           Kaye Insurance Associates, Inc.
           122 East 42nd Street
           New York, NY 10168
           Attention Bruce D. Guthart, President & CEO
           Facsimile No.: (212) 986-2278




                               -36-

<PAGE>


     with a copy to:

           Kaye Insurance Associates, Inc.
           122 East 42nd Street
           New York, NY 10168
           Attention: Ivy S. Fischer, Esq., General Counsel
           Facsimile No.: (212) 856-9458

     To the Sellers or any Shareholder at:

           130 Crossways Park Drive
           Suite 400
           Woodbury, New York 11797
           Attention: Mr. Chris Brady
           Facsimile No.: (516) 496-4040

     with respect to each of the Sellers and the Shareholders, with a copy to:

           Wachtel & Masyr, LLP
           110 East 59th Street
           New York, New York 10022
           Attention: Jeffrey Strauss, Esq.
           Facsimile No.: (212) 371-0320


or such other address as either party hereto may at any time, or from time to
time, direct by notice given to the other party in accordance with this Section.
The date of giving or making of any such notice or demand shall be, in the case
of clause (a)(i), the date of the receipt, in the case of clause (a)(ii), five
business days after such notice or demand is sent, and, in the case of clause
(b), the business day next following the date such notice or demand is sent. A
copy of any notice to the Shareholders shall be sent concurrently to the Sellers
and a copy of any notice to the Sellers shall be sent concurrently to the
Shareholders.

     12.3 Amendment. Except as otherwise provided herein, no amendment of this
Agreement shall be valid or effective unless in writing and signed by or on
behalf of the party against whom the same is sought to be enforced.

     12.4 Waiver. No course of dealing of any party hereto, no omission, failure
or delay on the part of any party hereto in asserting or exercising any right
hereunder, and no partial or single exercise of any right hereunder by any party
hereto shall constitute or operate as a waiver of any such right or any other
right hereunder. No waiver of any provision hereof shall be effective unless in
writing and signed by or on behalf of the party to be charged therewith. No
waiver of any provision hereof shall be deemed or construed as a continuing
waiver, as a waiver in respect of any other or subsequent breach or default of
such provision, or as a waiver of any other

                                      -37-

<PAGE>



provision hereof unless expressly so stated in writing and signed by or on
behalf of the party to be charged therewith. The Buyer's receipt of Tax Returns,
waiver of bulk sales law, and other waivers and receipt of information contained
herein shall not be deemed to waive any of the Buyer's rights under the
indemnification provisions of Section 11.

     12.5 Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by, and interpreted
and enforced in accordance with, the laws of the State of New York without
giving effect to principles of conflicts or choice of law thereof.

     12.6 Jurisdiction. Each of the parties hereto hereby irrevocably consents
and submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the United States District Court
for the Southern District of New York in connection with any Proceeding arising
out of or relating to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby,
waives any objection to venue in such District and waives any right to claim
that such District may be an inconvenient forum (unless such court lacks
jurisdiction with respect to such Proceeding, in which case, each of the parties
hereto irrevocably consents to the jurisdiction of the courts of the State of
New York in connection with such Proceeding and waives any objection to venue in
the State of New York, and agrees that service of any summons, complaint, notice
or other process relating to such Proceeding may be effected in the manner
provided by clause (a) of Section 12.2).

     12.7 Remedies. In the event of any actual or prospective breach or default
by any party hereto, the other parties shall be entitled to equitable relief,
including remedies in the nature of rescission, injunction and specific
performance. All remedies hereunder are cumulative and not exclusive. Nothing
contained herein and no election of any particular remedy shall be deemed to
prohibit or limit any party from pursuing, or be deemed a waiver of the right to
pursue, any other remedy or relief available now or hereafter existing at law or
in equity (whether by statute or otherwise) for such actual or prospective
breach or default, including the recovery of damages.

     12.8 Severability. The provisions hereof are severable and if any provision
of this Agreement shall be determined to be legally invalid, inoperative or
unenforceable in any respect by a court of competent jurisdiction, then the
remaining provisions hereof shall not be affected, but shall, subject to the
discretion of such court, remain in full force and effect, and any such invalid,
inoperative or unenforceable provision shall be deemed, without any further
action on the part of the parties hereto, amended and limited to the extent
necessary to render such provision valid, operative and enforceable.

     12.9 Further Assurances. Each party hereto covenants and agrees promptly to
execute, deliver, file or record such agreements, instruments, certificates and
other documents and to perform such other and further acts as the other party
hereto may reasonably request or as may otherwise be necessary or proper to
consummate and perfect the transactions contemplated hereby.


                                      -38-

<PAGE>



     12.10 Assignment. Except as provided herein, this Agreement and all of the
provisions hereof shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties
hereto, their heirs and their respective successors and permitted assignees but
may not be assigned or transferred by any of the Sellers or the Shareholders.

     12.11 Binding Effect. This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the
benefit of the parties hereto and their respective legal representatives,
successors and permitted assigns.

     12.12 No Third Party Beneficiaries. Nothing contained in this Agreement,
whether express or implied, is intended, or shall be deemed, to create or confer
any right, interest or remedy for the benefit of any Person other than as
otherwise provided in this Agreement.

     12.13 Entire Agreement. This Agreement (including all the schedules and
exhibits hereto), together with the Exhibits, Schedules, certificates and other
documentation referred to herein or required to be delivered pursuant to the
terms hereof, contains the terms of the entire agreement among the parties with
respect to the subject matter hereof and supersedes any and all prior
agreements, commitments, understandings, discussions, negotiations or
arrangements of any nature relating thereto.

     12.14 Presumptions. The parties hereby expressly agree and acknowledge that
there shall be no presumption against the party drafting this Agreement in
connection with any action, proceeding or claim arising out of or relating to
this Agreement in any manner.

     12.15 Headings. The headings contained in this Agreement are included for
convenience and reference purposes only and shall be given no effect in the
construction or interpretation of this Agreement.

     12.16 Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of
counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which
together shall constitute one and the same instrument.




                                      -39-

<PAGE>


     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed or caused to be
executed this Agreement to be executed as of the date first written above.

            Sellers:                SEAMAN, ROSS & WIENER, INC.


                                    By: /s/             
                                       ------------------------------------
                                       Name:
                                       Title:

                                    AMSCO COVERAGE CORP.


                                    By: /s/             
                                       ------------------------------------
                                       Name:
                                       Title:

                                    D.S.I. ASSOCIATES, INC.


                                    By: /s/             
                                       ------------------------------------
                                       Name:
                                       Title:


            Buyer:                  KAYE INSURANCE ASSOCIATES, INC.


                                    By: /s/             
                                       ------------------------------------
                                       Name:
                                       Title:


            Shareholders:           By: /s/  Alex Seaman
                                       ------------------------------------
                                             Alex Seaman
                                       


                                    By: /s/  Douglas Schenendorf           
                                       ------------------------------------
                                             Douglas Schenendorf



                                     -40-



                                                                      EXHIBIT 11
                                                                     Page 1 of 2

                                 KAYE GROUP INC
                         Earnings Per Share Calculation
                  For the Twelve Months Ended December 31, 1998



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  Twelve months
                                                                      ended
                                                                   Dec.31,1998
                                                                   ===========

<S>                                                                <C>          
Net Income                                                         $7,282,000(1)





I.   Weighted Average Shares:                                       8,474,000(2)
                                                                   ==========





II.  Basic EPS                                                         0.8593(1) / (2)
                                                                   ==========





III. Diluted EPS

            Weighted Average Shares                                 8,474,000(2)
            Dilution                                                  118,599(3)
                                                                   ----------
                                                                    8,592,599(4)
                                                                   ==========





            Diluted EPS                                                0.8475(1) / (4)
                                                                   ==========
</TABLE>



<PAGE>

                                                                      EXHIBIT 11
                                                                     Page 2 of 2

                                 KAYE GROUP INC
                         Earnings Per Share Calculation
                  For the Twelve Months Ended December 31, 1998


<TABLE>
IV.  Outstanding at December 31, 1998
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                      Weighted
                                          Units                 Price/Share         Proceeds           Average          Proceeds
                                        ==========              ===========        ==========        ==========        ==========
<S>                                        <C>                    <C>              <C>                  <C>            <C>
A. Options (8/17/93)                        75,750                $10.000          $  757,500
   Options (1/24/94                          5,000                 10.910              54,550
   Options (2/3/94)                            500                 11.625               5,813
   Options (9/13/95)                        15,000                  7.880             118,200
   Options (10/25/95)                       40,200                  8.430             338,886
   Options (5/15/96)                        10,000                  7.060              70,600
   Options (12/27/96)                       15,000                  5.000              75,000            15,000            75,000
   Options (2/1/97)                         35,000                  5.000             175,000            35,000           175,000
   Options (2/25/97)                       178,250                  5.060             901,945           178,250           901,945
   Options (4/15/97)                       200,000                  5.000           1,000,000           200,000         1,000,000
   Options (7/1/97)                         10,000                  4.970              49,700            10,000            49,700
   Options (10/31/97)                       15,000                  8.030             120,450
   Options (12/31/97)                        5,000                  6.640              33,200             5,000            33,200
   Options (07/01/98)                       10,000                  6.700              67,000            10,000            67,000
   Options (10/30/98)                       20,000                  6.170             123,400            20,000           123,400
   Options (12/10/98)                       24,500                  6.600             161,700            24,500           161,700
                                        ----------                                 ----------        ----------        ----------
                                           659,200                                 $4,052,944           497,750     (5) 2,586,945
                                        ==========                                 ==========        ==========        ==========

   Dilutive Shares                         497,750(5)                               2,586,945(6)
                                        ==========                                 ==========
</TABLE>

V.   Average market value/share
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          Average        Close on
                                                           Close         last day
                                                      =============     ===========
<S>                                                           <C>         <C>
                   Jan                                        6.538
                   Feb                                        7.013
                   Mar                                        7.193       7.500
                                                      -------------
                           Hash total 3 mths                 20.744
                                                      =============

                   April                                      7.272
                   May                                        6.887
                   June                                       6.660       6.500
                                                      -------------
                           Hash total 3 mths                 20.819
                                                      =============

                   July                                      7.017
                   August                                    6.870
                   September                                  6.625       6.625
                                                      -------------
                           Hash total 3 mths                 20.512
                                                      =============

                   October                                    6.261
                   November                                   6.393
                   December                                   7.147       7.500
                                                      -------------
                           Hash total 3 mths                 19.801
                                                      =============


                           Hash total 12 mths                81.876
                                                      =============

                                                      /          12
                                                      -------------
Average price per share Twelve mths                           6.823
                                                      =============


VI. Diluted

                                                      Twelve Months
                                                      -------------

Total Proceeds from exercise                             $2,586,945(6)
Divided by average price                                      6.823

Repurchase shares of                                        379,151

Shares issued (options)                                     497,750(5)
                                                      -------------
Dilution - Shares                                  (3)      118,599
                                                      =============
</TABLE>


<TABLE> <S> <C>


<ARTICLE>                                       7
       
<S>                            <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                  12-MOS
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                     DEC-31-1998
<PERIOD-START>                         JAN-1-1998
<PERIOD-END>                          DEC-31-1998
<DEBT-HELD-FOR-SALE>                       43,597
<DEBT-CARRYING-VALUE>                           0
<DEBT-MARKET-VALUE>                             0
<EQUITIES>                                  1,347
<MORTGAGE>                                      0
<REAL-ESTATE>                                   0
<TOTAL-INVEST>                             47,894
<CASH>                                     45,443
<RECOVER-REINSURE>                              0
<DEFERRED-ACQUISITION>                      3,921
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                            167,066
<POLICY-LOSSES>                                 0
<UNEARNED-PREMIUMS>                        12,327
<POLICY-OTHER>                                  0
<POLICY-HOLDER-FUNDS>                           0
<NOTES-PAYABLE>                             6,543
                           0
                                     0
<COMMON>                                       85
<OTHER-SE>                                 41,684
<TOTAL-LIABILITY-AND-EQUITY>              167,066
                                 24,689
<INVESTMENT-INCOME>                         4,735
<INVESTMENT-GAINS>                             85
<OTHER-INCOME>                             35,502
<BENEFITS>                                  8,496
<UNDERWRITING-AMORTIZATION>                 7,630
<UNDERWRITING-OTHER>                        2,077
<INCOME-PRETAX>                            10,554
<INCOME-TAX>                                3,272
<INCOME-CONTINUING>                         7,282
<DISCONTINUED>                                  0
<EXTRAORDINARY>                                 0
<CHANGES>                                       0
<NET-INCOME>                                7,282
<EPS-PRIMARY>                                0.86
<EPS-DILUTED>                                0.85
<RESERVE-OPEN>                             19,126
<PROVISION-CURRENT>                         9,384
<PROVISION-PRIOR>                            (479)
<PAYMENTS-CURRENT>                          1,877
<PAYMENTS-PRIOR>                            4,587
<RESERVE-CLOSE>                            21,567
<CUMULATIVE-DEFICIENCY>                         0
                                     


</TABLE>


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission